NIGHT MAGICK BY Phillip D. Williams

 NIGHT MAGICK


BY


Phillip D. Williams

pdwillia@silver.ucs.indiana.edu
























All rights reserved

Copyright 1990 by Phillip D. Williams


No part of this book may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any

means,  electronic or mechanical, including photocopying, recording, or by any

information  storage and retrieval system., without permission in writing from

the author.





NIGHT MAGICK 


 NIGHT MAGICK      


INTRODUCTION 

1. What is Night Magick? 

2.  Who is a Night Magician? 

3.  Why Practice Night Magick?   

4.  How to Study the Lore  


CHAPTER  II



THE NIGHT MAGICIAN 

5.  Her/His Life  

6.  The Apprentice's Unfoldment

7.  Night Consciousness  


CHAPTER III



BEGINNING NIGHT MAGICK 

8.  Standards and Principles of Practicing Night Magick  

9.  A Night Magician's Tools and Weapons  

10.  Your Magickal Night Name  

11.  Night Pillar  

12.  Invocation to Night Magick 


CHAPTER IV



Earth Magick 

13.  The Earth Realm   

14.  Night Breathing 

15.  The Night Magician's Meditation   

16.  The Realm of Vibration  

17.  Night Centers and the Physical and Etheric Bodies 

18.  The Power of Sound 

19.  Earth Rite  

20.  The Physical Realm of Death  


CHAPTER V



WATER MAGICK 

21.  The Water (Astral) Realm 

22.  The Astral Body and Exercises for Emotional Control  

23.  Astral Aura, Color, and Exercises 

24.  The Higher Night Centers and Exercises 

25.  The Dream Realm  

26.  Astral Guides, Oracleship, and Trance 

27.  The Moon and Its Rites 

28.  Water Rites 

29.  Night Projection 


CHAPTER  VI



AIR  MAGICK  

30.  The Mental Realm  

31.  Air Rite  

32.  Power of Thought  

33.  Your Silent Magician 

34.  Hypnotism and Self  

35.  A Night Magician's Pendulum 

36.  A Night Magician's Crystal Globe  

37.  Psychometry  

38.  Telepathy  

39.  Mental Projection 

40.  Creative Visualization  


CHAPTER  VII



Night (Fire) Magick 

41.  The Night (Fire) Realm 

42.  The Solar, Planetary, and Lunar Powers  

43.  The Night Guild  

44.  Night Powers 

45.  Night Flames  

46.  Night Rites 

47.  Night Healing  

48.  Immortality: Transmigration and Transmutation 

49.  Night Magicians: Past, Present, and Future  


APPENDIXES 


APPENDIX A

 

INVOCATIONS, HYMNS, POEMS, AND PRAYERS  


APPENDIX B   


CANDLE COLOR COMBINATION AND THE NIGHT TEACHERS  





NIGHT MAGICK     


There was the Clear Light, the Void, and It alone was.  The One Mind, apart of

nothing, yet containing everything, it alone the True Creator.  Formless,

Nameless, without Definition,  yet flowing through all that has form, name,

and definition.  From the One Mind there  came Two Matrixes, two sides of the

same coin, Night and Day.  Twin Soul Creators to  each side, the Yin- Yang of

Night and Yang-Yin of Day. And so the Night and Day of the  Omniverse was

born.


I AM Night.  I AM Darkness that flows through the Night.  I AM THE ETERNAL

DARKNESS. Yin-Yang created, Goddess-God of Night, Daughter-Son of Darkness,

Eternal Creator of  the Nightverse.   By the Dark Power and Energy, by the

Night Magick was all created in  the Nightverse.


The Ancient Dragons were first taught and they taught the others and so

creation began throughout the Nightverse.   And so by the Dark Power, by Night

Magick was everything created flowing through the created instruments of the

ETERNAL DARKNESS.  Night's beginning was good and the Earth was created a

jewel in the Crown of Night.


The Dragons came with other races and created the beginning Night Races of the

Earth.   And time flowed and the races prospered and their depth in Night

Consciousness  deepened.  But then as so often happens the Day came to war

with the Night and the  Earth changed.


The Day gods were young and wanted the Earth for its wealth of minerals and

beauty and destroyed the Night Races.  They created human bodies as mindless,

soulless slaves to  gather this wealth. But the Great Night Dragon, Tiamat,

Goddess-God of the World, saw  what had happened and ensouled the human bodies

placing a part of its Great Night Soul  into each human body.  But since then

the Day gods have warred with Tiamat for control  of the human souls. The Day

gods have spread false teachings about the origin of the human souls and the

Night Dragon.  They have tried to destroy the Night religions of old that

glorified the Yin  Spirit of the Earth and the beauty of life.  Long has the

war continued and now is the time  for a rebirth of Night Magick on Earth.


And so I, the Eternal Night, have ensouled the Earth to supercharge it with

NIGHT  MAGICK.  I have come to Earth, through a human instrument, to spread my

magickal  teachings.  To teach the human soul the truth of its origins and

re-awaken the Night  within.  To make humankind co-creators with the Eternal

Night through the teachings of  Night Magick.






CHAPTER I



INTRODUCTION


1. What is Night Magick?


I can only imagine at this point that you are about to put down this book and

run scared  due to words like Night, Darkness, Dark Power, and the title of

the book itself, Night  Magick.  Before we begin learning about Night Magick I

believe it will help to understand  what I mean by these "night" terms.


To begin, there is the Void.  The Buddhist call it the Clear Light as opposed

to "white" or  "black". The Taoist refer to it as the Tao and Christians refer

to it as God the Father.  The  Void is the indivisible eternal energy.  The

Void is beyond polarities of energy such as  positive/negative or Yang/Yin.

It is God Mind.  It is everywhere and through every thing  yet remains

separate from every thing.  That is, it does not become a part of any one

thing  such as the soul does with the body.  The Void does not think like you

and I yet it is "all  thought".   It is the most mystical of concepts and God

the Father is perhaps the poorest  term for the Void.  The Void is not a

Father, it isn't male or female, the void contains  creation yet it does not

assume a role within creation. The more I try to describe to you  the Void the

less I actually accomplish in doing so.  The Void cannot truly be described

but only experienced.  The Void begins with its major principles who spring

into being, the  Ultimate Yin and Yang of the Omniverse.


The original premise is that the Yang represents the Male Creative force in

the Omniverse  and Yin the Female Passive force in the Omniverse.  A more

accurate premise is that  there is an Ultimate Yin and Ultimate Yang each

complete in and of itself. That each  Ultimate force has the Creative Force

within it and that there are twin systems created by  this.  We have two

separate creation matrixes separated by a neutral zone.  There is an  Ultimate

Yang System and an Ultimate Yin System.   The Earth is a part of the Ultimate

Yin System.


The Ultimate Yin System is made up of many races.  The human race is not alone

in the Omniverse.  The most ancient race existing in form today is the Ancient

Dragon.  The  Ancient Dragons are not the Dragons you read of in mythology.

The Ancient Dragons are  far beyond the other races in total development.

Their science, philosophy, and religion  is based on the One Mind and the

Void. An Ancient Dragon came to Earth and guided the  development of the

planet and ultimately ensouled the World.   Working with other races,  the

Dragon created a new race to populate the world.  This was long before the

human  race.  The creation of the human race is a sad tale.


The races of the world go through a repeated pattern of creation, sustainment,

and then destruction.  Out of the old race a new race is born more highly

evolved than the last.    The human race though was created out of greed.

There came to Earth a high  technologically advanced race from the Yang

system.  They came to make the Earth their  own world and to rape it of its

resources. The advanced race, who we find described in  greek, roman, norse,

and other mythologies as the gods or as in the Bible, Jehovah or in  the

Koran, Allah, created the human race to be mindless slaves.  This was so the

gods  could live like gods.  The Ancient Dragon would not permit such an

abomination and so it  ensouled the human bodies and the human race had its

beginning as an ensouled Yin  race.  The Yang gods were quite upset by this

for the human race became a sentient Yin  race and had to be treated as such.

For some time the gods tried to continue to control  man through their

technology and set up religions based on worship of the Yang principle  and

the gods.  These religions taught absolute obedience to the gods or God and

the  worship of the Yang principle.  The Yang religion taught the domination

of the Earth and  its creatures by humankind.  The Yang religion taught the

hate and sin of the human body  and procreation.  This always included the

subservience of the human woman to the  human male for God was male and

superior and woman was the seducer and corrupter of man.  The leader of the

gods was always a male god such as Zeus.  They also taught that  the Yin

principle of the Omniverse was chaos and evil.  That the Dark principle was a

destructive force out to destroy mankind and the Earth.  They personified the

Yin principle  as Satan, Lucifer, Loki, Pan, Iblis, or Kali and created places

of damnation for those who  did not worship the Yang principle.  All this was

done to maintain control over humankind  and promote the Yang principles

through fear.   At some point the Yang gods were  required to quit having

direct contact with man perhaps when they used nuclear weapons  on Sodom and

Gomorrah as recorded in the Bible.   Whatever the reason, only periodic

contact was allowed and that through special religious messengers such as

Krishna,  Zoroaster, Jesus, and Mohammed.   If you examine the major Yang

religions you will see  a reoccurring theme of an evil servant giving

humankind the knowledge of good and evil  and humankind turned away from

Paradise.  These religions always worship the "White  Light of God" and place

man not woman in so-called dominion of the Earth. Woman, the  Yin-Yin

Principle in the Omniverse, was placed in deep shame and subservience to man

the Yang-Yang principle.  Yet on Earth, man is Yin-Yang not Yang-Yang by

virtue of the  indwelling Night Spirit of the Planet.


Every soul and spirit (terms we'll examine more fully later) of the human race

is a  fragment of the indwelling Soul and Spirit of the Planet Earth.  In

essence, the Soul and  Spirit of the Planet Earth is God to humankind.  That

Soul and Spirit is the Ancient Dragon  that originally came to Earth and saved

the human body from a mindless existence  enslaved to the Yang race. The

Ancient Dragon is the Creator and Ensouler of this World  and of each and

every one of us. The Dragon of this World is the Night Force. The  Dragon of

this world is Yin.


Yin is a primal force established in the Omniverse in parallel with Yang.

This planet is a  Yin world.  The presence of Yang and the worship and

practice of the Yang principle in  religions such as Christianity, Islam,

Hinduism, Mormonism has led to many evils in the  world.


It has led to the subservience of women.  It has led to humankind following a

spiritual  path of Yang in direct opposition to its Soul and Spirit's magickal

orientation.   This has  led to much inner confusion by humankind and this

world's instability and patterns of  destruction and chaos are a direct

response to this. The Earth is a very sick body.


Until you achieve a very, very advance point in your evolution, you'll have a

physical body  of some kind.  The Soul of this world has the Earth as its body

and humankind is killing it.    This so- called dominion by man has poisoned

the streams, rivers, lakes, and oceans of  the Earth, the Earth's circulatory

system.  The air, Earth's respiratory system, is poisoned.   The soil itself

is poisoned, stripped mined, littered, great holes filled with non-

biodegradable products.  The trees and forests destroyed wantonly, savagely,

and soon  the oxygen they generate will not be enough to sustain life.  Acid

rain instead of the clean  rains. Underground nuclear testing disrupting the

physical and etheric shell of the Earth  Body not to speak of the Astral and

Higher Body damage done by this intensely Yang  energy.  Ozone destroying the

upper atmosphere and the protection from the harmful  ultraviolet radiation.

Wanton destruction of wildlife of which some is inhabited by races of  greater

advancement than humankind. Just how much longer will man act as a deadly

cancer in the Earth's body.  At the rate of destruction it will not be much

longer before  humankind as you know it will cease to exist and that is

exactly what the Yang forces in  the Omniverse want.


Then they have the right to come and claim the Earth as they did before as

recorded in  the Old Testament of the Bible and in other ancient myths.

Humankind will once more  find itself enslaved and bowing before a

technologically higher race as it was in the  ancient days.  This must not

happen!  This is what Night Magick is all about.


Teaching you the truth about your existence.  Placing back into your hands the

truth concerning the Yin Primal Force of which you are a part.   To give to

you the tools to  balance yourself and the Earth in Oneness with the Night

Spirit.  What is Night Magick?


Night Magick is the arts, rites, practices, and teachings of a Night Magician.

Night  Magick is the lore of a Night Magician. The lore must be learned not

only with the eyes  and brain but also with the heart.  It is a way of life

and must be lived to be fully  understood.  Night Magick is founded on the

ancient knowledge and wisdom that  preceded the history of the Earth. Though

Night Magick is based on ancient teachings it is  no less applicable to the

modern world.  Night Magick is a magickal discipline.   Through  its rules,

instruction, and exercises it provides for you a code of conduct and a way of

living that brings to you the greatest possible Yin growth.   It is a

philosophy.  The goal of  a Night Magician is the Eternal Pursuit of Wisdom

and Knowledge based on the Yin  Primal Force.  It is a science.  For through

the study and practice of the lore, you will gain  greater knowledge and

wisdom.  Through Night Magick you will achieve perfection in your  physical,

emotional, mental, and magickal natures.  You will become the sum of all that

you can ever be.  You will become the Night Oversoul in Consciousness and

Action.  Night  Magick is a lore that will achieve for you your return to the

Night.  I know this has been  fast and furious for you.


For many of you, this is the first time you have been given such information

or even  thought about what has been so far discussed. I promise you that I

will go into greater  depths on the subjects I treated briefly and this will

help you understand more thoroughly.   But I wanted to make sure you

understood from the onset the principles Night Magick is  based on.


Night Magick is magick based upon the Sacred Principle of Yin. It is based on

the Dark  Force that flows through your being.  If you still have doubts read

on and test the  knowledge you find here.  You are not asked to accept

anything in this book on blind  faith.  You will not be asked to accept

anything without first putting it to test and validating  the truth.  If you

find some of the information hard to understand then reflect on it for

awhile. Put away the information you find hard to accept for another time of

reflection.    Place into your mind and soul only those things that you have

tried, tested, and found to  be truth for yourself. But at all times, keep an

open mind.  That is all I ask.  I think its time  now to discuss who is a

Night Magician.


2.  Who is a Night Magician?


Who is a Night Magician?  


A Night Magician is Absolute Love. They are the embodiment of Dark Love that

has its  origin in the Void.  They are Dark Love that is free from any

restrictions, limitations, or  exceptions. They are Dark Love free from

dependence upon external definitions for its  existence. They are Dark Love

born out of Absolute Innocence.  A Night Magician is  Absolute Love.

 

A Night Magician is Strong Willed.   They are the willpower necessary to move

mountains. They are the willpower needed to overcome the impossible.  They are

the willpower it  takes to overcome life's challenges and defeats.  They are

the willpower it requires to  wield Night Magick against their enemies and

win. They are the willpower of the Eternal  Darkness.  A Night Magician is

Strong Willed.


A Night Magician is Self-disciplined.  They will undergo a thousand days and

nights of deprivation to achieve their goals. They are hardest upon their

selves in achieving self- mastery of Night Magick.  They are the

self-discipline it requires to overcome failure for a thousandth time and once

more attempt the challenge.  They live in a self-imposed world  of

self-discipline in order to achieve the ultimate state of being.  A Night

Magician is Self- disciplined.


A Night Magician is Patience.  They are the patience required while acquiring

self-mastery. They are the patience needed when building dreams of success.

They are the  patience required when waiting for the destruction of their

enemies.  They are the  patience the Night Spirit has in each of us and our

magickal climb.  A Night Magician is  Patience.


A Night Magician is a Pillar of Strength.  They are the rock that will not be

moved as the  waves of strife come crashing over. They are the strength needed

to overcome the Forces  of Yang. They are the strength required to achieve

success in life.   A Night Magician is a  Pillar of Strength.


A Night Magician is Free of Self-limitations.  They are not bound by the

chains of limited thinking.  They do not see themselves as just human beings

made of flesh and bones but  as Ones, pure in Night Spirit, that transcend

time and space.   Their emotions do not  master their lives.  They are the

master of their emotions. They are the calm, silent, and  steady Soul of the

Night.  They are the Night Soul.  They are the Dark Masters of Life.  A  Night

Magician is Freedom.


A Night Magician is Deep Silence.  They are the Deep Silence of the Night.

They are like  the silence that follows the storm. They are the silence that

is found in the quiet of the  home. They are the silence of the Void.  They

are the silence of the Night Soul.  They are  the silence of the Night

Dragon's sacred flight.  A Night Magician is Deep Silence.


A Night Magician is Dark Knowledge.   They are knowledge found through

intellectual  pursuit of the hidden mysteries.  They are knowledge born out of

intelligence and critical  thinking. They are knowledge discovered through

intuition, meditation, and reflection.  A  Night Magician is Dark Knowledge.


A Night Magician is Nature.  They are the flowers that bloom and the trees

that bud in the Spring.  They are the mighty winds that blow across the world

and the gentle rains that  give life to all things that grow.  They are the

melodic voice of the birds who sing.  They  are the heat and cool waters that

are found in the months of Summer.  They are the  storms, tornadoes, and

hurricanes.  They are the frog churumping and the Night Owl  hooting.  They

are the short summer nights.  They are the Artist's brush that paints the

leaves of Fall. They are the harvest of the crops.  They are the stacked corn

stalks of the  fields and the pumpkins in the window sills.  They are the

squirrels and chipmunks  gathering up the nuts in readiness for the long cold

Winter months.  They are every snow  flake dancing and icicle hanging.  They

are the white bunny and fox who does the  chasing.  They are the never ending

cycle of Nature.  A Night Magician is Nature.


A Night Magician is Life.  They are passionate for their love of Life in all

its aspects.  They  are adventurous and courageous loving the challenge of

Life.   Yet they are practical,  cautious and responsible with Life.  For

them, Life should be faced with daring, boldness,  and energy.  They loathe

restriction and love the freedom found in Life.  They are the  Artisans of

Life. A Night Magician is Life.


A Night Magician is the Night Soul in Action on Earth.  It abides in their

conscience in all  the things said or done.  They are the Creative Force of

the Night Soul in the way they  create new life. They are the Preservative

Force of the Night Soul holding the world in  perfect balance. They are the

Destructive Force of the Night Soul tearing away the  illusions of the Yang.

They are the Regenerative Force of the Night Soul rebuilding the  true Night

World.  They are Night Soul by the way they remove us out of life's confusion.

The eyes that see us, the ears that listen to us, the mouth that speaks words

of strength,  the heart that pours out absolute love to us, the strong arms

and hands that hold us near,  and the legs that take us far on our way,

through all of these there is the Night Spirit.  A  Night Magician is the

Night Soul in Action on Earth.


Who is a Night Magician?  A Night Magician can be likened to a multifaceted

stone of Amethyst or Emerald of incomparable beauty. The Night Magician is as

beautiful and rare  as a Black Diamond. I have just discussed many of those

facets that make-up a Night  Magician but if I kept on writing for days I

would never be able to cover all of them.  Each  facet of the Night Magician

can best be known by living it; by becoming a Night Magician.   The facets I

have been covering are those found in the Night Magician who has been long  on

the path and has attained much.  It is anyone who will dedicate her or his

life to the  Night Principles found in this work. You have to dedicate your

lives to becoming all that I  described a Night Magician to be in the

beginning of this topic.  The teachings must again  be practiced actively in

your life as they were practiced in the ancient civilizations that  first came

into being here on Earth.  A Night Magician is one who will put these

teachings  found in this work into practice in her or his life and live them

fully.


A Night Magician is one who abides fully in the Consciousness of the Night.

They are the  total embodiment of strength, solitude, patience, intelligence,

courage and adventure.   They are beings free of self-limitations.  They are

ones who have dedicated their life to  self-freedom and perfection.  They are

the Night Soul in Action.  There is no greater  purpose in life then to be a

Night Magician.   Now that you have some idea of who a Night  Magician is and

what Night Magick is about, I would like to discuss why you should  practice

Night Magick.


3.  Why Practice Night Magick?  


Why practice Night Magick?  To begin with, there is great joy and happiness in

being a  Night Magician and practicing the lore of Night Magick.  In

practicing Night Magick you  are going to be able to see the results of your

labor; and the results of that labor are  going to bring you more happiness

and joy then you can imagine.  You are going to  derive a great sense of

personal satisfaction and accomplishment through the practice of  Night

Magick.  Practicing Night Magick is exciting and adventurous.


Your life will be filled with adventure and excitement the likes of which

you've never  known. It is very sad that so many people's lives are filled

with boredom needlessly.   Through Night Magick avenues of travel, business

adventure, intellectual pursuit, personal  adventure, and magickal conquests

will open up. Night Magick will bring you personal  success.


Personal success can be measured in many ways.   How about success in

marriage,  finances, college, business?  Or personal success in health,

vitality, and longevity.    Change is why you practice Night Magick.  What

changes will Night Magick make in your  life?


Everything!  Through the practice of Night Magick not a thing in your life

will go  untouched. You practice Night Magick for these changes in your life.

I can go a long way  in this book to answer specifically what kind of changes

are going to take place.  But  ultimately it is you, after study and practice

of Night Magick, who will be able to give all  the answers.  Let's begin

answering the question of what kind of changes you can expect  to see in your

life?


The first changes you will see, by practicing the lore, is improvement in your

physical life.   You are going to have better health and a sense of renewed

purpose in life.  You are  going to achieve this through the practice of Night

Breathing and Meditation.  As you go  along here there will be new terms that

you have never seen before, but be patient, for as  you proceed through this

book, you will learn them all.   Your life is going to be deeply  enriched and

health improved by the use of colors and self-healing that you will learn.

You will learn to develop and use the power centers of your body.  Once you

have  accomplished this, you will unleash untold power of fire and life

throughout your body.   This will allow you to become the master of your life;

"the Captain of your Soul".  You will  then learn to overcome your fear of

death and to recognize it for what it is, a doorway into  a new world.  All

this you can achieve through Night Magick, but there is much, much  more.


Through the practice of Night Magick you are going to become the master of

your  emotions.  No longer will your emotions rule you, but you will rule

them.  You will learn,  in dealing with your emotions and emotional body, the

ability to be able to see the higher  realms.  You will be able to recognize

those dreams in which a message of help and  inspiration is contained and to

interpret it.  You will come to know your magickal teachers  and guides and

ultimately you will be able to travel in the Astral Realm.  This you will

achieve through the mastery of your emotions.  There is even more to learn

through the  practice of Night Magick.


Through Night Magick, you will master the powers of your mind. You will

achieve thought control and be able to reach into your subconscious mind.

Your subconscious mind is the repository for all that you have ever known.

Think of what it will mean to have access to  this great storage vault of

information.  You will learn to use the pendulum and crystal  globe and never

have questions unanswered.  You will achieve psychometric and  telepathic

abilities. Above all, you will be able to create into your world "ANYTHING"

that  you desire to see in it through correct invocation and imagination.  The

mind is a  fascinating creation boundless in power and energy.  It is

multidimensional creating life  in all its forms.  The mind is truly a

wonderful thing when you have mastered its powers  and employ it as the

valuable tool it is. But over and beyond the powers of the mind and  its

realm, lies the power and realm of the Night Soul. There are no greater powers

then those of the Night Soul.  It is your objective, through  Night Magick, to

learn to use and manipulate these powers of the Night Soul for your  benefit.

Through Night Magick, you will learn to travel into the Night Realm while

still here  upon Earth.  You will learn the highest form of healing.  You will

be able to do this  healing for all whom you know.  You will learn to do the

Night Rites to achieve true  magickal progress.  Your progress will be highly

accelerated through the Night Rites.    The ultimate goal of Night Magick is

the achievement of Night Consciousness.


There is no higher goal then this.   The true union with your Oversoul, the

perfection of  Self, this is the consummation of Night Magick.  When you have

achieved Night  Consciousness, you are of greatest service to yourself and the

perfect offering unto the  Night Soul.  I stated before that I would discuss

the modern applications of Night Magick  in today's world.  I have already

covered some of those applications.


You will have good health, less tension and nervousness, and a stronger mind.

You can  use Night Magick at your everyday job. Through Night Magick, you will

develop great  insight that will go a long way in assisting you in problem

solving.  If you are out on the  highway in your car you will be steered clear

of trouble. You will avoid accidents and  traffic problems.  You will be able

to stay in touch with friends and love ones and know  when they are in trouble

or need through Night Magick.   If you have a need then you can  fulfill that

need by using the lore of Night Magick. If you have lost items and wish to

have  them back, then you can do so.  If you need to look forward into the

future and see the  realm of possibilities, then you can do so.  The things

you see are only possibilities and  you can decide whether they will happen or

not.  These are only a few of the many  applications for Night Magick in the

modern world.  The applications are limited only as  your imagination is

limited.  As you learn to see with the foresight and insight that you will

develop through Night Magick, your life will indeed change.


Night Magick will bring you a new way of living.  It will seem to you that

before, you were  only existing.   As I have said, your physical, emotional,

and mental health will vastly  improve. You will become the planner and

controller of your life.  Your physical  surroundings will increase in wealth.

You will also acquire magickal wealth from  practicing Night Magick.


You will gain a deep sense of magickal accomplishment and growth by making it

a part of  your life.  You will become a positive and dynamic force in your

life.  Through Night  Magick, you will leave nothing or no one untouched.

Night Magick, if practiced and lived  with dedication, vigor, and vitality

will achieve all of this.  You must not be mistaken that  all of this will

occur at once.  It will take patience and effort on your part to make it all

happen, but happen it will. One day you will look back on your old life and

wonder how  you ever made it from day to day. But with Night Magick, a new day

dawns in your life.


Before you begin to study Night Magick I want to introduce a special way to

study this  work that will help insure your understanding of the lore and

success as a Night Magician.


4.  How to Study the Lore 


There is a specific way to study the lore of Night Magick.  If you have been

just reading  this book through as any novel, then you have been doing it the

wrong way.  This book is  not a novel which can be read through quickly and

lightly and expect to gain anything  from it. When you study the lore in this

book it must be done one topic at a time.   Also,  each topic must be taken in

order as it appears written in this book.   Do not skip around  in this book

between the different topics.  Each topic was designed to be a building block

upon which to find success in the next topic.  There is more to studying the

lore then just  sitting down and reading.  Your studying will require

self-discipline, patience,  perseverance, and a prescribed technique for

learning. Let's examine that technique for  learning.


To begin with, you must prepare the place that you are going to study in.  If

you study in  the middle of a busy living room with the children shouting and

the TV blaring you aren't  going to retain or accomplish very much.  So to

begin with, you are going to find, what you  will term, your "Magician's

Study".


This is a physical room that you can call your own.  It must be a quiet place

and  somewhere where you can be alone and uninterrupted.  In this room you

will want a place  where you can both sit and lay down as necessary.  This

room will not only be used for  studying but also performing the many

exercises, rites, and practices of Night Magick.   This is your Magician's

Study. Now, you must attend to your own self-preparation.


You must prepare yourself so that you are in the right frame of mind to do

some serious studying.  To get into the proper mood, you should begin by

taking a bath.  This will help  you to relax and wash away the cares and

worries of the day.  If you think of it, your entire  thoughts and emotions

when you come home are filled with the tensions and problems of  work.  The

feeling around you is made up of a problem laden job and world. Literally, a

bath or shower will do a lot to remove this tension and stress from out of

your feelings.   Then you should dress to be comfortable in clean, loose

fitting clothes or your robes that  you will learn to make later. Let's retire

to your study.

  

When you go to your study it should be at approximately the same time of day

each day.   Do this if at all possible.  Then you should sit down in a very

comfortable chair or couch  and relax as much as possible.  When you have

learned to do relaxing exercises and  "Night Breathing" then you should do

these before you begin to read.  For now just relax  and let all the worry and

tension of the day flow away.  Once you are sufficiently relaxed it  is time

to pick-up the book.


As stated earlier, you are going to read each topic in order.  To begin

reading a topic,  read it through the first time quickly and lightly.  The

first time you are only trying to get  the "spirit" of the topic.  Once you

have done this, you will then want to go back and  reread the topic through

carefully and thoroughly insuring that you understand all that you  read.  You

should go slowly being sure that you understand all that you read.  This is

all  that you will do in the first reading.  If there is anything that you

didn't understand the first  time in sitting, don't worry about it, for it

will come to you later.  You are going to read the  same topic on two separate

days.  This is the minimum that anyone should read a topic  through.


The second time in reading, you will want to go just as slow as you did in the

first reading.   If there is anything you still don't understand then just

lightly think upon it and don't  worry. The answer will eventually come to

you.  After the second reading, if there is  anything to practice or do, this

is the time to do it.  Sounds easy doesn't it?


I have just described the minimum anyone should take per topic. You should not

go on to  the next topic until you are very familiar with the information in

the present topic you are studying.  You should understand the current topic

thoroughly and have practiced what is required of you until you are ready to

go on.  Let your inner guide be your judge about  when you are ready to go on.

You will find that you have to continue to practice many of  the first topics

you study each day in order to eventually master them.  Getting all the way

through the book having only read and practiced everything haphazardly will

only insure  that you are master of none.  To insure your success as a Night

Magician in Night Magick,  you must study as has been outlined here.


You must have a room in which you can be alone and uninterrupted. You must

cleanse yourselves of the outer world.  You must study slowly, carefully,and

thoroughly each topic. You will have to continue to go back and study and

practice daily the knowledge and  exercises until you become master of all.

There is no doubt about it and should he none  in your mind that Night Magick

requires study and work.  The results are more then worth  all the time and

energy that you can give to it.  To become a Master in Night Magick; to

become a Night Magician; to reach and obtain Night Consciousness; this is your

goal.  Let  me show you now the life of a Night Magician and all that it

entails in becoming and  being a Night Magician.


CHAPTER  II



THE NIGHT MAGICIAN


5.  Her/His Life 


The life of a Night Magician is a very special one.  You will find that a

Night Magician's  life is filled with the most powerful magick.  Your world

will not be the same after Night  Magick has filled it.   Your life will have

seemed very ordinary and plain before Night  Magick.  Your life will now be

filled with adventure.


When you have elected to live the life of a Night Magician you have chosen to

accept a  way of life that is different than you have so far experienced.  It

is a life filled with study  and practice of Night Magick and the excitement

and adventure that is a direct result.   Night Magick will fulfill for you

your lifelong aspirations.  It will be my job to present the  life of a Night

Magician to you.  I hope when I'm through that you will find it exciting and

want to begin the adventure of becoming a Night Magician.   Let's enter then

into the life  of a Night Magician. The Night Magician's life is filled with

study and practice of the Night Magick lore.  As you study and practice, the

Oversoul will examine and test your accomplishments.  No matter  who you are,

you came here to gain experience and grow from it.  But upon accepting the

Night Magician's way of life the trials will increase in both number and

intensity.  It is not  that the lore found in this book is difficult, but that

in accepting this life the Night Magician  is tested by life so that s/he may

put into practice Night Magick.  The Night Magician's life  is going to be

filled with many trials.


This is not out of cruelty but out of necessity.   The trials are set upon the

Magician to  build magickal strength and depth in the use of Night Magick.

Every test in the  Magician's life is to build magickal stature and to

increase it once passed.  No matter  whether the test is overcoming a

difficult financial situation, or the working through of a  difficult

marriage, or the death of a loved one, the tests are there to help the Night

Magician grow. If the Night Magician falls then there is nothing else for

her/him to do but  get up, dust off the knees, and keep going knowing that the

next time when faced with a  similar situation success will come. When you

accept the life of a Night Magician there  will be trials and hardships.  But

if you are willing to accept the difficulties and meet the  challenge then you

will not be overcome by them.


You will find solutions to these trials through your knowledge of Night

Magick.  Through  Night Magick, you will raise your magickal vibration and

grow closer to the Oneness of  your Oversoul.  It is through this Oneness, and

the power that flows from it and through  you, that you will be able to handle

these increased tests.  You are learning to become  the Oversoul in all that

you say and do.  No matter what the test, you must meet it in the  Night

Consciousness of your Oversoul.   Through this continual testing, and the

placing of  yourself in the Conscience of your Oversoul, you will become One

with IT.  Thus you will  have passed the final test on Earth and have achieved

the One Goal.  You will have  achieved Night Consciousness.  The Night

Magician's life is thus marked by training and  testing.  But her/his life is

not all training and testing.  For out of this training and testing  will come

adventure.


The Night Magician will travel new avenues of adventure that were never there

before.    The tests the Night Magician receives will take her/him to unusual

places and there will  be experiences that can only be described as exciting

and wonderful.  The Night Magician  will experience new levels of physical

well-being and sexual vitality.  S/he will experience  new job challenges and

opportunities as part of using Night Magick.  There will be  emotional and

mental experiences that break through the limited ways of feelings and

thinking of old.  The Night Magician will experience increases of personal

wealth.   The  Night Magician's life will become aflame with purpose.


That purpose may not always be easy to identify at first, but the Magician

will feel it none  the less, deep within.  Ultimately, through the Night

Magician's way of life, s/he will come  to know that purpose and become it.

The Night Magician is in command of her/his life.   S/he sets the trail where

others will follow.  The Night Magician must grab hold onto life  and in

everything that s/he says and does must express the Night Soul.  The Night

Magician's life is filled with purpose and it is through that purpose that

s/he will unfold  her/his Night Powers.  The Night Magician's purpose is

her/his dream.  It is what s/he  must do while s/he is upon the Earth plane.

But that purpose and dream will set her/him  apart from those adrift on the

sea.


The Night Magician must overcome loneliness as a result of it. S/he must

overcome the misunderstanding of others and press on. There will be many

unbelievers in this world for there are many lost in the Yang matrix, but s/he

must ignore them and all else that  interferes with the dream.  But if the

Night Magician is truly dedicated and willing to  sacrifice for the dream, if

s/he believes in her/himself and the Night Soul within and  expresses only

that Soul, then the Night Magician's dream will manifest itself into the

world.  That dream is the Will of the Oversoul and it will appear into the

world.  The Night  Magician's life is marked by purpose, dedication,

sacrifice, determination, and darkest  love.  The Night Magician's life is

darkest magic of the highest kind.  It is magick that  produces deepest joy

and happiness in the Night Magician's life.  It is the magick of the  Oversoul

on Earth.  The Night Magician's life is aimed at becoming the Oversoul in all

that  is done.  Imagine a life that is filled with nothing but the Nightsoul.


In you, as a Night Magician, the Power and Absolute Love of the Oversoul comes

to its  fullest. When that Power and Absolute Love flows through you and into

the lives of those  around you and on out into the world itself nothing can

remain as it was before.  Everything that the Night Power touches shall be

made anew.  It shall shine with an  Amethyst/Emerald Light Divine. This is the

Night Magick of the Oversoul.  This is Magick  of the Highest Order and it is

in the Night Magician's life.  Here you have some of the  beautiful facets of

the life of a Night Magician.


Her/his life is marked by trials and testing.  This is not meant to discourage

you but to  show the true picture to all would-be Night Magicians.  If you are

to become a Night  Magician then you must truly understand all that is

involved and be willing to give all that  it takes.  It will take

determination, courage, fortitude, and intuition in all the seemingly

hardships.  It will take this to be able to grasp from the lore the knowledge

required and to  put it into practice; to become a Night Magician. The Night

Magician's life is study, training, practice, and being tested.  But the Night

Magician's life is much more.  It is life filled with happiness and joy.  It

is filled with inner peace and absolute love.  It is filled with adventure and

excitement. It is a life filled with success.  The Night Magician is truly in

command of her/his life.    S/he is the Oversoul in action.  This way of life

is all that the Night Magician ever cares to know. Her/his goals for  this

life are all that matters.  These goals are the Night Magician's life and

Night Magick  will ensure the success of achieving these goals.  The life of a

Night Magician is a very  special one.  I would like you to travel with me now

on the roadway the apprentice must  follow to become a Night Magician.


6.  The Apprentice's Unfoldment.   


What I want to do now is draw for you a road map that will take you down the

road of  Night Magick.  The road ahead of you is easy to get lost on just look

at others around you.   If you are going to effectively follow the Night

Magick road you must have signs and  landmarks to guide you and tell you how

far you have come. In the next topic, I will  discuss your final destination,

Night Consciousness.  So let's begin our journey on the  Night Road.


From the beginning of the first descent into material creation, from the first

sojourn on  Earth, it will take many sojourns before one is ready to enter the

Night Road.   There are  many people who are not ready for it.   Their minds

are so preoccupied with doing things  the Yang way, they are so lost in doing

things the hard way, that they have no time for  their own magickal growth.

They are so lost in the illusion of the material world and its  limitations

that they can not see beyond it.  You can see why it will take so many people

hundreds of lives before they can see beyond the illusion of this world and

learn to use  Night Magick in overcoming its so-called limitations.  I should

state from the onset of this  work that there are very few paths or roads

which lead to truly achieving your goals and  overcoming the world of

illusion.  There are many paths dedicated to the Yang Spirit  which is a road

of limitation, hardship, self-denial, and poverty.  It is a path that runs

counter to the Soul and Spirit within you.  I have tried to present here a

road to Night  Consciousness which is simple in nature and language.  It is a

road that requires  persistence, study, courage, boldness, and self-discipline

to travel but the goals you will  achieve on the way and your final attainment

of the ultimate goal makes it all worth while.    There is no way of telling

how long it will take to reach the ultimate goal.


You may be able to reach it in this lifetime or it may take many lifetimes.

Much will  depend upon your aptitude for Night Magick and your dedication and

effort.  It isn't  necessary to reach the ultimate goal in one life.  There

will be many goals and great  changes in your life to make traveling the road

more than worthwhile.  Once you have  entered the Night Road, then life after

life you will return to this world taking up where you  last left off.  This

is because a simple decision to enter the Night Road does not mean that  you

will be accepted and are on your way.


The Night Soul looks for those who are ready to travel the road. You must want

to be on  the road that leads to your Night Soul more than anything else in

your life.  There must be  nothing more important in your life then being on

the road and the desire to achieve your  goals and the ultimate goal.  This

decision must be more then a mental thought.  This  decision must be backed by

action on your part.  Not only do you feel this intense desire  to be on the

Night Road but you are willing to begin the work necessary to achieve it.  In

Night Magick, you will have begun this work by beginning to read and put into

practice the  lore found in this book.  There is no way of determining how

long it will take to be  accepted on the Night Road.  But rest assured, if you

are truly sincere about entering the  road and are willing to do the work then

you will be accepted.   You are the beginner, the  apprentice, on the roadway

to the Night Soul.  Acceptance on the Night Road is no small  thing.

Acceptance on the road is your first landmark and is clearly marked.


In Night Magick, you are an "Earth Apprentice".  You have reached the first

landmark and gained entrance upon the Night Road.  At this point your Oversoul

will begin to take an  active interest in you.  Upon your acceptance, the

Oversoul actively enters into your life.   You will begin to feel the

beginnings of Night Power. You will have the beginning of  increased Oversoul

Power flowing into your life.  But how will you know when you have  been

accepted?


As said before, this acceptance is clearly marked.   You will undergo an

experience that  will definitely let you know you have become an Earth

Apprentice.  For example, you may  in the quiet of your Magician's Study, or

as you are falling asleep some night, suddenly  see the image of the Oversoul

in deep hues of Emerald, Amethyst, Midnight Blue and/or  Silver before you.

As you continue to watch the image of your Oversoul it will start to  come

towards you.  As the Oversoul comes closer, you suddenly know that you are the

Oversoul and Its Face is your face, and the Oversoul enters inside you, and

you feel a  deep, warm glow and power radiating from within.   You know that

the birth of the  Oversoul has taken place within and that you are an Earth

Apprentice.  As an Earth  Apprentice you have become the Night Child.


I refer to the Earth Apprentice as a Night Child for at the time of acceptance

you have  been given birth into the Night World. You are now a Magickal Child

of the Night Spirit.   Your Oversoul will gain new radiance and added power by

actively entering into  cooperation with you.  That new radiance will be seen

by the Watchers and reported to  the Night Guild.  Your acceptance upon the

Night Road heralds your entrance into the  Night Guild.


This Guild is composed of all beings who serve the Dark Light of the Night

Spirit.  The members of the Guild exist both in Higher Dimensions and upon all

material planets.    The highest members of the Guild serve as Teachers and

Directors of the Omniverse  everywhere. One group of members serve as Teachers

and Directors over the Earth.   In  Night Magick, I will refer to them as the

Night Teachers.  I have done this because they  have risen far in magickal

evolution and are One with the Night Soul.  As a new Earth  Apprentice, you

are watched over by a Night Teacher who chooses to do so based on  compatible

nature and vibration.   The assistance of the Night Teacher is one of

watchfulness and occasional guidance as you, the Earth Apprentice, begins to

journey on  the Night Road.  But as you continue to demonstrate your

willingness and dedication to  the road you've chosen, and to the Will of your

Oversoul, the relation between you and the  Night Teacher deepens.   When the

Night Teacher is ready and has determined you are  ready, then you will be

accepted by the Night Teacher as Her/His Chela.


The relationship between the Night Teacher and Her/His chela is a very special

one.  The  Night Teacher gives Her/His continual guidance, support, and power

to the new chela.   The Night Teacher shares Her/His very nature with Her/His

new chela.  The chela may call  upon the assistance of the Night Teacher at

anytime and it will be answered.  Yet the  chela must remember that s/he is

the beginner and that the Will of the Night Teacher  should always be

followed.  The Night Teacher and the Oversoul of the chela work very  closely

together to achieve what must be done by the Oversoul.  The Night Teacher and

chela are as Mother/Father and Daughter/Son.  They share and create in the

Night Power  and Guild.  How will you know though who your Night Teacher is?


There are many ways in which this may come about.  You may meet Her/Him in

your  dreams, or more rarely, S/he may come to you in your waking hours.  For

many of you,  you will just know through your sixth sense.  You will come to

know intuitively who your  Night Teacher is. I will go into greater depth

about the Night Teachers in the later part of  this book.   Do not be worried

or concerned about who the Night Teacher is in your life.   S/he will choose

you and guide you and you should feel secure in this matter.  S/he will

reveal Her/Himself to you in Her/His own time. At this point you are now

progressing upon  the Night Road.


Your first subject area to master in Night Magick will be Earth Magick.   Not

only will you learn a great deal about the Earth and its Magickal Energies and

Power but you will also  be altering physically and magickally.  When you have

achieved sufficient growth and  mastery in this area of Earth Magick you will

be ready for the second landmark.  If you  looked at the last landmark as the

birth of the Oversoul in the your world, as your  becoming the Magickal Child,

then this is "you the Oversoul" as a teenager. Here you  have been transformed

from the Earth Apprentice to the Water Apprentice.


You will begin your study of Water Magick.  This is the area of Night Magick

related to the emotions and astral world. As a Water Apprentice, you will

experience an ever greater increase of the Power of the  Night Soul.  You will

undergo increased emotional development.  You will be given  experiences that

will strengthen that emotional development.  As a Water Apprentice, you  will

gain the ability to know Truth in all Its forms and use that in your everyday

world.  You  will also begin to learn control over your emotions.  The Night

Magician needs emotional  control in order to wield Night Magick effectively.

The power you will be able to wield  without emotional control could do

incredible damage which you may later regret.  The  Night Magician must be

master of her/his emotions not the other way around.  One point I  should

cover is that concerning the aura. Until I go into more detail about it later,

accept for now, that there is an energy that  completely surrounds your body

and extends beyond it about one to three feet.  This  energy field is called

an aura.  The aura reflects emotions and thoughts in people.   The  aura is

made up of swirling energy currents and through magickal sight the aura can be

seen as colors.  All of this you will cover in greater depth in later topics.

In the average  person, the colors that comprise the aura are various and

many.  In the Earth Apprentice,  the color that is predominate in the aura is

green.  In the Water Apprentice, the aura will  be of a light blue.  This is

another indicator of when you have been accepted on the road.   The aura, as

an indicator, will help you further in identification of the next landmark.

You  have seen the things that you must accomplish, or be in the process of

accomplishing, in  order to achieve the next landmark.  You have studied Water

Magick and developed and  strengthened your emotional stature.   When you have

traveled far enough on the Night  Road another landmark appears before you.

You are about to undergo another  transformation and become the Air

Apprentice.


Here you have entered the "Oversoul as a very young adult" stage. The emphasis

as an Air Apprentice is upon mastering Air Magick or Magick of the Mind.   You

will be studying Air Magick and undergo mental training.   You will be

developing  what in Air Magick is known as the Mental Body.  Your studies in

Night Magick will help  develop the Mental Body.  During this phase of life

you may also attend some advance  education or training in the world.   The

mind is a powerful instrument and its training is  critical in Night Magick.

You will be merging your mind with the Higher Mind of the  Oversoul.  This

will lead you to the last part of your journey to becoming a Night Magician.

The last landmark is ahead and you find yourself traveling through Fire.


Here you are the young adult Oversoul.  You are the Fire Apprentice.  Your

studies are of  Fire Magick.  Fire Magick is the Realm of the Oversoul.  It is

the studies of the Higher  Mind and Causal Body.  You now are learning and

using the Night Powers of the  Oversoul.   The power that flows through your

life will be like nothing you have so far  experienced.  This is the time when

you will be reaching adulthood in the Oversoul.  You  will be achieving

oneness with the Oversoul and there will no longer be a you and the  Oversoul.

You are about to become a true channel through which the Night Power will

flow without impediment.  To experience the Night Realm of Fire is to know

life without  time or space.  It is being everywhere and every time.  It is

knowing and seeing all that  has ever been, is, and will be: and as the Silent

Watcher and Observer seeing it all  unfold.  It is like standing amongst the

sea of stars and knowing that this is all that you  are.  It is feeling and

being a part of unlimited darkness and absolute love. This is  perhaps the

longest part of the journey.  There is much to study, experience, and develop

into.   But finally like all journeys, this one comes to an end. And at the

end of the Night  Road, you are no longer an Apprentice but a Night Magician.


You and the Oversoul are One.  You are the mature, adult Oversoul on Earth.

Words only  tend to limit the experience of this achievement.  The Night Power

that you now feel is so  great that you have trouble controlling it as it

surges through your material being.  This  experience can never be adequately

described by words but must be lived to be known.   This is the point which

hails the complete union of the Higher and lower selves.  The  Oversoul and

you are now One to the greatest possible extent.  The Causal body is now

shared as One by the Oversoul and you.   A person with magickal sight of

sufficient  advancement will see a fully developed Causal Body with the full

and active Presence of  the Oversoul within it.  The aura will glow with an

intense deep amethyst/silver glow.  You  and the Oversoul share Its Powers and

capabilities jointly. You are One and Inseparable  in Consciousness and Action

with the Oversoul.   You have experienced everything that  you must in life.

You are now free of Karma.  This is the last material vehicle you will  have

to express through on Earth.  You are the master of the lower worlds.  You

know the  cycles of birth and rebirth and know the happiness at having

completed the need to ever  undergo the cycle again.   You are free from life

that ends in death.  You have become all  knowledge, power, wisdom, and

control of the Oversoul.  Is your journey really over?


No, not really.  There will always be a perfecting process going on.  There

will always be  new heights to climb and greater understanding to be achieved.

What is included in this  book as Night Magick is really only the "tip of the

iceberg".  But you will always enjoy  your continued travels and adventures on

the Night Road.  There will always be new  things to discover.  There will

always be new adventures and excitement on the Night  Road. I have done my

best to guide you this far on the Night Road.


I want you to understand that this map is not set in concrete. The general

course has been  laid out for you but the time you take to travel on the road

and the tests and experiences  you will undergo are known only to the

Oversoul.  Sometimes you may detour slightly into  another area of magick and

that's ok as long as it is the Will of the Oversoul.  I would like  now to

help you understand the Consciousness of the Oversoul.  I call it Night

Consciousness and it is what you will ultimately achieve.



7.  Night Consciousness 


There are countless numbers of Souls in creation.   The Soul, that is your

Oversoul, is  unique throughout the Omniverse.  The consciousness of the

Oversoul is separated from  the consciousness of the human being.  It is

possible for the two consciousness to join.   This union of consciousness I

refer to as Night Consciousness.  I am going to explore with  you the inner

depths of Night Consciousness.  You will discover things that you will have

to do in order to attain it.  You will learn to live and practice it and the

changes that will  take place within you as you start to acquire it.  First

though, we are going to examine, in  greater detail, exactly what Night

Consciousness is.


Night Consciousness, in humankind, is a state of causal, mental, emotional,

and physical being.  It is becoming the Oversoul in each of these states of

being.  It is reaching the  greatest possible state of perfection while here

on Earth.  The Causal body is to the  Overself what the physical/etheric body

is to humankind.  Its lowest vibrational body.


The Causal Body is the storehouse for the experiences of countless lifetimes

in  incarnation. The Overself experiences life from its dimension through the

Causal Body  just as we experience physical life through the physical body.

When you have achieved  Night Consciousness you will be able to consciously

use the Causal Body.  You will be  able to directly tap into awareness of the

Oversoul.  This will directly effect your mental  being.


Mentally, you must achieve all that the Oversoul is.  It is your mental

development and attitude which will carry you into this Magickal

Consciousness.  When you have mentally  set your sights upon your goal and

give it all that you possible have, then you will bring it  into manifestation

within you.  Night Consciousness is mentally being aware of all  knowledge and

wisdom of the Oversoul.  You will know, whatever it is that you must know  by

simply tapping into it.  You will have supreme wisdom for all situations

knowing just  what and how to do it. You may have never studied the subject

before but the knowledge  will be there when you need it. You will have

tremendous willpower and concentration.   This is Night Consciousness in

humankind.  Night Consciousness is more then just a  mental state.  It is also

your emotional state of being.


It fills your world of feeling and changes it to perfection.  It is having

perfect  understanding of all situations.  It is the giving of perfect,

absolute love.  This is love  beyond the human state that enters you into the

absolute state of being.  More on this in a  later topic.  The emotional state

in Night Consciousness is one of silence and profound  solitude.  It is a high

state of reflection and receptivity.   It is also a state of aggression,

boldness, and daring.  Night Consciousness is an emotional state of passion,

courage  and love of pleasure and ease.


This Consciousness even descends into the physical state of being.  Your

bodies become  pure, Night Energy through Night Consciousness.  The body

becomes the perfect channel  through which the Oversoul may flow out into the

world.  Night Consciousness is perfect  control and mastery of the physical

being.  This is Night Consciousness in the four  aspects of humankind. Night

Consciousness is many things to humankind.


It is a state of bliss and peace that humankind has yet to know. It is a state

of perfect knowledge, wisdom, absolute love, understanding, innocence,

happiness, joy, and  freedom.  It is a state of awareness that words can not

do justice to.  Words only tend to  diminish the real understanding of the

nature of Night Consciousness.   Yet I have made  the attempt to do so in

hopes that you would have a better understanding of what it is.   Night

Consciousness is the goal of life on Earth.  It is a goal worth giving your

all in  dedication, devotion, and determination to in reaching it.  Therefore,

let's see exactly  what you will have to do in reaching the Bliss of Night

Consciousness.


The things necessary to do, to reach Night Consciousness, may at first seem to

overwhelm you. There is a great deal to accomplish if you want to reach it.

But you  should not be scared by the number of things you must accomplish, nor

by the feeling that  some of them seem impossible for you to do.   Nothing

that is described here will be  impossible for you to do if you will be

determined and persistent in your efforts.  To begin  you must master the

physical body.


Its alright to indulge the physical body with food, pampering and passion.  At

the same  time, you must also balance this with physical training to maintain

physical well-being.   The body is essential to every Night Magician for it is

the channel through which Night  Magick flows and alters the world.  Take care

of it. Much of the knowledge you will gain  will slowly alter the human body

changing its frequency into harmony with the Night  Force. As the body changes

you will be able to increase the flow of the Night Force  through you.  Do

everything in balance. You must become masters of your emotional life.


From the onset of studying Night Magick you will experience emotions.  It is

alright to experience and even use the emotions in Night Magick.  But at all

times, you must be in  control them. You must not be ruled by jealousy, lust,

pride, or selfishness. You must  control anger and hatred.  These things will

still try to enter into your feelings but you will  gain instant control over

them.   You must remain in control under all conditions.  No  matter how

disturbing the current challenges in your life you must remain centered.   You

must also maintain a balanced mind.


Your mind must always be centered in the silence of the Night. There is great

power in  the silence of the Mind.  Your mind should be fixed in

self-discipline and strong-willed.   Your mind must be fixed in intellectual

pursuit and critical thinking.  You must maintain  original and independent

thinking at all times. You will be inventive and versatile in your  thinking.

Your mind set must be one of persistence, patience and persevering.  Your

mind will at times be required to act in a reserved and cautious manner and at

other times  courageous, bold, and gallant. Flexibility to meet the ever

changing challenges is the key  of Night Consciousness. You must be temperate,

wise, and poised in all things.  These  are just a few of the things necessary

for you to reach Night Consciousness.


They are not easy to master.   Yet they must be mastered and put actively into

your life.   You must live and practice Night Consciousness from the very

beginning.  This topic is  placed early in the book because it is the first

thing which you will have to learn and begin  practicing in Night Magick.  If

you are to have any success at all in Night Magick, you will  have to practice

and master this topic.  In all other subjects you will study and master in

this book, Night Consciousness is of the most importance.   It will bring you

success in all  other things you attempt in Night Magick.  How then do you

practice and live Night  Consciousness?


To begin, you must live the life of the Oversoul.  You must be consciously

aware of the  Night Power that flows through you from your Oversoul.

Everywhere you go, you must  constantly remain in the Consciousness of the

Oversoul.  You must know that you are the  Oversoul and radiate Night Power.

You must speak and act as the Oversoul.  You must  gain a very special

attitude towards life.   You must learn to be in the world but not of it.

You must not become lost in the illusions of limitations.  With the aid of

Night Magick you  will want for nothing but at the same time you must never

allow material possessions to  possess you.  Your magickal life must be

balanced by your practical life.  You must give  each part of your life equal

time.  Your practical life should be filled with your magickal  nature.  You

must learn to take each day, one at a time.  It is wrong to worry about

tomorrow for in Night Consciousness your destiny of success is assured.  You

must learn  to obey your Oversoul as you would yourself for in reality you and

the Oversoul are One.   All of your needs will be taken care of through Night

Consciousness. That doesn't mean  you can just sit back and do nothing.  You

must give your full effort to life but without  worry or concern about your

future.  If you are following the Night Road to Night  Consciousness, then the

outcome is clear.  There is also one other thing that you can do  to enhance

your attaining Night Consciousness until you become more adept in Night

Magick.


In your pursuit of Night Consciousness you will be greatly benefitted if you

will get out into  the outdoors as much as possible.  The beauty, peace, and

power of nature will do much  in restoring and helping to maintain your

Oversoul Nature.  The Earth is a storehouse of  Night Energy and by your

visits to those places where the Earth has been relatively  untouched you will

be able to absorb the Night Energy.  If you begin to practice what I just

covered and continue to study and practice Night Magick then you will

eventually reach  Night Consciousness.  But only your Oversoul knows all the

things necessary for you to do  to reach Night Consciousness and the time

required to do so.  So you must be untiring in  your efforts to reach it and

know that it will come.  You must come to know that there is no  separation in

Consciousness between you and your Oversoul.  There are signs which will

indicate to you that you are starting to approach Night Consciousness.


There are changes that will take place within you all along the road to your

final  destination. These changes will help reassure you that you are making

progress.  One of  the first significant changes in your life will be a new

powerful inner vibration.


You will become charged with a new zest for life.  The Oversoul Power will

flow through  you and raise every cell in your body in a glorious fire.  You

will find you will need less  sleep and yet your energy will remain very high.

You will find that your health will be  greatly improved and that your

breathing will come much easier.  Your body will become  the Body of your

Oversoul.  You will find yourselves growing more in the ways of the  Silver

Rule.  You may do anything that you want if you always maintain the Eternal

Night  Balance.  You will begin to hear an Inner Voice who will be your

instructor and guardian.   This Inner Voice will be that of your Oversoul

and/or Night Teacher who will guide you and  care for you.  This will cause

you to develop flashes of intuition.  These brief moments of  insight should

be carefully listened to and followed.  If you do, then the help will continue

to come to you.  You will find that your knowledge seems to increase within

you.  You will  gain an understanding of things that you never seemed to

understand before.  You will  instinctively seem to know what to do about a

particular problem. For example, if your car  breaks down you will know almost

immediately what is wrong with it and if possible, how  to repair it.  You

will also come to know Truth from untruth.  It doesn't matter whether that

source originates from a person, reading material, or whatever, you will know

whether  what is said is True or not.  Nothing will be able to hide from your

inner knowing and  vision.  This is also about the time when your lower

psychic abilities and faculties start to  open up.  You will learn a great

deal about them later in the book.  They will give you  abilities and powers

beyond that of other people.  Therefore you must be careful in using  them

such that the Eternal Night Balance is always maintained.  Do not worry about

these  centers for now in a later topic you will be given what you need to

maintain control. You will feel a greater need for solitude and a time away

from people.  There are more  indications of approaching Night Consciousness

and you will learn more about them as  you continue your studies of Night

Magick.  Remember, Night Consciousness is a  physical, emotional, mental, and

causal development. You know some of the things to concentrate on to help

develop this consciousness.  As I  just said you will learn more of the

essentials to help develop this consciousness as you  learn Night Magick.

You have also learned some of the indicators of your developing  Night

Consciousness and when you finally reach it you will know it.  What is

required is  effort, dedication, persistence, self-discipline and study.  With

all this, you will achieve  Night Consciousness. Combined with Night Magick

there won't be a thing you can't  achieve.  Your imagination and dreams are

the only limits in Night Magick.  From this  point in your study of Night

Magick, I would like to go over the principles upon which a  Night Magician's

life is based.


CHAPTER III



BEGINNING NIGHT MAGICK


8.  Standards and Principles of Practicing Night Magick 


You are about to embark on the Night Road of learning Night Magick and

achieving Night Consciousness.  There are certain standards and practices

which you must include in  your life while on the Road.  I have covered a few

of them already but I will go into greater  depth over some of them and cover

some additional standards and principles to insure  your success.


The Silver Rule (silver being a precious metal to the Night Force) is "you may

do anything  that you want if you always maintain the Eternal Night Balance".

The Eternal Night  Balance is a fundamental law of the Night Force.  Balance

in the Omniverse is a vital  factor to order within the Eternal Night. For

everything you take from the Eternal Night you  must give back to the Eternal

Night in equal measure.  This does not mean of course that  if through Night

Magick, using the energy of the Night Force, you acquire wealth that you  must

give money back to the Night Force.  It means that the amount of energy used

to  accomplish something must be returned in full.  This keeping of the

Eternal Night Balance  is an intuitive matter that is easy to maintain when

working within Night Consciousness.    Therefore, before using Night Magick to

accomplish any event, always work within the  consciousness of the Oversoul to

be able to maintain the Balance.  There also follows  another major principle

within which you must practice Night Magick.  This is the "Law of  Night

Magick".

  

The Law of Night Magick is "there is nothing impossible when you are One with

the Night Force".  I mean absolutely nothing. Always remember this fundamental

law and believe it  with all your might.  Remember that everything you do in

life is Night Magick. It should be  done in Night Consciousness.  Your whole

life is now an expression of Night Magick and Consciousness.  There is nothing

you cannot do.   I'd like to turn for the moment to the principles governing

the Night Magician and the world as a whole.


You will find the world to be rather hostile to you concerning Night Magick.

The religions  of the world are predominantly Yang. The majority of people

have been conditioned to  respond in a Yang manner.  Yang and Yin are opposite

forces which do not mix well.  From Night Consciousness's view, each soul is

responsible for its own world.  Each soul  determines much of its life and the

quality of that life before coming here.  There is some  predestination in all

lives yet there is much which is not.  If individuals are poor and/or

homeless then this gives the Oversoul that experience.  If souls are wealthy

then that is  another experience.  This world offers a myriad of different

experiences for the Oversoul  to live and experience.   The Oversoul lives

many lives on Earth in order to get a well-rounded education.  The Earth can

be a very rough school and souls here are  experiencing in essence the first

grade of life.  When the Oversoul has experienced all  the lessons it deems

necessary then It moves on to a new world with more advanced  lessons to be

learned.   This system is called reincarnation and is very difficult for much

of the world to except.


They would rather explain much of the world's problems and their own as the

fault of  someone else.  The Christians blame Satan for the ills of the world.

There are many  people who blame their government.   Others blame other people

and their not caring  about their fellow human. The Night Magician blames no

one.


The Night Magician knows that her/his beginnings on this planet are chosen

from the  other side of life.  S/he chooses her/his parents, race, sex,

country, and many of the future  events before arriving to insure that the

necessary lessons for this life are achieved.  It  may sound terrible but a

woman may actually chose to be raped in order to gain that  experience and

learn from it.  There are children born bad.  They are souls who  previously

raped, murdered, robbed, etc. and are returning little changed from their

previous lives.  Human souls are not born innocent regardless of how innocent

that baby  looks in her/his cradle. They have lived before on Earth and are

returning little changed  from when they last lived on Earth.  They are a

bundle of possibilities and potentials and  already have the beginnings of

personality for this life.  You arrive the same way but as a  Night Magician

you must take charge of your life. If you don't like it then change it.  Use

Night Magick to alter your world.  Some parts of life  are predestined but

many are not. The free times feel like your adrift on a sea without  much

direction.  This is the time to chose a new direction.  You shouldn't get

involved in  changing all the world's ills.


I believe someone said before that there will always be the poor and hungry.

This is true because this world requires those experiences for a certain group

of souls.  There will  always be crime because there will always be others who

want what someone else has.   There are experiences of hardship, suffering,

crime, poverty, hunger, divorce, physical  and sexual abuse, and a thousand

more like it.  There are experiences of wealth, fame,  comfort, peace, happy

marriage, beautiful children, successful career, and a thousand  more like it,

too.  The Oversoul needs all these experience possibilities.  The Night

Magician chooses her/his experiences and controls them through Night Magick.

The  Night Magician knows that the rest of the world chooses their experiences

too and lives  them the best they can so that the Oversoul may gain

experience.  Help the other soul  when led by your Oversoul to do so.  But

have no guilt, nor interfere in another soul's  existence, when in Night

Consciousness you know that what they are experiencing is  necessary.  The

practice of Night Magick requires that the affairs of your world move with  a

steady, even pace.


There is no set limit as to how fast this pace may be.  Setting limits upon

pace is a  relative matter.  But the pace must be even and steady.  Do not

become so embroiled in  the everyday routines of the hustling, bustling world

that your world is conducted without  Night Magick. You must have a magickal

attitude while in the world.  You must keep your  consciousness raised above

the mire and limitations of the world.  You must approach life  with passion

and zest.


In Night Consciousness, life is an adventure. Life is usually made up of one

adventure  after another.  Everything that has happened to you is a type of

adventure that requires  your use of Night Magick to see it through.   There

are adventures which you may feel  have had an unhappy ending.  Perhaps that

ending did not have to occur with the use of  Night Magick.  If you are in the

Night Flow and something bad seems to have happened  perhaps there was a

reason.  Use Night Magick to find out.   Use Night Magick to correct  the

situation.  Do all this in Night Consciousness. There will be times when you

must  approach life with courage, boldness, and energy.    There will be other

times when you  must use caution, prudence, and reflection. Approach life from

Night Consciousness and  you will always know what to do.  In Night

Consciousness, life is art.


You are the Night Magician.  You are the artist.  Create!  Create any kind of

life you want.   Your imagination is the limit.  Fill your life with passion

and love.  Fill your life with honor, dignity, and pride in the works you

create.  As the artist be inventive and imaginative in  what you create as

your life.  If you want wealth that is fine.  If you want pleasure and  ease

that is fine.  Remember, Night Balance in what you create.  The Night Magician

operates from a point of solitude.


The Night Magician is a solitary worker.  This doesn't mean you won't have

friends.  You  may be a very active person socially with many friends.  You

can even practice Night  Magick collectively in groups.  But ultimately, the

Night Magician is a solitary worker.  The  Night Magician must achieve mastery

in Night Magick and Night Consciousness on  her/his own.  No one else can do

this for you.  I can show you how to practice Night  Magick and give you the

keys to obtaining Night Consciousness but I can't bestow upon  you, mastery in

Night Magick or Night Consciousness.  This you must do on your own with

study, self- discipline, effort and energy.


Night Magick is for those willing to pursue knowledge.  It takes knowledge not

faith to  become a Night Magician.  It takes a lover of independent thinking.

One who is free of  convention and is not a sheep in the world.  It takes

mental precision and intelligence to  master Night Magick. It will require

will power and perseverance to overcome obstacles  when they show up.  You

must learn control of thoughts.  You will hear this over and over,  "thoughts

are things".  I don't know who first said this but remember it.  If you think

thoughts of poverty then guess what, you are poor.  If you wish some one dead,

even idly,  then they may die.   Through Night Magick, thoughts become things

with purpose.  Learn  control of your thoughts from the onset. Emotions are

also part of this.


Emotions add energy to thoughts.  So you must also learn to control emotions.

Emotions,  like thoughts, are energy and energy changes the world around you.

I am not limiting any  thoughts or emotions from your world.  You are free to

think and feel anything you want.   But remember, thoughts and emotions will

change the world around you and you are  responsible for those changes.  Keep

the Eternal Night Balance.  Remember the Silver  Rule and you will have no

problems.   You need to take care of your physical body.


Night Magicians come in all shapes and sizes.  There are no requirements in

this area.   What is important is the physical body is the ultimate channel

through which the Night  Force flows out into the world.  You need to keep

that channel as in tuned with the Night  Force as possible. You will learn

techniques to do this shortly.  Try to maintain oneness  with your Oversoul

and the Night Force by keeping them in your thoughts and emotions at  all

time.  This will help maintain the balance.   It is alright to smoke, eat, and

provide the  body with physical pleasure. But balance is again important to

your practicing Night  Magick.  You can't practice Night Magick if you die of

overeating, heart attack, or cancer.   You will learn to control your thoughts

and emotions to help prevent these things.  But if  you go too far one way

then all your knowledge won't help if the body can't act as a  channel for the

Night Force.  Balance pleasure with physical exercise, breathing  exercises

with smoking, and right thoughts and emotions that will control the stress and

pressures in your life.  I want to talk to you about drugs.


Their use is a very popular thing.  In the right hands drugs can be very

beneficial to  human health.  Magickally, drugs have been used to induce

certain mental and emotional  states.  In the case of Night Magick, DON'T USE

THEM!  Drugs have more then a physical  effect.  They alter the etheric,

astral, and mental bodies. Drugs can do severe damage to  these bodies that

may take many "lifetimes" to repair.  I assure you that there is nothing

drugs can do for you that Night Magick can't do for you.  There is no high or

altered state  that Night Magick can't achieve for you. Drugs can so alter

your many bodies that by using Night Magick you will place yourself in danger

of losing your physical life. Moreover, you may lose your emotional and mental

stability that will require hospitalization.   So far, I have not limited you

in thought or  action in this book.  But in this case, be warned.  Do not use

drugs.  If you are using  prescription drugs under a physician's care and they

severely alter your state of being  then for that time don't practice Night

Magick.  Wait till you no longer need the drugs.   Under drugs I am also

including alcohol. On occasion you may feel like getting drunk.  As  you

progress in Night Consciousness you will eventually be able to drink and not

get  drunk.  For most, that is a long time from now. Drinking, to a lesser

degree, alters the  physical, etheric, astral, and mental bodies.   The

effects are usually not as damaging  unless you overdose on alcohol.  Drinking

in moderation is fine. There is nothing wrong  with an occasional drink.  For

some though, an occasional drink becomes overuse of  alcohol which ultimately

will have the same effect as non-alcohol drugs. Again, do not  practice Night

Magick while under the influence of alcohol regardless of the amount of

alcohol.  It has the same possible effect as non-alcohol drugs.   Let's go on

to sex.


In today's world one usually talks about sex after talking about drugs.  Sex

is great.  With  Night Magick, sex is going to become fantastic.  The energy

that is going to flow through  you during orgasm will give you the ultimate

orgasms of your life.   There are though  some rules that apply to this area.


It should be obvious that you must practice "safe sex".  The male should use a

condom  and the woman should be sure he uses it.  No matter how close you are

to your spouse or  circle of friends unless you're sure of their monogamy, men

use condoms.   Women  should also use contraceptives to prevent pregnancy. Men

should learn how to put on  condoms to insure they don't break and never use

petroleum products that will cause the  latex to break.  Women should also

know how to put a condom on a man to insure the  man does it right.  You may

find that as you increase in Night Consciousness and the flow  of the Night

Force increases that the only time you will achieve those ultimate orgasms is

when the partner is also practicing Night Magick.


In Night Magick, concerning sex, it doesn't matter whether the couple is

heterosexual,  male- male, female-female.  It doesn't matter if the couple act

alone.  It doesn't matter if  there is a man and more then one woman or a

woman and more then one man to the  couple.  It doesn't matter if there is a

group of couples of all polarities.  It doesn't matter if  the group is

exclusively men or women.  What really makes the difference is if everyone  is

practicing Night Magick.


When all are practicing Night Magick then all are in the Night Flow.  Everyone

present will have some increase of energy flowing through them.  All will feel

the bond of Night Consciousness.  In Night Magick there is no jealousy or

possessiveness.  In Night Magick  there is no Judeo-Christian, or Moslem, or

Mormon, or any oppressive religious hang-ups  about sex. Each Night Magician

is independent and free.  Marriage under Night Magick  is not one of

possession but of mutual cooperation and love.


Group marriage is a very real possibility under Night Magick because a Night

Magician  honors independence, freedom, and equality in action among Night

Magicians.  There is  no jealousy or possessiveness among Night Magicians.

Women and Men have equal  rights in Night Magick and Consciousness and in the

world itself.  But marriage between a  Night Magician and non- practicing

human being rarely works out. Ultimately, the Night Magician changes so much

that the spouse no longer understands  the Night Magician.  It is very rare to

find a spouse who will understand the Night  Magician and their way of life.

The marriage often ends in divorce.  But it is better to  divorce and remain

friends then to stay in a marriage which creates hostility and  resentment.

There is no balance in such a marriage.  Many are made to feel guilty if there

are children involved and stay married although there is hostility and

resentment  between them.   I believe it is better for everyone involved if

the couple divorce, and even  if they can't remain friends, to at least remain

cooperative and fair with each other  concerning settlement and visitation.

Balance and harmony are important in a Night  Magician's life.  It is

important to her/his success on the Night Road.  Also important to  this

success and of a more concrete nature are Magickal Tools.


Down through the ages the Ancient Night Magicians have used many different

types of  tools and implements in the practice of the Ancient Art.  You too

are going to need  Magickal Tools and in the next topic I will help you attain

these tools.


9.  A Night Magician's Tools and Weapons 


These are the Night Tools a Night Magician will need to set the proper

atmosphere and  conduct the basic rites.  You will conduct these rites in the

room you have designated as  your Magician's Study within the Magick Circle

which you will define its area with the  Night Cord.


This cord should be made of silk, cotton, or wool.  The cord needs to be long

enough so  that when it is laid down on the floor it will form a circle that

contains the altar and  yourself.  If there are more people then yourself

conducting Night Magick or even possibly  just observing then you will need a

long enough length to make a large enough circle to  contain them.  Within the

Night Circle you will build the Night Altar.


The Night Altar is symbolic for your physical being in which is focused the

Night Spirit.   You will build an altar upon which you will focus your Powers

of Eternal Darkness here on  the Earth plane.  It is best to keep it simple.

The basic structure can be a small table,  box, or anything which is sturdy.

The altar should be about three feet wide by six feet  long.  The height of

the Night Altar is your decision.  You can have one which is at waist  height

when you are standing and one for when you are sitting.  It is best to have

both in  your magickal inventory. Place the Night Altar so that when you are

standing or sitting  behind it you are facing North. Use a compass if

necessary so that you can place it  facing North.  Then cover the Night Altar

with a cloth of your choice.  If at all possible  choose a black, red, or

silver colored cloth.  It is best if the cloth has no distinctive pattern  on

the surface portion of the altar.  This is your Night Altar.  You then must

place upon it  some very special articles.


Upon the altar and towards the back left side place a red candle and on the

right side  place a black candle.  On the left side and in front of the red

candle place an incense  holder and on the right place your copy of Night

Magick.  You may also place any other  small trinkets that help build your

feeling of Night Magick.  Dragons, wizards, owls, and  so on are fine.  The

Night Altar is a sacred symbol before which you come to release  Night Power.

It is the physical symbol of your body and heart and serves the same  purpose:

an anchor of the Night Force.  You will need a good supply of incense to fill

the  incense holder on your Night Altar.  Through trial and error you will

find the right incense  that fits your personal vibration.  Each incense

creates a vibration in the air and as you  grow more magickal, you will be

ever more sensitive to its vibration.  Incense, which is of  the stick variety

and is thick in nature is good or you may have a small charcoal brazier  and

powdered incense.  On the Night Altar you will also need the following things:

a  silver or crystal dish of sea salt; a vial of patchouli oil;  a crystal

bowl of water; a silver or  crystal chalice; and a silver or crystal bell. Now

all these articles sit on a Pentacle which  is in the center of the Night

Altar.


The Pentacle is a symbol of the Earth.  It is a round plate made of wood and

inscribed  with sacred symbols of Night Magick.  The plate is thirteen inches

in diameter.  For an  example of such a plate and the layout of the articles

see Figure 1.  Then you will need a  loose leaf notebook which will become

your Night Magician's Grimoire.


From the very beginning of Night Magick you will have practices, exercises,

and rites to perform and grow from.   After each practice, exercise, or rite

you should develop a  grimoire which records the date, time, and experiences

felt in that session. Record in as  much detail as possible the successes and

difficulties experienced.  Keep a separate  section for each type of practice,

exercise, and rite.  This will allow you to see your  progress in each and to

help you see where your difficulties are and how to possibly solve  them.  Be

faithful and accurate in all entries made and this record will help speed your

progress. These are your Night Tools.  Next you will need your Night Weapons

the first of  which is a Night Amulet.


You need to make for yourself an amulet of black quartz crystal. This is a

grounding and  power stone of Night Force.  If you want, the necklace the

stone hangs from can also be  made from quartz. I recommend though that the

necklace be made of silver or amethyst.   This will help balance the power of

the black quartz stone.  The Night Amulet will help  keep your physical body

in tune with the Night Force.  You can tune into the Night Amulet  and by

holding it increase your vibration in the Night Force. You will also need to

make a  Night Ring.


This should be a ring made of silver.  You can set the Night Ring with any

combination of amethyst, black quartz, emerald, ruby, or diamond.   A plain

band of silver is fine.  You  may later want to add Night Runes and Night

Magick Symbols to the Night Ring as you  learn them. The Night Ring is a

symbol of union with the Night Force.   Next you need to  make your Night

Wand.


The wand should be about thirteen inches long.  It should be made of wood or

silver. You  may encrust the wand with a combination of semi-precious and

precious jewels.  You may  inscribe the Night Wand with Night Runes and

Symbols.  You will find these in Appendix  C.  You may place a crystal at

either or both ends of the wand.  The Night Wand is a focus  of the Night

Energy that leaves your body to be transmitted to an object or place.  You now

need to make a Night Staff.


The Night Staff is a symbol of Night Guidance, Power, and Authority.  The

Night Staff is to  be made of wood.  The kind of wood is left up to you but it

should be one which you are in  harmony with.  The Night Staff should be

approximately six feet high.  You should leave  the staff in its natural state

or paint it black, red or silver if you feel its necessary.   As said earlier,

the Night Staff is a symbol of true Night Power and the Night Spirit's support

to  you.  You will need a Night Athame.


This is a small dagger whose blade and handle is about twelve inches in

length.  This is  used for ceremonial purposes only.  Do not use this knife

for cutting.  You may want to  place special symbols on the handle and/or

blade to add magickal importance to your  athame.  Make for your Night Athame

a scabbard  which you can place on a belt on your  person.  You will also need

a Night Sword.


You can use any style of sword.  Japanese samurai, scimitar, cavalry sword, or

excalibur  style sword.  You should also have a scabbard which you keep the

sword in and attach it  to your side under your Night Cape.   Of course, the

next item you need is a Night Cape.


There is an easy way to make the Night Cape.  Take enough cloth so that you

have a  square which is twice your height long on each side.  Now go to the

center of the cloth,  and using a string that is half the length of one side

of the cloth and on one end has a  chalk stick attached, draw a circle on the

cloth that has the radius of half the length of one  side of the cloth.  Also

draw from the center a circle that has a radius of three inches.    Now cut

out the small circle and the large circle.  Then place a slit from one edge of

the  small circle you just cut down the center of the cloth and through the

edge.  Sew ties into  the material on the edge you just cut and near the top

of the cape. You will also need to  make a hood that will cover your entire

head and will go over the head far enough to cover  the face.  You may attach

the hood to the cape.  See figure ___.  The Night Cape serves a  valuable

purpose.


The Night Cape acts as an insulator to the outside forces that surround you.

It will help  block them out of your inner world and keep them from

interfering in your magickal  operations. Keep the cape secured in a cloth bag

and put it where no one else may touch  or bother it.  Use it only in the

practice of Night Magick. Next you will need to make the  Night Plate.


Actually this is a breast plate.  The basic shape and size of this plate is

given in Figure __.   You may change the size and shape as fits you best.  You

may place upon the plate Night  Symbols and Runes.  You may also want to place

stones of black quartz, amethyst,  emerald, ruby, or diamond on it.  The color

of the plate should be black with runes and  symbols in red and silver.

Finally  you will need to make a Night Shield.


The Night Shield is patterned after the shields used by knights of chivalry.

Some basic  shapes and sizes are given in Figure ___.  Again the background

should be black and  symbols and runes should be in red and silver.  The runes

and symbols you place on the  shield as with the Night Plate should help you

increase your feeling of strength and  courage in Night Magick. These runes

and symbols should help place you in Night  Consciousness.  The Night

Magician's Tools and Weapons are very valuable to you. They provide for you a

means to advance in Night Magick.   They provide the proper atmosphere in

which to practice the lore of Night Magick.  There are other devices that will

be needed as you progress in your studies.  As a rule, each will be relatively

simple to  acquire. They will be brought to your attention as you proceed.

The Night Magician's  Tools and Weapons given here are those which you will

need before you proceed further  in Night Magick. Once you have your tools and

weapons made it is time to select your  Night Name.


10.  Your Magickal Night Name 


The true name given to anything is very important.  A true name contains the

essence of  that entity.  It describes the differences and qualities of that

entity.  To know the true name  of a thing is to imply acquisition and

knowledge of that essence. To know the true name  gives you dominion over it.

The name that you as a Night Magician will choose is of great  importance.


You will select a Night Name which to you contains the very essence of your

Inner Nature.   This name may be the same as a famous personage you wish to

emulate or a famous  saying or motto. For example, you may choose a name such

as Merlin, Saint Germain,  Abra-Melin, Mithratar, or any other name that

strikes your imagination and heart.  You  may choose a name from a saying or

motto.  A Night Name will help to build-up your  Night Essence, your feeling

of Night Consciousness and will quicken your magickal  vibration.  This name

should be given to no one else to know.  It is your own Magickal  Name that

when used will bring you to Night Consciousness.  Now, you must choose a

second name.


This is the name that you will be known outwardly by to fellow Night

Magicians.  You  should pattern this name after something unlike your Night

Name.  This name will be  used on all correspondence with other Night

Magicians and any published writings.  The  second name is your public name

and is used in such rites and exercises.  Remember, to  know the name of a

thing is to know its Eternal Essence and to have dominion over it.


In selecting a magickal name you are defining that Inner Essence. To tell

another is to  give him access to your Inner Nature.   He may reach you and

make demands of you  whenever he chooses by knowing your inner name.  Do not

reveal it for any reason.  You  should always use your second or outer name as

Night Magicians. To do so will insure  that you will never be bothered here or

hereafter.  Both names are important and should  be selected to help bring you

into your Night Consciousness.  Your Night Name will bring  you closer into

the aura of Night Magick.  Having selected your Night Name you now must  learn

Magickal Protection in order to conduct Night Magick safe from outside

influences.


11.  Night Pillar 


What you are about to learn is perhaps the most valuable Night Tool you will

ever  acquire. There are many forces in the world which will attempt to do you

harm if you  practice Night Magick. By harm, I don't necessarily mean physical

violence although that  is possible.  I am talking about the threat of harm to

your subtle bodies: Astral, Mental,  and Causal bodies. Harm to these bodies

could cause serious emotional and mental  sickness.  There is also the threat

of attack to your Etheric which usually translates to  physical harm.   For

Night Magicians there is a serious threat of attack from Yang  followers. This

could be from so- called White Magicians and their use of magick against you.

It could come from Christians, Jews, Muslims and so on. Attacks can come from

collective emotional or mental energy meant to harm a Night Magician.  A group

of Yang  worshipers gathered together in prayer praying for the demise of all

Night Magicians  everywhere could build up enough energy to harm the

unprotected Night Magician.  As  you grow more magickal you will become very

sensitive to subtle energies around you.   Attacks could come from anyone who

wishes you harm.  You will need protection.  You  will need to build the Night

Pillar.  The Night Pillar is not just for protection.


The Night Pillar also acts as an invisible wall which will contain the energy

you will be creating through Night Magick. This will allow you to build-up the

energy to a great  intensity before you release it to accomplish your will.

This will increase the effectiveness  of the magickal rites you create.  So

how do you build the Night Pillar.


You begin by calming and clearing your mind of extraneous thoughts.  Close

your eyes  and visualize the Night Energy collecting around your form.  See

the Night Energy forming  a pillar of protective force that extends around you

about six feet.  See that energy flowing  below your feet and above your head.

See yourself in a pillar of deep violet and emerald  energies.  See yourself

in a pillar of darkest night.  Know that you cannot be harmed while  contained

in the Night Pillar.  Now say the following invocation:


"I am a Night Magician surrounded in a Pillar of Night Energy that cannot be

penetrated.   It repels all energy that would harm me.  It repels all thoughts

and emotional energy of  my enemies. Through the Power of my Oversoul, I am

protected in a Pillar of Night Energy  and cannot be harmed.  May this Night

Pillar remain around me at all times keeping me  out of harms way.  So be it."


Say this invocation and visualize the Night Pillar around you until you can

feel its  protection. This energy comes from the Oversoul within.  As you

begin the invocation the  Oversoul extends the Night Energy into your world

through the silver cord. The silver cord  is your life line to your Oversoul

and through it all energy passes to you which sustains  your life on Earth.

You can invoke more of this energy and power into your life when you  work in

conscious union with your Oversoul.  There are many different kinds of energy

which can be invoked into your world through the Oversoul.  The Night Energy

of  Protection is only one of them.  You will learn about many more types of

energy you can  invoke and use towards the end of the book. What you want to

remember about the Night  Pillar is to use it often.


Always place the Night Pillar around you before you work Night Magick.  Always

place yourself in the Night Pillar at the beginning of each day.  The more you

use it the stronger  it will become.  The Pillar will protect you from all

physical and psychic harm.  You must  learn to consciously keep the Night

Pillar around you all the time.  You should always  remain in the Night

Pillar.  Everything that you practice in the lore of Night Magick should begin

with the Night Pillar.  You must always do this whether it's stated so or not.

Through the Night Pillar you will safely live and learn in Night Magick.  You

now have  built a strong foundation upon which to live and practice Night

Magick. You have learned  what it is to be a Night Magician and to practice

the lore of Night Magick.  If you are ready  to begin using Night Magick then

let's consecrate your Night Study and Tools.


12.  Invocation to Night Magick  


This is a most sacred time in your life for it marks the beginning of your

entry into Night Magick.  You are going to perform a very sacred rite to mark

your entry.  You will, in this solemn rite, dedicate your physical, emotional,

mental, and magickal energies to the  practice of Night Magick.  This rite is

meant to convey to you the seriousness and  importance with which you should

view Night Magick.  In this rite, you will learn the basics  which will begin

every ritual you will learn.  In this rite, you will invoke the Night Energy

into your Night Tools and Weapons and make them yours and yours alone.  The

Night  Tools and Weapons will then be sacred and contain the Power of the

Night. To begin, you  must have your Magician's Study and Night Altar

prepared.


To do this, have all your Night Tools and Weapons laid out on the Night Altar.

Have the  cord laid on the floor in a circle around the Night Altar.  On the

Night Altar you should now  light the candles and the incense.  Your bowl

should be full of water and your chalice  should contain wine or grape juice.

Be sure and turn off the phones and lock the doors so  you won't be disturbed.

Once you have accomplished this be sure and have your Night  Name selected. It

is this name you will use in the performance of this rite.  Now for the actual

ritual.


You will begin by invoking the Night Pillar.  Standing before your Night Altar

and with your eyes closed see the Protective Night Energy pouring down from

the Oversoul above you,  through your head, on into your heart, and out into

the study completely surrounding and interpenetrating the room.  See the Light

continuing through you and on into the Earth.  At this point you should repeat

the Night Pillar Invocation given earlier.   Feel the Night  Energy

concentrate deeply within the circle boundary outlined by the cord.


Now pick up the bell and ring it six times in each major direction, that is

North, South,  East and West.  Then repeat the following invocation, "I who am

(give your Night Name)  summon the Presence of all Deities in the Night Force

to attend my ritual of Eternal Night.   To witness my consecration of my Night

Tools in the service of the Eternal Darkness.  We  now stand in the Eternal

Night beyond time and space.  Come and witness my Ritual of  the Night". After

this, pick up the salt container, and repeat the following: "By my sacred

name, (give your Night Name), through the Presence of my Oversoul and the

Eternal Earth  Deities, I invoke the Earth Night Power into this container of

salt and now place the salt  upon the earth to mark the boundary of my sacred

circle."  Visualize the Earth Deities  filling the vessel with their power.

Pinch a little salt lightly between your fingers dropping  it on the floor

over the cord going completely around the circle.  BE CAREFUL NOT TO STEP

OUTSIDE THE CIRCLE FOR THE REMAINDER OF THE RITUAL.  Place the salt container

back on the Night Altar and pick up the crystal bowl of water. Repeat the

following: "May the Presence of my Oversoul and the Eternal Water Deities fill

this water and container and endow it with the Water Night Power." Visualize

the Water  Deities of the Earth filling the vessel with the power.  With your

left hand dip it into the  water and sprinkle lightly the boundary you have

already marked with the salt. Place the  water bowl back on the altar and pick

up the incense burner.


Repeat the following: "Let the Presence of the Four Winds of the Earth enter

into the  incense burner filling it with Air Night Power".   Now face each

direction, rotating  counterclockwise, and see the Presence of each Wind Deity

enter into the incense burner.   Then circle four times in a counterclockwise

manner around and within the Magick Circle.   Place the incense burner back on

the Night Altar and pick up the candle.


Repeat the following:  "May the Presence of my Oversoul and the Fire Deities

of the Earth  place their sacred flame here within my candles and upon my

Night Altar."   See the Fire  Deities come and dance around the flames and

upon your altar.  Place the candle back  where it came from and pick up the

chalice of wine or juice.


Repeat the following: "Let the Presence of my Oversoul and the Eternal

Darkness enter  into the liquid and fill it with the Power of the Eternal

Night.  May this elixir give me  strength, healing, and courage each day of my

life."  Feel the Power flow through you and  into the chalice.  See the energy

collect and concentrate till the chalice glows with Night  Energy.  Then drink

the liquid and your ready to consecrate the other Night Tools.


You will begin with the oil so pick it up and repeat the following: "Let this

oil be made  sacred and filled with the Power of the Night.  Let the Presence

of the Oversoul and Night  Spirit touch it with their might, courage,

solitude, and darkness.  For the oil is now sacred  and made for anointing the

Weapons of a Night Magician."   Take a small amount of oil  and touch the

Pentacle and state, "May the Night Force flow into this Pentacle and bless all

things laid on it". Now it is time to anoint each weapon in your sacred

arsenal.


You will pick up each Night Weapon, one at a time, and while placing a small

amount of  oil on each tool, repeat the following: "Through the Presence of my

Oversoul and the  Eternal Darkness, I (Night Name), consecrate this Night

Weapon in the service of Night  Magick and the Eternal Night."  Do this with

the Night Amulet, Ring, Wand, Staff,  Grimoire, Athame, Sword, Plate, Shield,

and Cape.   Now put the Night Amulet, Ring,  Plate, Athame and Sword on your

body.  Place the Grimoire in the front center edge of  your Night Altar.  Put

on the Night Cape. Place the Night Shield over your left forearm and  in the

left hand hold the Night Wand and in the right hold the Night Staff and state

the  following:  "I,(give your Night Name), commit my all to the Oversoul and

the Night Spirit  within, and to the dedication of my Magickal Energies to the

practice of Night Magick.  I  dedicate myself to the Oversoul within and to my

union with it in Night Consciousness.   May these Night Tools and Weapons

serve me ever in this cause. So be it."  Now face  each direction and repeat

the following:  "Thank you Night Deities for your attendance at  this sacred

Night Rite.  May we ever serve the Eternal Powers of Darkness here on Earth

and the Omniverse forever. So be it."  And that's it, you have finished your

first night rite  and all your Night Tools and Weapons are consecrated in

Night Magick.  At this point stop and re-enforce your Night Pillar and then

take off all your Night Weapons and place them  back upon the Night Altar.

Leave the cord in place on the floor.


Each ritual will begin by your stepping into the Night Circle and putting on

your Night Weapons and Cape.  It is alright if you wear your Night Amulet and

Ring outside the  Circle. After this place the Night Pillar around you.  Do

not leave the Circle until the end  of the ritual and be sure and re-enforce

the Night Pillar around and through you before  leaving the Night Circle.  Go

through the actions of consecrating the Night Circle with  earth, water, air,

and fire each time.  Fill the chalice, say the invocation, and drink the  wine

each time.  Then always ring the bell and summon the Night Deities.   These

are the  basic procedures you will begin each ritual which takes place within

the Night Circle.  I  hope you have had fun and are ready to begin learning

about the first realm you will pass  through on the Night Road.  Let's go then

to the Earth Realm.


CHAPTER IV



Earth Magick


13.  The Earth Realm  


Since time began there has been traditionally four elements which make up the

world of  the Night Magician.  These are the elements of Earth, Water, Air,

and Fire.  They are  symbolic for the basic four worlds of being: that of the

physical(Earth), emotional(Water),  mental(Air), and causal(Fire).  The

Oversoul must express through each of these realms  using the appropriate

vehicle or body and ultimately gain mastery over each of them. So, I  have

divided Night Magick into four basic realms with knowledge, exercises, and

rituals  appropriate to each realm. Ultimately, the Oversoul, through you,

working in and  mastering each realm will have learned all that must be

learned here upon Earth and  return no more.  The Earth Realm is your

beginning point in becoming a Night Magician.    I want to take you back to

the beginning of time and the origin of the soul.


From an understanding of general cosmology, that is the origin of the Void,

Monad/Godsoul/Oversoul and the soul of humankind, then this will help you to

see the  whys of a magickal evolution and the reasons for being on the Night

Road that follows this  magickal evolution.


There is no beginning to the origin of the Void.  The Void has always been, is

now, and  ever will be.  The Void is principle, unmanifest, and exists

entirely in itself, from itself, and  by itself. The Void is the potential and

unmanifest Source of all that exists.  The Void is  the Life present in all

things.  It is omnipresent, omnipotent, and omniscient.  From out of  the

Void, the potential and unmanifest Source, comes the Ultimate Yin and Yang

Creators.   The Spirit of the Spirits.   The Ultimate Spirits are the first

and only creations  by the Void.  The totality of all that the Void can be is

brought into being in the Ultimate  Spirits.  The Ultimate Spirits derive all

potential and essence from the Void, the potential  and unmanifest.  The

Ultimate Yin and Yang then created twin parallel matrixes and so it  began.

What is now referred to here is also applicable for the Ultimate Yang.


The Ultimate Yin created beings like unto itself.  Each of these Beings I will

refer to as a Monad.   Each Monad was created in order to share in the joy of

creation with the  Ultimate Yin.  The Eternal Night gave to each Monad the

potential of becoming all that It  is.  The Dark Goddess-God gave to each

Monad the essence and potential for expressing  the Eternal Darkness.  Each

Monad evolves into the Oneness of the Eternal Night by  actualizing its

Eternal Night's potential.  Each Monad grows by bringing into  manifestation

the latent abilities and powers placed within It by the Eternal Night.  Like

the Eternal Night, each Monad is given the right of free will to determine how

it will do  this.  The free will of each Monad permits it to choose how it

will create and what path of  evolvement to follow.  When the Monad chooses to

manifest its Abilities and Powers and  to Create, the way of interest to you

as a Night Magician, is by its descent into matter.


The material universe is made up of an infinite number of vibrational

energies.  The very highest of these energies is the substance upon which the

Monad first creates.  Through  the Creative Power of the Monad, acting on the

highest vibrational matter, the Monad first  takes on form.  This is not form

as you understand form but something that is beyond your understanding. When

the Monad first takes on form, it becomes two Godsouls.


The two Godsouls are true twin souls.  They are the magickal twins who shall

evolve and  create together by the Will and Power of the Monad.  They each

have free will and free  choice of their own.  Yet all creation that proceeds

from them is related.  All fragments of  their divine spirit which are sent

forth to be ensouled in the world of spirit and matter are  thus related and

united in purpose.  In all they do the twin souls are united through the  Will

of the Monad.   One Godsoul is predominately Yin with Yang and the other is

totally  Yin.  This is a simplification of the energy systems but basically

these twin Godsouls now  have the creative energies ready to continue downward

into material creation.  Each  Godsoul has the full potential and essence of

the Monad and also the free will to use  them.  Because of the power and high

vibrational energies of the Godsoul it cannot  continue its direct descent

into matter, thus it created an extension of itself into the lower  worlds.

This level of presence I have called the Oversoul.  The Oversoul is a being of

lower vibrational levels.  It is very active on its levels in  learning and

creating and using the potential given to it by the Godsoul.  Ultimately, the

Oversoul must learn to create on the lowest of levels and thus it sends a part

of itself into  the lowest worlds of form and so is born the soul.


The soul is the instrument through which the Oversoul learns about the lowest

worlds of creation.  The human soul will return to the Earth many times for

the human body does  not last long. The human soul will return to experience

many different lives in order that it  might gain all the experience the Earth

has to teach it.  Once the human soul has gained  all the experience the

Oversoul needs then the human soul will move on to different  worlds and

dimensions in order to gain new experience.  The soul gets its life force and

direction from the Oversoul.  This Power and Will flows through what is called

the Silver  Cord.  This Cord is made up of high energy particles through which

flows energy of  varying frequencies.  The soul operates through a mental,

emotional or astral, etheric,  and physical body.  On Earth this is the human

body.


The Soul (Oversoul and soul) is very delicate and composed of very high

vibrational  energies. If the Soul is to grow, develop, and evolve in material

creation then it has to  have a material vehicle through which to work.  You

could compare this to a person who  wants to go into outer space.


Because outer space is very cold, lacks oxygen, and is a vacuum the human body

could  never withstand going out into space without being protected from it.

So a special suit is  designed which is heated, pressurized, and contains

oxygen with which to breathe. It also  contains many devices and sensors to

work in space and monitor the surroundings.  In  order to protect the delicate

Soul from the dense material surroundings, and for it to be  able to work in

and monitor its surroundings a special suit was devised. This is called the

physical body.


The physical body is composed of the lowest and densest matter. It is designed

to  respond and interact with its material surroundings.  There are the five

senses: sight,  touch, smell, taste, and hearing; and their respective organs:

eyes, skin, nose, mouth, and  ears.  These allow the soul to react to the

world around it.  The hands, arms, legs, feet,  and joints allow the soul to

work with its surroundings with great dexterity and ability.  The  physical

body is an excellent tool through which the soul to operate when it is

properly  attuned and under the control of the Oversoul.  Unfortunately, for

the majority of  humankind this is not the case.


Too many human beings are the human body instead of the soul and Oversoul. The

Oversoul/soul is not in charge but it is the human body which is in charge.

The human  body is basically undisciplined and unruly.  Whatever the human

body wants it gets and  half the time it doesn't really want what it thinks it

wants. Without the control of the  Oversoul/soul, the body is helpless before

the elements of life.  The human body has no  control over the world around

it.  Because of this current state, the Oversoul/soul does not pay attention

to the human body.  It is much like a car out of control.  If you were the

driver of a car that refused to go where you wanted it to go and was always

headed for  destinations unwanted and going past places uncared about, you

would get out and just  let it go till it crashed and burned. This is pretty

much what the Oversoul/soul does  concerning the human body. But there is a

way to change this. You must identify, tune  into, and become the

Oversoul/soul.


You must gain mastery over the physical body.  You are the Oversoul/soul and

not the  physical body.  You must remember that you are eternal and only

working through the  physical body.  It is your tool through which to work and

experience the material world  around you.  You cannot allow the passions and

desires of the body to rule you.  You  must develop control over the body.

Properly channeled and controlled these forces can  be used to your advantage

instead of your detriment.  You will learn through Night Magick  how to

develop this control and mastery.  The Night Magician must attain through

discipline, diet, exercise, and ritual mastery over her/his body and the world

around  her/him. But in all trials that occur in your life be easy on

yourself. You will fail many times, but get up, dust off your knees, and go on

vowing to try and do  better. Never give up for all things are possible to

those who follow the Night Magician's  life.   "The world is but a stage and

we are the actors upon it,'' thus it was said by  Shakespeare.  This world is

but an illusion and your attitude should be that of "in it but  not of it".

You must never become lost in the illusion of the game played by the majority

of humankind.  You must become the Master of Illusion, the Night Magician. Let

me  discuss with you for a moment the Stage upon which we experience life.



After many millenniums of experience there is a Soul who is qualified to

become a  Planetary Soul.  The Planetary Soul is the Soul for every person

upon that planet.  Think  of a pie sliced into an incredible number of pieces

of pie.  The pie as a whole is the  Planetary Soul and you are one of those

pieces of the pie. The Earth is the physical body  of a very advanced Soul who

I have told you is the Ancient Dragon Tiamat.  Many of  humankind have named

this Soul, Gaia/Pan. This name representing the fe/male aspect  of the Earth

Soul.  Every human being is a part of the Soul of Earth.  Moreover every part

of our human body, that is causal, mental, emotional, etheric and physical is

directly  effected by the Earth Soul.  Our entire existence is constantly

effected by the Energies of  this Being which plays upon our own energies.

Just as you are developing and evolving  magickally so is Soul Earth.  Soul

Earth's evolution is far greater then that of yours but all  are aiming

towards the One Goal; every greater unfoldment of Night Consciousness.  You

must take care of the Earth Body.


It is your stage upon which you gain magickally and moreover it is the vehicle

through  which Gaia/Pan gains magickally and has its physical being.   If the

body of Tiamat is  killed then the Soul will leave it just as if your body is

killed your soul must leave it.  If  there is continued pollution and

destruction of planetary life and resources then soon  Tiamat will have to rid

itself of the cancer that is causing physical destruction.  I believe  all of

humankind should take this as a warning.  It has happened before and it will

happen  again, Tiamat will not allow the death of its physical body before its

proper time.  It will do  what is necessary to stop the destruction of its

body just as you would.   There is also  another type of destruction happening

on Earth and that is with alien races from the Yang  matrix.


I know this subject may be tough for you to deal with but consider it as you

have  everything else, with an open mind. This planet is a battlefield between

Yang races and the Night Soul of this world, Tiamat.   The opening poem was

not just a piece of fiction.   There are still Yang races who desire  to

possess the Earth for its wealth and who enjoy dominion over human beings.

There  are other Yang races who plan to slowly convert the Yin souls of this

world into Yang  souls.  To change the basic polarity of all souls on this

world.  They believe that their  polarity is the only appropriate polarity and

would see the destruction of the Yin matrix of  life.   What evidence is there

of this?


I can point out to you books on the market today that deal with alien

visitation and kidnapping in which there are biological experiments going on

to create a human/alien  yang body in which they plan on placing Earth yin

souls in order to ultimately change the  polarity of the souls.  Turning back

to the pie example given earlier, think of what happens  to the pie if pieces

of it are removed never to be returned.  I believe Soul Death is an

appropriate term.   You can look at the Yang religions that were introduced by

the so-called gods or god and see that through their magickal practices they

slowly change a  soul's vibration from Yin to Yang. These of course are the

religions that have no  tolerance for other religions and have gone to great

lengths to force conversion on others  such as Christianity.  There is also my

own personal experience.  I will not go further in  discussing my personal

experience except to say it wasn't pleasant and could have led to  my ultimate

destruction.  What can you do?


You will learn many things to do in Night Magick.  You will learn to place

your body in attunement with the Yin Force of this planet.  You are learning

to unite with the  consciousness of the Oversoul which is one in consciousness

with the Planetary Oversoul.   If enough human souls accomplish this the Night

Force will become too strong for the  Yang races to deal with. You have

learned to take care of the Earth.  Go out and help  environmentalists who

promote care of the planet.   When you feel physically well the rest  of you

responds in kind and so it is with the Earth.  If the Earth Body is strong and

healthy  the Earth Soul will be strong and its aura will repel the alien

races.  In your meditations  and visualizations, see the Earth and Its Soul

strong in the Night Force.  Use your Night  Pillar and extend its protection

around and through the Earth.  Use your Night Pillar  around every human body

and soul to keep them strong in the Night Force.  If enough of  humankind

joins in there will be no destruction of the Yin life force.  If you think

that  aliens are fiction, DON'T.  If you practice Night Magick you will draw

their attention to you.   I have had personal experience with aliens and my

battle with them continues.  I advise  you strongly to wear your Night Amulet

and Ring at all times and keep your Night Pillar  strong through constant use.

I hope you will take my advice and not have to learn through  experience.


This is the Earth Realm where you have to live and practice Night Magick.  In

Earth  Magick, I will introduce knowledge, rites, and exercises which will

help to improve and  refine your physical body.   To make your body a more

sensitive instrument to the Night  forces around you.  The more refined the

instrument the greater the Night Power that will  be able to be expressed

through it.  These exercises will not only benefit the physical but  overlap

into the development of the higher vehicles too.  Earth Magick will give you

ultimate control over your physical body and the world around you.  So study

with all your  heart, persevere, practice, have courage and patience and you

will attain the Earth.  Your  first subject for study and practice in the

Earth Realm is Night Breathing.


14.  Night Breathing    


Breathing is an important aspect in life and Night Magick. Breathing is

essential to life  and your well-being.  That may seem like an obvious

statement since without air you  could not live, but actually breathing means

more then just taking in air to sustain life.  As  you will see, breathing

correctly and with the knowledge of what it can do for you will  propel you

far down the magickal road.  Incorrect breathing leads to many problems in

your life.


Does it seem that you run out of energy well before the day is done?  Are you

often  nervous and irritable for no real apparent reason?  Through correct

breathing you can  eliminate these problems from your life.  You will be able

to go through each day with  boundless energy. Tension, irritability, and

nervousness will disappear from your life.   What is wrong with the way you

breathe?


Stop right now and notice how you are breathing.  Do you find that your

breathing is  shallow? Almost everyone in the world is a lazy breather.  Deep

breathing is a simple  thing to do but in the beginning it will take some

effort on your part for it to become a  regular practice.  Begin by taking a

slow, deep breath and as you inhale, not only expand  your chest to hold more

air but force out your abdomen and feel that air going deep down  into your

lungs.  When you have inhaled as much air as you can, try to take in just a

bit  more air.  Really fill up your lungs. Now that you have inhaled as much

air as possible,  exhale very slowly and steadily.  Bring your expanded

abdomen in and force out the air  till you are completely empty.  At no time

should you strain yourself in doing deep  breathing.  Even though you cannot

go around in public being very obvious about this  exercise you should, no

matter where you are, breathe as deeply, slowly, and  rhythmically as

possible.  You will do this consciously at first but soon this will become a

part of your life without thinking of it.  Do this and you will have a

vibrant, youthful body.   Why would an increase in air intake cause this

increased vitality?


There is an active, vital, life force that energizes the world around you.  In

the Eastern languages this essence is called Prana.  This Force is active not

only on the physical  plane but on all planes or dimensions of life.  On the

physical level, you breathe in the air  which contains one aspect of this

Force and which then is transmitted throughout your  body via the nerve

network.  When you are feeling nervous, irritable, or tense, this can be  due

to a lack of this vital Force.  The Pranic Force is not just for the physical

body.


There are many aspects of the Pranic or what is called in Earth Magick, Earth

Force.  To  utilize the Earth Force, you must learn to draw in this Energy

within you.  The technique  outlined is termed Night Breathing. To begin with,

retire to your Magician's Study and sit comfortable with spine erect in your

chair.  For a few minutes practice deep breathing with your feet on the floor

and touching.  Your hands should be resting in your lap, palms down at all

times.  The indrawing of the  Earth Force is through the action of the mind

rather then the physical act of breathing.  As  your attention has been on the

physical act of breathing let's now move it to the Earth  Force surrounding

you.


This Force is the Life of the world.  Through it you have your well-being.

Your mind must remain in a state of complete openness to the Earth Force.

Your mind must be  completely centered in the Earth Force alone.  The mind

must be without strain.  You  must not force the indrawing of the Earth Force.

It is breathed into your being through a  conscious attunement to it. Feel the

Earth Force entering into your body.  See it  penetrating every cell in your

body and causing them to be filled Earth Light.  Know that  as it fills your

physical body with Earth Light and Life that the Earth Force also charges

your higher bodies with this same Emerald Light. As you continue to absorb the

Earth  Force know that you will achieve a Oneness with it.  You will lose

identity with your  physical body and forget physical limitations for in the

Earth Force there are no limits.   You are the Earth Force, Limitless and

Free.  Through Night Breathing, you will become  filled with the Earth Force.

This Force will keep your body in Eternal Youth.  You will be  free of

sickness. You will have abundant energy.  Not only does the Earth Force

quicken  the physical but also the Emotional Body.  Your outlook on life will

improve.  It will raise  the vibration of your body so that depression,

loneliness, and fear will not have a part in  your world.  The Night Force

transforms the Mental Body.  It can give you perfect memory.   Your mind and

all that it can do will be greatly enhanced.  Your memory will be able to

search back to when it first was.  The Earth Force will help raise your

overall Being into  Night Consciousness.  In addition to the practice of Night

Breathing and the use of the Earth Force you must also study and practice the

art of the Magician's Meditation.


15.  The Night Magician's Meditation    


The Night Magician's Meditation is the beginning level at which you will begin

to awaken  your Inner Self.  It is an exercise that is essential to your

magickal growth.  In the  beginning stages of meditation, your sense of

awareness will take place from your  physical awareness, but as you grow your

conscious awareness will move into your  Oversoul.  There are many benefits

that can be derived from meditation.


Meditation will greatly benefit your health.  The body will become inwardly

calm and tranquil.  The practice of Magician's Meditation can help to

eliminate ulcers and other physical problems due to stress and tension.  What

meditation can do for you physically it  can also do for you emotionally.


You can achieve a state of emotional tranquility and stability never before

thought  possible. No matter the confusion going on around you, you will be

able remain steady  and firm as a rock. It will develop your ability to

concentrate and to expand the workings  of your mind.


You will be able to achieve true telepathic communication with those of

similar magickal standing.  Your memory will be vastly enhanced.  Ideas from

the Higher Mental Realm  will come to you. From the Mental Realm, you will be

able to contact and obtain  information from the Akashic Record.  This Record

I will speak of later.  You will be able  to know the past, present, and

future probabilities for yourself and for others.  You will be  able to gain a

true understanding of your life and why you are here. There are  preparations

and precautions to take prior to meditating.


First, you must watch the food you eat.  You must avoid fried foods and spicy

foods close  to the meditation period.  Do not eat just prior to meditating

for a full stomach can be  quite discomforting.  You will then need to set a

quiet period aside each day.  This period  should be at the same time each day

if possible.  Early morning or late evening will be  the best time. You should

feel refreshed when you meditate so wash up prior to  commencing.  Now that

you have taken care of your bodily needs it is time to set the  proper

atmosphere for meditation.


Retire to your Magician's Study and be sure that you can not be disturbed for

say a half  hour. Put on your robe, light your incense, and sit down in a very

comfortable chair.  Do  not light your candle for the flickering will tend to

distract you.  Once you have done this  you are ready to begin the Magician's

Meditation.


Close your eyes now and place the Night Pillar around you. Follow this with

Night  Breathing. Now select the type of meditation.  There are actually two

ways of meditating,  and they differ by your conscious directive. The first

way of meditating will have you direct your thoughts on a particular subject.

For example, the subject can be on strength.  You will want to look at the

different types of strength.  Try to understand how strength develops and how

you can become stronger.   You can go on to becoming Pure Strength and the

qualities needed in your life to be  Strength.  As you continue to look fully

at the subject of strength and understand all that  there is about it your

conscious thoughts will slowly be overshadowed by your Oversoul,  and you will

be given true enlightenment on Strength, or any subject you should choose.

The second way deals with entering the Silence of your Oversoul.


Here you will not choose a topic but remain in a state of silence and complete

Openness  to the Indwelling Oversoul.  You must remain completely free of

thought.  You must not  enter into this meditation with cares or worries but

surrender them into the care of your  Oversoul.  As you advance into the

meditation you will become aware of Its Presence.   You will feel Its Energy.

Here the Oversoul will choose the subject of importance and  instruct you

directly. Remember, "to be Silent and Know".


Having chosen the type of meditation, turn your attention to within yourself

and give open recognition to the Oversoul within. If you feel a slight sense

of shaking or a raising of the  heart beat do not let it bother you.  It is a

good sign that what you want is taking place.   Remain very relaxed and allow

your thoughts to drift on the subject.  Do not overtire  yourself. If at first

you can only do five to ten minutes then that's fine. Do not push for

results.  The results will come in their own good time.  Meditate only as long

as you feel  comfortable with it. After you have finished don't get up and

plunge back into the work-a-day world.  Take it easy and allow yourself a few

minutes or however long is necessary to  adjust to a faster pace of living.

In Magician's Meditation, you slowed your rate of living  considerably.

Strive to attain but be patient for the results to happen.  You will not

attain  all you can be overnight but someday the Night will be yours.  There

is nothing greater  you can do for your quest on the Night Road then the

sincere practice of Night Magician's  Meditation.  In Night Magician's

Meditation you studied a method of changing your  conscious vibration and

attuning it with the Oversoul's Consciousness.  Now you are going  to explore

the very depths and heights of the Realm of Vibration. 16.  The Realm of

Vibration


The study of vibration is important to a Night Magician.  The actual magickal

progression made is a result of increased vibration of the physical,

emotional, mental, and causal  bodies. You must therefore begin with the

lowest level of vibration, the physical, and  study its nature.


Vibration is movement.  In the physical world, vibration is based on molecular

motion or movement.  The physical world is composed of small particles in

motion which are termed molecules. Molecules are composed of small particles

known as atoms.  Atoms are  composed of even smaller particles which are

protons, neutrons, and electrons.  If you  could become small enough you would

see that the electrons orbit around the nucleus  like the planets around the

Sun.  If you took the analogy farther, you would see that the  human body

would be composed of many solar and galactic systems.  The human body is  in

constant molecular motion which produces something akin to electricity.  There

are  machines today which can measure this very fine electricity.  The

combination of this fine  electricity added to the Energy of the Oversoul

causes sentient life.  All forms of matter  produce this fine energy due to

molecular motion.


Further, all matter, that is the mineral, plant, and animal kingdoms, are

guided in development, just as you are, by a Higher Power and therefore have

Life.  This Life is  perhaps not as you know Life, but yet it is Life.  As you

have seen, all forms of matter have  molecular activity.  This molecular

activity is very active in some forms and slower in  others.  The rock has a

very slow molecular, or vibrational rate, whereas the air has a very  high

vibrational rate.  This rate of vibration is termed frequency.  When the

vibrational rate  is high the frequency is high and the opposite is also true.

You have learned that matter  is in a constant state of motion.  That all

motion has a relative vibrational rate, or  frequency, dependent on the

molecular activity.  An important part of the physical realm of  vibration

which goes on to touch all levels of vibration is light and color.


Light and colors are dependent on matter and its rate of vibration.  Color is

important in  your physical life.  In a moment, you will discuss how it

effects the human body, but some background information on light and color

will prove beneficial. Light is energy.  Light is actually electromagnetic

radiation. When light strikes an object the molecules absorb  some of that

energy, and in turn, that which is not absorbed is reflected and radiated out

into the surrounding space.  This radiation is perceived by the eyes as color.

The  different colors seen are due to the different frequencies of that

radiation.  This frequency  is a slightly different term than that used to

describe molecular activity.  The frequency  used to measure color is based on

the fact that color is a radiation or energy.  Light is  separated into seven

basic frequencies.  These frequencies are seen as the colors red,  orange,

yellow, green, blue, indigo, and violet.  Red is of the lowest frequency and

violet  the highest. Here you have looked at the physical definitions of light

and color.  How,  though, can light and color be of benefit to the well-being

of your physical body?


You are familiar with how colors can effect one's mood.  A blue room for

example can  give one a feeling of peace and relaxation while a red room would

tend to make one feel  energetic or even nervous.  But few of us are aware of

how colors can effect the physical  body directly.  The entire principle

behind color healing is vibration.  Every part of your  body vibrates at a

particular frequency.  Disease is the result when any part of the body

develops disharmony or the wrong frequency.  Color radiation when directed at

the  particular area of imbalance, induces a sympathetic vibration into that

organ and corrects  the frequency of the organ back to its original frequency,

and thus, good health.  How can  this be done?


Before explaining this procedure its best to give this WARNING!!! Do not go

out based on  these teachings and setup a healing practice!  If you are not a

doctor, are you really sure  of what is wrong with the person?  You could be

sued if you end up hurting someone.  As  you progress magickally, you will

know through your Oversoul what is wrong with the  person and what color to

use.  Use this science to help only those to whom you are close  to and on

yourself.  Be absolutely sure of what you are doing.  If you have any doubts,

DON'T DO IT!   This is a great healing science if used wisely.  Be careful.

There are  several methods to induce color healing. No discussion will be made

here of the use of  color lamps for they will be replaced soon with a more

advanced machine.  What will be  discussed is the use of color meditation and

your own physical instrument, the body.


You are a channel for the higher energies.  You are a magnet for these

energies and by concentrating or meditating on the specific color necessary to

be applied you will  magnetize them to you and then be able to apply them to

the one needing healing.   Before discussing the actual procedure you must

prepare yourself as you did in  meditation.  Be sure you are in good health or

you could induce your illness into the one  your healing.  When you enter into

meditation it would be good to get a sheet of paper  with the color you wish

to magnetize and gaze on it.  As your meditation proceeds be sure  your ankles

and hands are crossed.  This conserves the energy you are magnetizing.

Visualize this color energy filling your Night Pillar. See the Pillar becoming

filled with the  color until it can hold no more.  Then you are ready to pass

it to the one in need of  healing.  If you are the one who needs healing see

that energy penetrating the area in  poor health.  See that part of the body

becoming whole and perfect. If it is another person  or anything needing the

color energy place your hands on the area that is ill. Again see  that energy

penetrating into that part and restoring it to perfect harmony and vibration.

You do not necessarily have to be present to administer the healing energy.

If the person  is somewhere else see your energy moving to that person.

Visualize that person and the area of illness and again see the energy making

all whole and perfect.  Be sure when you  are finished that you wash your

hands in cold running water.  It will be necessary to  continue the number of

treatments once every hour until the condition is relieved.  You  should apply

the healing for a period lasting fifteen minutes.  These continuous

treatments are necessary so that you are working in harmony with the cyclic

nature of the  body.  This time period allows the body adequate time to use

the energy being supplied  to it.  Also it allows you to know when to stop

treatment, for sometime in the forty-five  minute period, you can observe the

healing process and its progress.  The last subject to  discuss is the colors

themselves and what ailments they cure.  You will begin with the  lowest

frequency of color, red.


Red is vibrant and alive.  Red is a heating, vitalizing, and stimulating

color.  It is directly responsible for your physical vitality.  In cases where

there is a lack of energy red is an exceptional color.  It is effective in the

treatment of anemia and cancer.  It vitalizes the  blood and helps to purify

it.  Do not use this color when there is an inflammatory condition  present or

when the person is of excitable temperament.


The color orange has often been associated with the Sun.  It is necessary for

health and vitality.  It influences primarily the processes of assimilation

and circulation.  The color helps to regulate the intake of food and is

centered around the spleen. It is good for the treatment of asthma,

bronchitis, colds, and epilepsy.  It is further useful for the treatment  of

gout, inflammation of the kidneys, gall stones, cessation of menstruation, and

mental debility.


The color yellow acts as a tonic on the nerves.  It is an inspiring and

mentally stimulating color.  It is good for the treatment of dyspepsia,

diabetes, flatulence, and constipation.  Clear golden yellow is one of the

most powerful forces against depression and limitations  of every kind.

Yellow stimulates the brain as well as exerting great therapeutic influence

on the assimilative organs of the body.  Yellow also stimulates the purifying

action in the  body for it effects the liver, gall bladder, and intestines in

stimulating them and aiding in  the elimination of the body wastes.  Yellow

improves the texture of the skin, heals scars,  and heals other blemishes.


Green is the color of the Earth.  It is the color of harmony and balance.  It

has a soothing  effect upon the nerves.  It has a very powerful effect on the

blood supply and its  distribution throughout the body.  Green is an excellent

tranquilizer and is further  beneficial in the treatment of heart complaints,

blood pressure, and headaches.   Blue is the color of deep peace and harmony.

It acts upon the body as a powerful  antiseptic.  It is excellent in the

treatment of insomnia.  Blue is good in the treatment of  all throat diseases

and in the treatment of gall bladder attacks, jaundice, skin abrasions,  cuts,

burns, and rheumatism.


Indigo is the Healer for the eyes, ears, and nose.  It is excellent in the

treatment of  deafness, cataract, delirium tremens, and eye inflammation.  It

is good in the treatment of  lung disorders, pneumonia, asthma, bronchitis,

and indigestion.


Violet is the highest vibration of visible light.  Its effect is primarily in

the area of the brain.   It is good in the treatment of mental disorders,

cataracts, and paralysis.  Creative artist  and workers would benefit by

surrounding their room with objects of this color and  meditating and storing

this color.  It is excellent in the treatment of insomnia.


In closing, again use the colors carefully.  Do not use them excessively.  At

all times, you  should seek the guidance of your Oversoul.  Never prescribe

treatment to anyone.  And  above all, in the case of illness Consult your

Physician!  You can use this science to aid  your healing and that of others,

but it is not meant to replace the therapeutic care given by  your Physician.

I have made a small beginning in discussing the realm of vibration.  I  spoke

of the vibrating world around us and how all life is in constant motion.  I

discussed  the special world of light and colors and their relationship to the

human body.  In the next  topic you are going to explore some fascinating

information concerning the human body  and how it works.


17.  Night Centers and the Physical and Etheric Bodies    


In the Eastern languages the Night Centers are known as chakras. Night Centers

are  located in each type of body that you have, from the Etheric to the

Mental Body.  They are,  in appearance, small whirlpool-like vortices of

concentrated energy.  The Night Centers  are responsible for a number of

functions.  They are conveyors of the Night Force from  higher dimensions to

the lower ones.  They act as step-down transformers taking the  higher energy

and lowering it to meet the requirements of each body. They further  function

as message centers.  They connect each dimension from the higher ones to the

lower with an internal form of communication keeping your entire system of

bodies in  rapport with each other.  They have other functions but these will

be covered in later  topics.  You are presently going to look at two bodies,

the physical and Etheric, and the  role of the Night Centers to each.  Let's

look at the physical body first.


In the physical body there is a corresponding organ and/or gland to each of

the Night  Centers. The lowest of the centers is at the base of the spine and

relates to the gonads.   The second of these centers is located over the area

of the spleen and is associated with  the spleen/pancreas. The third Night

Center is located over the navel area or the solar  plexus and corresponds to

the adrenal glands.  The fourth is located over the heart region  and relates

to the thymus gland. The fifth is located in the throat area and relates to

the  thyroid gland.  The sixth Night Center is located in the brow area and

relates to the pineal  gland.  The seventh Night Center is located at the top

or crown of the head and is  associated with the pituitary gland. What is

interesting and important to observe is that  the organs make up the

endocrine system.


These glands produce a substance called hormone which is spilled into the

blood stream  to regulate every cell in the body.  These glands further effect

the growth and  development of the physical body; the way you feel; and even

the way you think.  The  endocrine system is regulated by the nervous system.

Here there is an important parallel.   For every Night Center there is a nerve

center that corresponds to it too.  These nerve  centers are closely related

to the glands they regulate, which are those of the endocrine  system.  This

leads us to the Night Centers, Etheric Body, and their relationship to your

bodily control.


The Etheric Body is produced by the electromagnetic energy generated by the

physical  body. The Etheric is an exact counterpart to the physical body.  The

Etheric Body  interpenetrates the physical body and extends from a half inch

to four inches around the  physical body and can be seen by the Night Eye as a

whitish blue light.  The Etheric Body  is the lowest body where the Night

Centers can be found.  The Oversoul influences the  body through the

transmission of Night Force through the Higher Night Centers which  continues

to be stepped down till the energies enter the Etheric vortices which in turn

affects the nerve centers, endocrine system, and the body overall.  They are

all  interrelated.  The two Night Centers which directly effect the well-being

of the physical  body are the lowest two.


The lowest center found at the base of the spine contains the Earth Fire.  In

the Eastern religions it is called Kundalini.  I will discuss this Energy in a

later topic but for now I will discuss the intake of Earth Force, a less

concentrated form of the Earth Fire.  Those who  have ever lived in a

high-rise apartments and worked in similar offices may recall feeling  very

tired and run down.  This is due to lack of direct contact with the Earth.  It

is essential  for humans to remain in contact with the Earth.  When the body

makes direct contact with  the Earth, the base Night Center is then able to

absorb the Earth's energy. Everyone  should take time to get outdoors in

direct contact with Mother Earth and absorb that vital  energy.  In a later

topic, I will present a rite to help keep the Earth energies high in

yourself.  The second Night Center concerned with your well-being is located

over the  spleen/pancreas and absorbs the pranic force generated by the Sun.

This is the second energy necessary for the well-being of your physical body.

An  adequate intake of this energy will give you good health.  It will give

you vitality, youth,  and a zest for life.    As was mentioned earlier, the

Etheric extends beyond and around the  outline of the body approximately a

half to four inches.  It is bluish grey to bluish white in  color.  When a

person is in good health the Etheric will be strong in appearance and  extend

several inches beyond the outline of the body.  In poor health or when one is

low  in energy the Etheric will be close to the body and hard to see.  How do

you see the  Etheric?


Etheric sight is the best way to begin to see magickally.  Since this energy

is of lesser  vibration then that of auric energy it will be easier to see

with the Night Eye.  For a  moment, let's discuss exactly what is the Night

Eye and then the mechanics of how it  operates.


The Night Eye and its existence have been known since the time of the Ancient

Ones.  In  the Eastern languages it's referred to as the "Third Eye" .  The

Night Eye is a magickal  organ that when activated allows you to see the

higher dimensions.  The Night Eye is also  capable of enlarging microscopic

particles till you can see them.  This is very similar to  the microscope and

its function.  For most, the Night Eye is closed and blind to the higher

realm, but through the techniques and practices in this work you will learn to

use and see  through the Night Eye. The mechanics of the Night Eye will be

discussed in greater depth  in a later topic.  For now, the Night Eye is

related to the sixth Night Center and the pineal  gland.  When they are

functioning under your voluntary control then you are able to see  magickally.

Knowledge of the exact mechanics is not necessary in order for you to see

through the Night Eye.  What is necessary is knowing the techniques for

opening and  using the Night Eye and then plenty of practice. Therefore, let's

perform some exercises  to begin its development.


To convince yourself more fully that there really is an Etheric Body begin

with the  following experiment.  One night as you are in bed, lie on your back

with your feet spread  apart.  Then slowly bring your feet together until you

can feel them touch each other.   When you feel them just touch try and see if

you can put them together any closer.  You  will be surprised to find that you

can.  This distance is the area occupied by the Etheric.   You can also do

this with another person.  Try touching the other person on an area of  bare

skin.  The neck and head area is the best.  Touch them with one finger very

lightly  and then slowly remove the finger to about one inch away.  The person

will not be able to  tell the difference when you are touching and when you

are not.   Now that you are more  fully convinced that there is an Etheric,

let's move on and see it.


It will be easier if you get another person to help you.  Have that person

stand against a  neutral background, the best color is white, and have them

relax and breathe deeply.  The  lighting is very important.  The light should

be behind you and positioned such that it will  not produce a shadow on the

subject.  The lighting should be dim.  You should now  position yourself away

from the subject about six to ten feet and sit or stand in a  comfortable

position.  Relax and breathe deeply.  Look at the subject and let your eyes

relax.  Do not concentrate on seeing anything.  Look beyond the subject as if

looking off  into the distance.  The subject's Etheric Energy will extend

around the outline of the  physical body.  If you are alone you can still

practice seeing the Etheric.


Have a mirror positioned in front of you such that you can see the upper body

outline.   Have behind you a background of neutral color.  Do the same as

outlined above as if you  had someone before you.  In all the work, outlined

above, do not become discouraged if  results do not occur the first time.  Be

patient and know that all is, and will, work for you if  you but try. No one

can become a Master Night Magician without great practice and  perseverance.

So you, too, can be a Master of Night Magick if you will but practice and

persevere.  You leave the Realm of the Etheric and Magickal Sight to enter

into the Realm  of Magickal Sound.


18.  The Power of Sound    


Ever see an opera singer shatter a crystal glass?  It is said that words are

things and once spoken may cause the very thing to happen.  Can there really

be so much to the spoken  word? Let's explore the physical properties of the

spoken word, or in other words, sound  and its properties and discover the

secret.


You first must learn that sound is caused by vibrating structures.  That for

sound to travel  it must move through a material substance or medium.  Sound

travels as a wave motion.  As a sound wave travels, in a medium, small

displacements occur to the molecules in that  medium or substance.  These

small displacements are a regular collective motion in  which all the

molecules, in a small volume of matter, move together.  Think of this motion

as compared to a small volume of water held by a container in which you would

see a  wave moving in the volume of water.  This ordered wave motion is

superimposed on the  random thermal agitation or vibration of the molecules.

We, therefore, look at sound  waves as the molecules of the substance jiggling

back and forth in a regular fashion.  You  know that sound is the result of

vibrating bodies but beyond this you must know that a  traveling sound wave

transports energy.


When this sound wave is incident on, or striking, a body of matter there is

absorption of  that sound wave's energy by that body.  In some cases this will

force the body to vibrate at  the frequency of the incident wave.  A state of

resonance will occur when the vibration of  the body and that of the incident

wave are close in natural frequency.  Sound can do some  phenomenal things.

For example, remember the high pitched note of the singer, when it  is

incident upon the crystal glass, causes it to break.  But even greater is the

Power of the  spoken word or sound energy, when that energy is transmitted on

the carrier wave of  creative magickal thought.  The spoken word is endowed

with the Night Force when the  creative thought behind that word is that of

Night Consciousness.  Your words are  endowed with Night Force when your

Magickal Consciousness is that of the Oversoul.   Your words are as potent as

your consciousness is equal to that of Night Consciousness.   For your words

to be life and accomplish that where they are sent, then your  consciousness

must be that of the Oversoul.  Your will is the selector of the words, but for

them to be more then mere words they must be endowed with Night Force through

Night  Consciousness.  Let's try it.


To begin with first see yourself as the Oversoul.  Feel the Night Presence of

your own  Oversoul selecting the words with which you wish to create with.

Then speak the words  knowing that it is not you that says the words, but that

it is the Oversoul who says the  Words.  Then those Words will go forth and do

as they are sent forth to do.  The greater  your attunement with your

Oversoul, the greater will be the potency of the Words.  Keep  your thoughts

in tune with your Oversoul at all times.  For your words to take on the Night

Force you must become the Oversoul in all you do. Repeat the Words over and

over again  till you can feel the words take on a life of their own.  Repeat

them till your words are  endowed with Night Force then they will go forth and

create as you have said.  There are  no limitations to what your Words in

Night Consciousness may do.  They can bring to you  your heart's desire.  They

can literally move mountains.  They can create life.  There are  no

limitations to what you can do, so long as it is in accord with your Oversoul.

As you are  filled with the Sound of the Oversoul, now to fill yourself with

the Energies of the Earth.


19.  Earth Rite  


Your body is very much like that of the Earth.  As was shown in an earlier

topic, the body  has interspaced in it an Etheric Body. This is your magnetic

field just as the Earth has a  magnetic field.  It is essential to your good

health to be in contact with the Earth.  The  Earth currents mixed with your

own magnetic currents keep you in good health.  You will  experience less

tension and frustration.  If you can do nothing else you should get out into

the country and go barefoot.  Here though, I would like to introduce a rite

which will allow  you to absorb a great deal more Earth Energy.


The Earth's energy is of the highest order.  You may feel that the Earth is an

unclean  place and that its energies are of the same order.  This is not true!

Man's attitude is the  harmful energy which is slowly destroying the Earth

itself.  From the Oversoul's viewpoint  the Earth is covered in a dense

blanket of Man's wrongful attitude concerning the Earth.   The Earth is the

Body of a magickally advanced Being and Its Energies are of the deepest

order.  Let's look specifically at how to absorb these life giving energies.


The only place to do this rite is outdoors.  You should select a place which

is free of  Man's urbanization.  Go out into a park or a private woods.  Go

somewhere so that you  won't be disturbed. Once you have selected a place that

feels right sit down and get  comfortable.  Your bottom should be in direct

contact with the Earth.  Do not sit in a chair.   Next begin with deep

breathing, relax, and let all tension go.  When you are perfectly  relaxed

begin to feel your own Etheric Body.  Feel your magnetic current touching the

magnetic current of the Earth.  When you breathe in, you will draw the Earth

Energy up  into your body via the Night Centers.  See this energy flowing up

through the base center  and flow on higher and higher through each center

until it reaches the crown center.   When it has reached this far, hold the

energy there and allow it to penetrate your entire  being.    Then, as you

exhale, see the tired and tense energies of your own body flow  back out of

your body and being absorbed by the Earth.  The Earth will change and  charge

these energies with Earth Force. Continue this exercise as long as you feel

comfortable.  During this exercise you should feel a communion and Oneness

with the Soul of the Earth.  The Earth is a Magickal Fountain of the Darkest

Night.  Drink from it  and be renewed!


You have traveled far on the Earth Road.  You have learned a great deal about

yourself.   You have come to know the hidden faculties and powers that lie

within you.  But as all  things on Earth must end so in the next topic, you

will come to know your own ending and  this chapter on Earth Magick.


20.  The Physical Realm of Death    


It has always been said that people fear the unknown.  One of the greatest

unknowns in  life is death.   Dying is as important as living on Earth.  Dying

does not have to be a big  unknown. There does not have to be fear of death.

To end the fear of dying one must  look at death and understand it.


Your life is sustained only so long as the silver cord is attached to your

physical body.   This is your lifeline from your Oversoul to that which you

know as "I".  In the actual  physical process of dying it takes three complete

days for this cord to separate.  The body  should be left alone and

undisturbed as much as possible till then.  As you are  separating, you feel

like a cloud drifting over your physical body.  After three days, you  will

cast off like a ship adrift on the seas.  The process of dying is entirely

painless and  you should have no fear.  Before casting off for the next

dimension, you are required to  view the actual process of the preparation of

your body for burial.  This is to convince you  that your physical body has

actually died, but that you still live.  Here, it might be  appropriate to say

something about those who are left behind.


In the west, you have been taught that you should grieve for the one who has

departed.  It  would be more appropriate to celebrate for they now have left

this world for a new world  of happiness and joy.  In this new world there is

no suffering, hunger, or struggle for  survival.  You grieve over another's

dying for many reasons, but mostly at the loss you  feel and at being alone.

How can you overcome this grief?


First, you should realize that you will someday be reunited with them if you

wish.  Only  those in harmony with each other can reunite, for only harmony

can exist on the other  side.  You should also realize that you should not

grieve so much for the one gone, for  you tend to disturb their rest and

recuperation on the other side.  What can you do to help  the person who is

suffering from grief?


The best help you can provide is to be the "listening ear".  You should do

everything in  your power to help the person talk out their grief.  Let them

talk to you about the sorrow  they feel over their loss and talk about how it

was in the past.  Keep them company and  let them cry all they want.  Crying

and tears are the greatest safety valve the human body  has.  This prevents an

emotional overload causing perhaps insanity.  Allow the person a  reasonable

time to express their grief.  But this should not go on for ever and ever.

Grief  can not be allowed to go too far. It will cause the person to develop

self-pity and this is  just as bad.  Dying to this world is birth to the next

and higher world.  There is a practice which will assist you in the process of

dying.  You should prepare  yourself through meditation.  Meditate on the

subject of death as has been described  here.  See yourself at the time of

dying.  Feel and know yourself developing as a cloud of  consciousness over

the physical body.  See yourself actually trying to get out of that old  dying

house.  Then you should see and visualize the person you want to come help you

and meet you.  Feel their presence very strong and know that they are there to

help you  make the transition.  If you have no one special to come get you,

know that there are  special helpers waiting to assist you into the next

dimension.  Have no fear for you are  never alone.  Know that just as soon as

there is complete separation of the silver cord  from the physical body that

they will assist you to the next realm.  Then allow yourself to  relax and

wait out the physical process of dying.  There is no pain nor fear to

experience,  only the beginning of a new day in a new world.  The only thing

you will experience is the  feeling of going home.   This simple process of

meditating on the transition from one  world to the next can relieve much

anxiety and worry when the actual time seems near.   There is no way that

meditating on death can bring about the actual thing.  Only the  Oversoul

knows the time of transition and can cause it to happen.  So rest assured,

that in  dying from the physical world, the process is simple, easy, and

merely a phase of  transition necessary to enter the next world beyond.  Now

you must also make the  transition from one chapter in Night Magick to the

next.


You must leave behind the Earth Realm and enter the Water Realm. You have seen

many wonders in the Earth Realm.  You have learned better ways of breathing

and things about  your body you may have never known about.  You are opening

your Night Eye by learning  about and seeing your Etheric Body.  You should be

acquiring better health and a  sounder mind through meditation and the use of

colors.  I must emphasize here, before  leaving Earth Magick, that no matter

how far you go do not stop practicing the techniques,  rites, and exercises

learned early in this book. Always take time to meditate and practice  Night

Breathing.  All the things you have learned, so far, are essential for your

success  later on.  If you are ready to explore a fascinating realm and

discover many new wonders,  then let's enter into the exciting Realm of Water

Magick.


CHAPTER V



WATER MAGICK


21.  The Water (Astral) Realm 


Here you will enter a land of great beauty.  A land of Harmony and Peace.  In

the last  topic, you had just left your dying body, the silver cord had

separated, and you were set  off adrift.  At this point, it is essential that

you believe that there is continuity in life after  physical death, otherwise

you will simply drift in a dense, dark fog, until slowly you  realize, that

you are still conscious and alive.  As soon as doubt is gone, the clouds will

dissipate and your loved ones will be there to help you.


In the first stage of transition, you will be allowed time to recuperate.  The

process of  living on Earth and the troubles of the long years spent there

have made you very weary.   In the new realm that you have just entered, you

are given time to rest from your journey  on Earth and to adjust to the Astral

Realm. Everyone, no matter what their magickal  attainment, must enter this

level of the Astral Realm.  It has been referred to, by some  religions, as

purgatory.   You are here in order to rest, purify yourself of human dross and

make decisions about your magickal future.  Your magickal development

determines the  level of purgatory you first arrive at.


For souls who are of the lowest and crudest of development, there is a very

low vibrational level for them.  At this level, acts of the worst kind, akin

to their own vibrations, are  portrayed before them.  The things that they did

wrong on Earth are done to them.  This is  a very dense region.  This is not a

land of punishment and torture, but a place to show the  individual the folly

of such a life and a place to rid the soul of its denser energies.  This is

not Hell.  There is no such place as Hell.  If Hell is anywhere it is right

here on Earth.  It is  what humankind has made of the Earth.


Above this there is the next level which some go immediately to and some come

up to  from a lower level.   This level is for souls who allowed their lower

passions to rule them.   For those who sought after money and power without

maintaining the Eternal Night  Balance.  This region is very much akin to the

physical plane just left behind.  The Astral  surroundings will be very

similar to those of the Earth.  Here the souls will remain, till they  rid

themselves of the courser Astral material, so that they may go ever higher.

They rid  themselves of this dense Astral material by learning control of

their passions.  They must  make up the Eternal Balance.  From here we go to

the level you probably rose to from the  beginning.


You rise to the level where generally all begin who are of a basically good

nature.  This  land is filled with beautiful parks and lakes.  There are very

beautiful buildings all around  you.  There are colors never before seen by

you.  The air is alive with energy and life.   Animal life is abundant and

tame.  There is beautiful music everywhere in the air.  Here in  this realm no

disharmony can occur.  No one can meet anyone who would cause them

unhappiness of any kind.  When you first arrive, your loved ones or magickal

helpers will  be there to assist you.  In this realm, all that you want is

produced by your thoughts.   Travel is by thought.  If you want to wear

clothes then you must think of yourself dressed  as you want to be dressed.

Your nourishment is all around you.  All you have to do is  breathe.  Your

physical habits that you learned on Earth will still be with you.  You may

feel that you still have to eat.  This is fine. You need only think of the

food you want to eat  plus the table and so forth necessary to eat it with.

But the sooner you learn to forget the  old physical habits, and learn and

experience your new Astral Body, the sooner you will  be able to progress.

This is a very real world.  This world is as solid and real to its

inhabitants as your own Earth is to you.  But there are some who see this

realm slightly  different.


For some souls who believe in an exact type of heaven according to their

religious beliefs,  or even of the opposite region, and feel that this is

where they are going, then this is what  they will see.  If they believe that

they will see the Pearly Gates and St. Pete at them, then  this is what they

will see.  Gradually though, imperfections will show up here and there.   The

gates may squeak or even fall off the hinges as they start to open.  The

angels, flying  about, may suddenly be wearing flannel shirts and play off-key

on their rusty harps.   When the person has enough doubts about their

make-believe heaven, then like a dream,  it will disappear and the real Astral

Realm will appear and so their beloved ones too.


It is best to keep an open mind when you make the transition. This will

quicken your entry into your new realm and life.  After you have become

adjusted to this new realm, you will  be escorted to a building where you will

review your recent life and past lives you have  lived.  All that you have

ever done will be shown to you on what has been called in some  religions the

Akashic Record, and by others, the Book of Records.  Let's look at this

Record and see what it is?


The Night Record, as you will come to know it, is a special energy upon which

everything  that has ever occurred to anyone and anything is recorded.  There

is further shown, on the  Night Record, the probabilities for the future.

This Record not only can show what has  occurred on the Earth, but for

anyplace located anywhere.  This Record can be seen by   those who have made

the Earth transition in order to look at their life just lived, and by  those

of high magickal development who have a need to see. The Record is not for the

use of just anyone.


So, you were just entering the Night Record Hall and preparing to review your

life.  You  see the things you did and the things you shouldn't have done.

You see the things you  were supposed to have done and learned.  No one judges

you but yourself and your  Oversoul!   You are your own sternest judge.  It is

through your Oversoul that you see  where you have gone wrong and what your

Oversoul wanted you to accomplish in your  life.  You are then led out of the

Hall by your guide and taken to a council of advisors.  These advisors are

trained to aid you in reviewing your lives and determining the best  means for

accomplishing the previous desired results wanted by your Oversoul and thus

planning your future. You are placed in the proper circumstances, at the

proper time, to  achieve the desired results.  After this planning, you will

retire to the Astral Realm of your  vibration and rest and prepare yourself

for the next phase of life.


You are responsible for all that you do in life.  You are responsible for the

debts you  occur in life and for repaying your debts.  No one will pay your

debts except you.  The bad  and good you create is called Karma.  Karma and

the Astral Realm are deeply related.  It  is at this plane of life that you

make decisions which will effect your future.  Until you  learn the lessons

necessary to be learned on the Earth plane then you must continue to  return

until you have learned all there is to be learned.  Who determines when you

have  learned all that there is to be learned?  The Oversoul is who!


In a Process not described here, your future is woven out of your magickal

essence in the  Astral Realm.  This magickal fabric that is being woven

contains the basic kinds of  programs.  By programs, I am referring to

programs very similar to that used by the  computer so that it can carry out

its basic functions.  One of your inner programs sets for  you predetermined

events which you must experience.  These events are the results of  energies

you have set into motion from out of the past which must be again experienced

and worked through.  Further, they can be events, not necessarily a result of

your past but  of events which you need to experience to make you stronger and

a better instrument for  your Oversoul.  The second program is for you to

make.


These are periods which allow you to determine the path you will choose.  They

are like a blank tape upon which you write your future.  You know when you

have entered these  periods for you feel like a ship adrift on the seas.  All

the familiar surroundings,  experiences, and securities in your life are gone.

They are not easy times for you, but  they are the greatest periods for your

soul growth.  They bring to you periods of inner  growth, new directions in

your life, and a chance to accelerate your magickal growth.  In  these

periods, you are the Captain of your Destiny.  By the choices you make and the

opportunities you take to advance, your future is set in motion.  These

periods allow you  to clear up excess karmic debt.  They will bring to you new

friends, teachers, and many  changes which if taken advantaged of, will allow

you to achieve great magickal growth.   You must watch for these periods and

take all the advantage of them you can.  You have  to be tough.  They will

test the very essence of that which you are made of.  You must do  the very

best you can in all that you do.  You must be strong and know that you are

guided.  You never fail in life if you can say that you did your best.  You

can gain these learning experiences in the Astral Realm just as you can learn

them on Earth.  So why  would you want to leave the Astral world.


In the Astral, life is full of harmony and beauty.  It would take a long time

to learn even the easiest of lessons.  So, in order for the Oversoul to grow

at a fast rate, it chooses to send  a part of itself, being you, to learn

quickly in the "School of Hard Knocks".  You know that  you grow fastest when

you have to learn the hard way.  You learn your lessons quickly  and well.  If

life was all fun and games you would never learn, so life is not easy.  There

are some lessons that can only be learned on Earth. A hard life may not

necessarily be a  sign of large karmic debt, but a period of quick growth and

possible advancement.  How  many lifetimes does it take before you don't have

to come back here anymore?


No one can really say how many lives it will take except your Oversoul.  There

is only so  much that can be learned from each sojourn on Earth.  There are so

many things that  must be learned from living on Earth.  You keep coming here

to the Earth until you have  learned all the lessons necessary and until the

Oversoul is in charge of your life.  Each of  your lives adds to the Eternal

Essence which is your Oversoul.  Yet this idea of  reincarnation or the

returning to life on Earth time and time again scares many.


They don't like reincarnation because they are afraid that they will lose

their individuality. Well, you never lose that individuality.  Your Oversoul

can be compared to a vessel of  water.  In that vessel of water, if you add

some red dye the water will appear red add the  color yellow and you will have

orange.  Each color is still there but their added essence  creates a new

whole. Thus you add each individuality into the Oversoul.  The Oversoul  grows

and becomes more then it just was by that new addition.  You are still that

individuality but you are in cooperative union with all the other parts which

make up the  sum, which is the Oversoul. When you have learned all that must

be learned, then you no  longer have to return to the Earth. You then pass

beyond the Astral World when you have  learned all that you have to learn

there. There are many things to learn in the Astral.


There is the special group that is responsible for the souls making the

transition from the Earth to the Astral.  There are those who weave the soul

fabric for a soul's journey to  Earth. There are also teachers, doctors,

nurses, advisors, and guides to those still living  on Earth. You can, after

gaining all that you must learn in the Astral, die or leave this  dimension

and go on to an even higher realm.  You could also go on to a more advanced

planet and civilization and begin the cycle of life and death there.  The

variables are  endless and the choice of your Oversoul.  I have referred to

the Astral Realm as the Water  Realm.  In Night Magick, the things you will

learn of this realm are known as Water  Magick.


From the beginning, the Ancients have likened the Astral Realm to water

because things  of the Astral involve the emotions.  The Astral Body is the

body of emotions.  You feel and  express emotions because you have an Astral

Body.  It is the purpose of Water Magick to  help you gain control over, and

to refine, your Astral Body.  The instruction, exercises, and  rites are

presented here to accomplish this purpose.  This is the hardest body to gain

control over.  The emotions in most people run wild and out-of-control.

People give into  their emotions without trying to gain any self-control.  You

have to learn to control your  emotions in order to have magickal growth.  You

must make the Astral Body an  instrument worthy of the Oversoul.  It must

become an Instrument through which the  Oversoul pours out Its Night Energies

into the world.  You must strive at all times to be  consciously aware that as

you feel and express emotions that actually it is the Oversoul  who feels and

expresses through you. That control over your emotions and the expression  of

Night Force comes only through constant communion with your Oversoul.  Strive

for this  communion at all times.  You are the Oversoul in emotional

expression here on Earth.   Through the Oversoul you will succeed.  Let's

begin immediately learning exercises for  emotional control and magickal

advancement.


22.  The Astral Body and Exercises for Emotional Control 


On each realm of life that the Oversoul lives on there is a necessity for a

vehicle made up  of that realm's essence in order for the Oversoul to find

expression in that realm.  The  vehicle you are most familiar with is the

physical body.  It is made up of dense physical  matter.  You know from

earlier discussions that there is a large amount of space between  all the

molecules of the physical body.  Interspaced in the physical body can be found

the  Astral molecules which make up the Astral Body.


In the Astral Realm, your Astral Body and all the Astral surroundings are as

solid and real  to you as is your physical body and surroundings, when you are

in the physical realm.   The Astral Body is much more refined, and vibrating

at a higher vibration, then is the  physical body.  The Astral Body has the

same identical form as your physical body.  When  you are in the Astral Realm

though, your Astral Body is very beautiful and without  imperfections.  There

are no signs of ageing as there are in the physical world.  The Astral  form

is very beautiful and the face is of exquisite beauty.  There is no ugliness

or lack of  harmony in the Astral.  The Astral Body exists simultaneously with

the physical body and  all other bodies as well.  While you are in the

physical body, the Astral Body is the body  through which you feel.  It is the

body through which the Oversoul impresses and  communicates with you.


At night, when you sleep, it is the body through which you experience dreams.

Dreams  are often distortions of your experiences in the Astral Realm.  The

Astral Body is the body  of emotions.  The Astral Body can be likened to an

emotion magnet. When you express  an emotion, you actually charge the

surrounding Astral material with that emotion.  You  have experienced this

happening.


For example, when you have gotten someone angry, you can actually feel the

atmosphere around that person become alive with anger. You have also seen this

when someone  expresses love for another. The Astral material which surrounds

you and the physical  world is made up of charged Astral Energy.  For the

Earth, this energy is of a dense  nature.


There are all kinds of emotional energies which make up the astral material

around the  Earth. These energies range from love to hate.  On the Earth you

can have inharmony  and discord and harmony and accord.  This is what is meant

by dense.  You can express  any emotions while on Earth.


When you express an emotion, such as hate, the energy which is of like quality

in the  Astral is attracted to you.  You can see that your hate, added to the

greater hate which is  surrounding you only makes your hatred more intense.

You can then become consumed  with hate, so much so, that you may lose control

and seriously hurt through that hate.   Long after the hate seems to have left

you, it still remains within your Astral Aura.  The  slightest thing can

trigger again this hate reaction and more hate energy will be  generated.

This is what happens from a lack of emotional control.


As I've said, the world as a whole is made up of many kinds of emotional

energies.  The  energies are there to use and express with control.  Without

control, you become a pawn  for domination by the emotional energies

surrounding you.  You must begin by learning  to refine your Astral Body.  To

learn to place it under the control of your Oversoul.  Let me  introduce some

exercises which will help you gain self-control.


Begin by deliberately slowing yourself down.  When you drive on the road

always let the  other person go first.  Slow down when you drive.  If you will

drive the speed limit, or five  miles an hour below it, you will be passed by

all.  When you walk do it slowly.  Let others  enter a building or room ahead

of yourself. The idea is to slow down.  This is the first  exercise and the

next involves your use of meditation. When you are in meditation, visualize a

cleansing energy moving through your Astral  Body and Night Centers.  See that

energy cleansing all emotional energy and replacing it  with the Night Force.

Visualize bliss, peace, and ecstasy filling your entire being.  Next,

visualize any act which you know produces an out- of-control emotional

response within  yourself.  See that event occurring and you remaining in

perfect control.  Do this with all  events and slowly you will gain control.

Learn to disassociate from an emotional world of  chaos.


The world rids itself of an over abundance of chaotic energies through natural

means.   These include such events as hurricanes, tornados, earthquakes,

floods, and violent  storms.  They are the world's safety valves when the

human emotional energies become  too much.  You can help to prevent these

occurrences by correcting your own energy  production.  In meditation, you can

visualize the entire world and do for it what you did for  yourself above.

See that cleansing energy fill the world.  See the emotional energies of

humankind balanced and in order.  If you will do this daily the world will

become a more  stable environment.  This is your first step on the Road of

Water Magick.  Your next  involves the Astral Aura and its relationship to

colors.


23.  Astral Aura, Color, and Exercises  


Around you, shaped like an egg, is the electromagnetic energy known as the

aura.  Each  body produces its own aura.  The most studied aura is the product

of the Astral Body.  I  will discuss the astral aura, its relationship to

colors, and exercises for seeing and  strengthening the aura.


The aura surrounds your body like an egg with the point at the feet.  In the

average  individual the aura extends approximately twelve to eighteen inches

around the body.  As  you develop magickally the aura enlarges.  The

electromagnetic energy is perceived by  the Night Eye as color.


In the Astral aura, these colors reflect the emotions which make up the

individual.  The  colors of the aura generally extend up to the eyes with the

halo region just beyond that.   Out of the top of the head extends a fountain

of energy in the more advanced soul.  This  halo region is the strongest

region of energy and is the easiest to see using your Night  Eye.  On the

outer fringes of the aura is the Auric Sheath.


This is a skin-like film and completely encloses the aura.  On the auric

sheath, which can  be compared to a translucent screen, the subconscious mind

projects a variety of thought pictures.  On this screen can be seen images of

thoughts and even past life images.   Before you learn to see the aura, let's

look at what the auric colors reveal about people.


To begin with, some of the colors seen reflect current emotional expression.

For  example, anger will flash into the aura as a deep, dark blackish-red.

This color will  generally last only as long as a person feels the emotion,

although residuals of this anger  will remain for sometime.  The second kind

of colors seen reflect long standing emotional  states.  You'll remember in

the last topic that the emotional energy produced by your  Astral Body was a

magnetic attracter for similar energy.


For example, if you become angry a great deal, then this energy tends to

concentrate in  your aura.  The concentration tends to increase for

surrounding anger energy is attracted  to the anger energy already in your

aura.  Thus, you will see a heavy concentration of  blackish-red in your aura

which remains there over long periods of time.   It won't  dissipate so long

as you continue to create this energy.  This applies to all kinds of

emotional energy.


There are seven basic colors in the aura.  They are red, orange, yellow,

green, blue,  indigo, and violet.  All the colors and their shades indicate a

particular emotion or  something about the character of an individual.  Take

each color and try to learn as much  about it as it pertains to people.  Some

things you will learn about colors will come from  your experiences over the

years.  Colors can first be broken down into two main groups.   The red,

orange, yellow group are full of energy.  They represent people who are

vibrant.   These are people who are extroverts. They are the worlds'

socialites.  The second group,  green, blue, indigo, and violet are the

introverts.  These are the quiet, less social people.   They are more

concerned with their interests then those of the world.


The color red rules the physical world.  It is the color of Earth's fertility.

It is the color of activity and creativeness. When seen as a clear, bright red

in the aura it signifies people  who possesses the attributes of ambition,

leadership, sociability, and strong character.  It  indicates force, vigor,

and vitality in people.  They will have a strong sex drive.  They will  be

pioneers. They will love adventure and have a great need for new friends and

new  things.  These are very aggressive people.  This does lead to some

problems.


Red makes people very impulsive.  They are apt to be abrupt and impatient in

all things.   They are very earthy in their ways. This is the person with

clear, bright red in their aura.   But there are many modifications to the

color red that can be see in the aura.  Dark red  indicates a deep passion or

emotion within. A person who is sometimes domineering and  brash.  A light red

indicates irritability, nervousness, and one who is excitable.  A bright  red

flashing on a black background indicates extreme anger arising from hatred and

malice.  A brick red is for conceit and reddish brown is for deceit.  A dark

scarlet is for the  strongest, sensual love.  A coral color pink is for

immaturity in teenagers; childishness  and insecurity in adults.  A clear,

rose pink is for a friendly, selfless loving person.  The  people who have red

in the best and clearest colors are leaders of the world.  They are

one-pointed, high spirited, and seek after what they want on their high

driving force.   These are people of high energy and a color you could use

some of in your aura.  This is  the color of creation.


The color orange is related in some ways to the color red.  The color orange

is formed by  the blending of the red and yellow colors.  It is the color of

vitality.  When this color is  found in the aura it indicates people who are

in good health and full of vitality.  Orange  indicates that they are

considerate towards others.  They are the humanitarian.  It can  further

indicate people who are creative, even to the extent of genius.  This is a

social  person.  Again, you see the red nature of this color. These are people

who like to get  along with others and be liked in return. They like to lead

an adventurous life.  They look  for events in their lives which offer

excitement.  They are lovers of freedom and look  forward to all that is new.

Shades of orange represent many things.


A dark orange indicates one full of self-pride.  A brownish orange represents

one who is  lazy. It could also indicate someone who is subject to kidney

trouble.  If muddy and  cloudy orange is present in the aura it indicates a

person of low intellect.  But yellowish  golden orange in the aura shows

self-control and efficiency in all things.  I have indicated  what orange can

mean when seen in the aura.  Let's go a bit further and see what orange

induced into your aura through meditation can do for you.


The color orange is a color which can induce change into your system.  It is

an energy for dealing with problems which can be changed to a more positive

situation.  For example,  let's say you have an inferiority problem.  You

always feel unmatched towards any  problem.  You perhaps have a low opinion of

yourself and never feel able to deal with life.   The orange light can change

this attitude.  It can make you feel free of limitations.  It will  add zest

and optimism in your life.  Orange helps to induce change into your thinking

processes so that you can assimilate new ideas.  It also induces stability in

your thinking.   As you will recall, orange is made up of two colors.  The

first was red and the second is  yellow.


Yellow is the color of the mind.  It signifies all there is in relation to

intelligence.  In the  aura, a bright, clear yellow represents good mental

capabilities.  This color is very  prominent in the halo region.  An excess of

this color denotes people who spend almost  all their time after mental

pursuits. These people have very quick minds.  They are able to  realize their

mental capabilities.  They have a desire to help other people through the

products of their mental abilities.  They do tend to be shy and slightly

introverted.  They  control their anger easily. They are the concrete thinker.

They deal in hard physical  realities.  This is a good color for scientists

and professors.  If the colors are of a softer,  paler shades, then this is

good for the writer, artist, and all creative workers. Diffused  yellow, in

the aura, indicates people who are tactful, cheerful, and use discrimination

in  all they do.  They do not worry about mundane things.  They are generally

happy, friendly,  and helpful to others.  If the yellow is muddy, mustard

yellow it shows craftiness.  A  grayish cast to the yellow shows mental

cunning.  A greenish yellow aura it indicates  jealousy.  Pinkish yellow shows

astuteness in people.  A dingy yellow shows cowardice  and reddish yellow

shows mental, moral, and physical timidity.  Yellow induced into the  physical

body leads to the regeneration of the human cells keeping the body in beauty

and health.  Yellow effects the Astral Body by inducing a state of emotional

well-being.  It  further helps the mental capabilities by sharpening them and

improving the memory.  It  will make the mind quicker and able to more easily

assimilate new material. Yellow  qualities help to produce the next color.


Green is the color of Earth.  It is the garment that clothes the Goddess/God

of Earth.  This  is the color which symbolizes balance, harmony, and

abundance.  In the Night World, this  is the color of balance and harmony.  In

the physical world, it is the color of success and  prosperity. If this color

is a pure, emerald green, with just a touch of blue, it is the color of

healing.  This color can be found in the aura of doctors and nurses.  Green is

also found  in the auras of teachers.  Green in the aura generally indicates

people of peace and  harmony. They are the good neighbor and active in all

community projects. They are  people who have a strong inner faith in

themselves and humankind.  It is a color  representing generosity and sympathy

towards all of humankind.  If there is a light green  present it shows

prosperity and success.  A middle green denotes adaptability and  versatility.

An excess of green indicates people who are very individualistic and

independent.  Clear green denotes sympathy and dark green indicates deceit.

Olive  green shows treachery and a double nature.  Next we have blue.


Blue is the color of the Sky World.  This is the  color denoting peace and

calm.  In the  aura, the deeper the shade of blue the deeper the nature of the

individual.  Blue is a good  color regardless of its darkness.  Pale blue is

an indication of people who are trying to  grow emotionally.   They may be

struggling with who they are and what they should do in  life.  As the blue

deepens so does their emotional maturity.  They are closer to knowing  who

they are.  They are closer to seeing the true purpose of their life.  They are

people  who are more dedicated and work harder in life.  The deep shades of

blue indicate people  who have found their quest.


They are people actively involved in their quest.  They know their purpose in

life and  actively seek to complete it.  They are totally immersed in the

magickal quest.  People  with blue predominate in their auras are generally

very calm individuals. They seek the  contemplative life and friends of like

nature. They are not akin to the social set.  They can  be very temperamental

when their calm is disrupted.  They are easy people to get along  with and are

very thoughtful.  They are sensitive people towards their surroundings and

other people.  They enjoy times of intimacy with close friends and love the

quiet and  solitude.  In the aura, a deep and clear blue indicates one of pure

magickal devotion.  A  pale and etherial blue shows devotion to a noble idea.

A bright blue shows one given to  loyalty and sincerity.  The sixth color is

indigo.


Indigo is the color of the true seeker on the magickal path. They are one

dedicated to the magickal quest and only the magickal quest.  People with

indigo predominate in their  aura are the ones who aim at the stars and

succeed for they combine the ideal with the  practical.  They have developed a

magickal maturity which will carry them unto their  ultimate goal; the goal of

Night Consciousness.  The final color to study is violet.   Violet is the

highest vibration of color that can be seen in the aura.  The souls who have

this color in predominance are very rare indeed.  They are supersensitive and

will hold to  their ideals even at the cost of personal suffering.  All the

great works of art owe their  realization to the souls who have this color in

their aura.  Violet is the stimulator of ideals  and provides nourishment for

the brain cells in the upper brain which gives greater  magickal

understanding.  They are people of a mature, well- rounded personality.  They

are strong in character with sound judgement in all things.  They have

excellent mental  abilities and strong reasoning capabilities.  They have the

highest sense of personal  integrity.  People are strongly attracted to them.

They are introspective and temperamental. They can be easily irritated because

of their sensitivity.  They enjoy the refinements of life, but can easily

forego these and endure the most austere of lives, if it  will serve their

purpose in attaining their goals.  So far, I have said a great deal about the

colors of the aura itself.  This won't help you, if you can't see them.


To be able to see the aura you will need to go back to the topic on seeing the

Etheric  (Topic 17).  If you have been studying and practicing seeing the

etheric, then you will soon  be able to see the Astral aura.  The aura is not

easy to see.  The colors in the aura are of  a much higher vibration then the

energies of the Etheric, and this requires that you have  greater development

of the Night Eye.  It requires that you do not become impatient and  give up.

The lower colors, those from red to yellow, will be the easiest to see.  The

higher  colors may elude you for some time. Do not forget that you can also

see thought images  or in other words pictures projected onto the auric

screen.  The procedures for seeing the  Astral aura are identical for seeing

the Etheric.


It is best to begin with a period of meditation before trying to see the aura

so that you will  be in the highest of magickal states and awareness.  All of

this will take time and practice  on your part but the effort is well worth

it.  You will help your magickal development and  learn more about people.

You will come to know people for what they truly are inside  when you can see

their auras.  The second exercise involves strengthening the aura.


To strengthen the aura, you must first cross your wrists and your ankles.

This will  complete your bodily circuit and prevent your energies from being

dissipated.  You must  also slow down and deepen your breathing.  A few

minutes of Night Breathing would be  excellent.  You should then see added

energy flowing down your silver cord, from your  Oversoul, adding tremendous

Power to your aura.  This will aid you when dealing with  others who try to

exert their own aura against you.  This often takes place between people  in

business who are negotiating a contract between themselves.  It will also aid

you in  trying to see someone else's aura along with your own.  If you are

trying to view another  person's aura, and they are practicing with you, have

them do this too.  You will find you  can see it much easier and more clearly.

The progression of the colors from red to violet  marks the road of a Night

Magician's journey.


You must develop the highest qualities and characteristics of each color.

Ultimately, you  must master each.  Through mastery of the qualities embodied

in the colors and their  energy added to your aura, you will see yourself

progressing towards Night  Consciousness.  As you learn to see your aura, you

can identify the colors and the  character they represent.  If they are not of

the highest standard then you can work for  their improvement. Again, strive

to achieve mastery over self.  Embody within yourself the  highest qualities

of the colors.  The next subject is intricately related to auras and colors.

It is the Higher Night Centers.


24.  The Higher Night Centers and Exercises


In topic seventeen, you looked at the purely physical aspects of the Night

Centers.  Here,  you are going to examine the magickal aspects of all seven.

You will discover the powers  that will become yours to use as each Night

Center begins to function within you.  You will  see how colors are related to

each Night Center and learn an important exercise to help  advance the opening

of the Night Centers.  Finally, you will examine and perform an  exercise that

will release the Night Energy through the Night Centers into your world.


First, let's have a quick review of what you learned in topic seventeen.  You

were able to  locate the Night Centers in relation to the physical organs.

The first and lowest was  located at the base of the spine in relation to the

gonads.  The second was located over  the spleen/pancreas and the third over

the navel area or solar plexus.  The fourth is  located at the heart level.

The fifth at the throat.  The sixth at the brow level and the  seventh at the

crown of the head.  The Etheric Centers have a role in your life which

extends beyond the physical plane and your physical bodies.  You saw that the

centers  are for the purpose of keeping all planes in communication with each

other. As you grow  magickally, the Night Centers begin to unfold more and

release their energies into your  life.  As these centers unfold, you become

aware of the higher things on those realms. As  you develop magickally, all

Night Centers on all realms evolve and receive continually  higher energies

which pour into your lives.  This releases abilities and powers into your

life not normally present in the lesser evolved.  What are the abilities and

powers of each  awakening Night Center, and what do they mean to you?


Let me begin by saying, "DO NOT FORCE YOUR DEVELOPMENT!"  As you proceed in

this  topic, I will cover the powers which will awaken in you as you develop

magickally and the  Night Centers begin to open.  In the unevolved, only the

minimum of energy flows through  the Night Centers to the physical body so

that there is life. But as you develop magickally,  the centers evolve and the

Oversoul is able to send more of Its Energies through you.  As  long as you

develop along magickal lines, the Oversoul will send ever greater Energies

through you.  But do not practice any form of Night Meditation, or Yoga, or

whatever,  which will force the development of the base Night Center.  This is

the seat of the Earth  Fire.  In the eastern languages, it is referred to as

the Kundalini.  The Earth Fire is Life.  It  is the Energies of Life itself.

This Energy lies in the base Night Center of all planes. It is a  powerful and

special Energy which when released, will surge upward through the Night

Centers and awaken each of them to their fullest extent.  Only if you are

fully and  magickally developed and have special guidance from a magickal

teacher of the Higher  Realms will you survive such a forced awakening.  For

example, the Earth Fire, on its way  up, could very easily tear through tissue

and destroy various organs and cause physical  death.  This is the least that

could happen!


The second Night Center is concerned in its undeveloped state with sensual

gratification, sexual desires, and reproduction.  If the Fire is unleashed

while the Night Center is  magickally undeveloped, then all the bad traits of

this center will be extremely heightened  which could result in

uncontrollable, depraved, sexual conduct and harm to others.  This  forced

awakening could cause insanity.  Allow the Earth Fire to awaken inside of you,

naturally, as the result of your magickal development.  Grow magickally and

the base  Night Center will awaken in you, as you are ready to handle the

power that is contained  within it.  You will be shown how to unfold the upper

Night Centers but allow the base  center to unfold of itself.  It will awaken

naturally and easily as you unfold magickally.   When this base Night Center

has fully awakened, you will become the Oversoul.  You will  be a Night

Magician of the highest degree. In the beginning of your development, this

center will glow with a reddish light.   When you have achieved Night

Consciousness it  will glow with an intense dark light of incredible power.


The second Night Center relates to your passions.  The deeper your passions

are and involvement in lust and sexual gratification the darker the red of

this center's light.  As you develop magickally, a dark light begins to be

added to the red till the center is all aglow in  the Night.  In its highest

development, this Night Center will allow one to overcome  disease, old age,

and eventually physical death.  This is a great center of vitality.  It

absorbs the orange light and distributes the energies throughout one's being.

As this  Night Center begins to awaken, you will be able to remember journeys

taken into the  Astral Realm at night.  Upon awakening in the morning, you

will begin to have vague  recollections of what they did in the Astral that

night as their body slept.  You will  probably have the feeling of flying

while in the Astral Realm.


The third Night Center as it awakens will give you the feeling of an awareness

of Astral presences.  You will become very conscious and sensitive to all

manner of psychic and  Astral influences. Some of these influences may feel

good, while others may induce in  you a sense of fear.  On the lowest levels,

this center is associated with power, mastery,  and ego control.  This is the

center for engrossment in material matters and their control.   On the highest

levels, this center will be able to help you achieve strong magickal rapport

with your fellow Astral brothers.  This center is used to contact Astral

entities.  This Night  Center should be surrounded in the Night Pillar such

that the contact remains a contact  and does not allow the Astral entities

control over your bodily mechanism.


The next Night Center is the crossroad for all centers.  This is the fourth

Night Center and  it is located over the heart.  As this center begins to open

on the  etheric level, you will  begin to have an emotional rapport with

others.  You will be able to know and feel the  emotions of others around you.

You will have empathy with them on all levels of feeling,  to include that of

feeling their pains as your pains.  Located within this Night Center is the

"Heart of the Oversoul".  This is the anchor within your magickal being placed

there by  your Oversoul.  It is around this miniature dark star that all that

you are is gathered.  You  can liken it to a small miniature Oversoul.  It is

the embryo of your Oversoul beginning.  As  you begin on the path of Night

Magick and continue to grow magickally, you will see this  embryo begin to

grow into a small child of the Oversoul.  The farther along you develop,  the

child will continue to develop and grow, until you gain Night Consciousness

and the  Oversoul within you is a full adult.  This center actually does exist

and can be seen in  meditation.  You will learn to do this in a later topic.

It is the focal point in your world  where you, as a Night Magician, can go

and meet your Oversoul.  In this center's fullest  development, the Power of

your Oversoul will pour out from you.  Through the Energy  pouring out of you

there will be nothing you cannot do. This is the Center of the Night in  which

you move and have your being.


Through the fifth Night Center, you gain the ability for clairaudience.

Clairaudience is the ability to hear voices in the Astral Realm.  You will

have the sensation of hearing those on  the other side, as you can hear those

on this side of life. You may also be able to hear the  "Music of the Night

Spheres". As this center continues to develop, you will be able to  clothe

your thoughts in form.  The thoughts you generate with your mind, through this

center, will be able to take on direction and energy and go forth and do as

directed.   Through the development of this center, you will achieve strong

will power which will see  you through difficult tasks.  Through this center,

you will achieve true mastery over  yourself and life.  This is only, though,

when you link up this center with that of the heart.   Together, these centers

in unison can do anything.


In Night Magick, the sixth center is the Night Eye.  As this center begins to

develop, you  first perceive Astral shadows.  You will often see nothing more

then clouds of color.  As  the Night Eye continues to develop, you will be

able to see Astral people, landscape, and  symbols.  When the Night Eye is

fully developed, you will be able to have true seeing  which you call

clairvoyance. Clairvoyance is the ability to see and know Truth in all its

forms.  It is seeing and knowing as the Oversoul within you sees and knows.

You will be  able to see the past and present.  You will be able to see

anyplace at anytime and be  able to enlarge, in the physical world, matter

ranging in size from small to microscopic.   In the future, you will be able

to see the probabilities of what might happen.  In the future,  there is

little which must happen, and a great deal which can change according to your

actions.  Thus, according to the way things seem to be forming you can see

what will  probably  happen. The seventh center is the link between your mind

and that of your Oversoul.   In the  beginning, as this center begins to open,

it allows for partial consciousness when you are  in the Astral world.  As

this center unfolds, your consciousness will be more complete, and  you will

perceive the Astral Realm as clearly as you do the physical world.   You will

never  know any cessation of consciousness whether you are in the physical

world or the Astral  world.  As you grow more and more dedicated to doing the

Soul's Will this Night Center  will continue to open on Higher Realms allowing

more and more Magickal Energy to be  released into your everyday world.  You

will become more in tune with what your Higher  Self would have you do in this

world.  When this center has developed far enough, in  conjunction with the

heart Night Center, the Oversoul Child will be born within you.  When  this

Night Center has opened completely, your aura and your word will be filled

with Night  Energies and the aura will glow with a brilliant radiance of the

Night.  From what has just  been said, there can be seen a relationship

between the Night Centers and colors.


Each Night Center, in its pure and developed state, vibrates to a particular

color.  The  base Night Center vibrates to the color red.  The spleen/pancreas

center vibrates to the  color orange. The third center, located over the solar

plexus, vibrates to the color yellow.   The heart center vibrates to the color

green and the throat center to that of blue.  The brow  center, Night Eye,

vibrates to that of indigo, and the highest of Night Centers, the crown,

vibrates to the color violet.  As all the Night Centers are developing

magickally, they will  attain to the purest of colors.  As the Night Centers

reach perfection, they will open, and  the colors will flow till they can be

perceived as the color of the Night.   Let's look at an  exercise which can be

done to develop the Night Centers so that they will radiate in the  Night and

permit your the Night Powers to flow through you.


First, refer back to topic sixteen.  In that topic, we discussed meditating on

the desired  color you needed for healing and projecting it into your Night

Pillar.  You prepared  yourself for meditation with a sheet of color paper,

which would help you concentrate, and  draw to you, the desired color energy

that you wished to use.  Let's again do the same  technique, only this time,

instead of sending the color into your Pillar, you will send it into  the

specific Night Center you wish to stimulate.


You should first see the specific Night Center, in your mind, and feel that

great wheel of  Night Energy slowly rotating, and see the specific color

desired flowing into the Night  Center and stimulating it.  See the center

whirling faster and faster as the result of the  inflow of color energy.   See

the center becoming a pure channel for the color energy and  the impure

energies leaving it.  Further, see the added Energies of the Oversoul flowing

into the center via the silver cord.  Do this with all of the Night Centers

except the base  Night center.  This is an excellent exercise will actually

bring the Night Energies from the  Higher Realms and then release them into

the physical world around you.  Stand with  your feet together, and your arms

and hands outstretched, as you form a living X.  Palms  should be facing

outward.  Now you must become very calm and silent within. See  yourself as

the Oversoul on Earth.  See yourself as a  Night Being.  Now, you will bring

into your being Two Great Energies. Through the soles of your feel, you will

see the Earth  Energies rise up, and at the same time, you will be drawing

into you the Night Force  flowing from your Oversoul down through the Crown

Night Center.  These Energies will  meet in the heart Night Center.  As they

meet, see these Energies going out, under the direction of your Oversoul and

the Night Gods, healing, cleansing, purifying, and touching  the Earth.  If

you know someone in special need of the Energies, see them flowing to her  or

him.  As you continue to practice this exercise the flow of the Energies will

become  stronger and stronger.  You will be of true service to the Night

Guild.  You will truly be a  Night Magician when the Night Centers radiate in

the night of your world.  I said earlier,  that as the Crown Night Center

begins to open, you have partial awareness of the Astral  Realm.   Yet, your

awareness is often distorted.  One state of awareness that you have of  your

Astral journeys is the dream state.  In our next discussion, you will enter

the Dream  Realm.


25.  The Dream Realm 


There are a great many books on the market dealing with the topic of dreams.

Many of  these books list the symbols which you see in your dreams and then

tell you what they  mean, or what is going to happen because of what you

dreamed.  But interpreting dreams  is just not that easy.  Dreams are a very

personal thing to each of us.  A dog, seen in one  dream, may mean one thing

to me and a totally different thing to you.


To begin with, there are two basic types of dreams.  The first type of dream

is a common occurrence in most people's lives. This is the dream when upon

awakening you have only  vague recollections of what transpired.  These are

dreams which you rapidly forget what  took place. They are very confusing

dreams and are the mental garbage which your mind  gets rid of as you sleep.

The second type of dream is what you need to pay attention to.


These are dreams which you remember very vividly upon awakening. You see

images,  and possibly colors, vividly.  You feel that you were actually there

and taking part in what  was going on.  You have a sharp recollection of what

took place and you do not easily  forget what transpired after awakening.  If

this is the kind of dream that has occurred in  your life, then you are

remembering an actual experience that has taken place in the  Astral Realm.

You can also be witnessing a message that is meant to help guide your  life.

The first type of dream you can forget about.  This is just your mind getting

rid of a  lot of mental garbage and worries pressed upon it, or a distortion

of a journey in the Astral  Realm.  The second type is important. You have

often heard of the phrase, "sleep on it",  in connection with solving a

problem that you cannot seem to resolve.


When you sleep on a problem, you are out in the Astral Realm and can meet with

people  on that side of life and receive an answer to your problem.  The

answer generally comes  to you in the form of a dream.  There are other things

that can be done in the use of your  dreams.


Let's say that you have an important interview with a client coming up.  The

night before,  you will need a picture of your client that you're going to

meet.  Preferably, this should be  a physical picture or a strong mental

picture will suffice.  Then before going to sleep, you  should concentrate on

the picture of your client and think of the thing you would like your  client

to do.  Think and say the things to your client that will persuade her/him

your way.   Then put it out of your mind and just know, that as you sleep, you

will meet your client in  the Astral and this will help prepare your way in

tomorrow's meeting.  You will be  successful if you do this. You can see that

there are endless variations and possibilities  in the use of your dreams.

You can also help improve your dreaming.   The first thing you should do in

helping yourself in dreaming is find out which way you  sleep best.  The body

best picks up magickal currents by having the head facing in a  certain

direction.  Practice sleeping with your head pointed say to the North and keep

a  record on how you slept for a week.  Then the next week, sleep in a new

direction and do  the recording.  You should do this for all four directions.

This is the first step towards  better sleeping and dreaming.


To further improve dreaming do the following: when you fall asleep at night,

say to  yourself that you're going to remember all that you dream of clearly

and sharply.  Say this  over and over to yourself until you fall asleep

naturally.  Know that you are going to dream  true!   Now, you will want to

keep a diary of your dreams.


Keep this diary by your bed along with a pen.  Upon awakening from a vivid and

true  dream, record what you saw and the impressions of what it meant to you.

If the dream is  in a very symbolic form, then take that dream into your

meditation periods and seek to  discover the meaning of those symbols.  As

said before, symbols are a very personal thing  to you and their meaning lies

with the Oversoul and Night Teacher.  You may want to  record these symbols on

a three by five card and arrange them alphabetically.   Symbolism is used a

great deal of the time by your Oversoul for communication with you.

Symbolism is used so that you will spend more time in communication with your

Night  Teacher and Oversoul in seeking an answer.  Dreams are important.  It

is important for you to become familiar with your dreams and their meaning.

Dreams  are one means by which the Oversoul may speak with you and give

important information  to guide your life. This could be from warnings

concerning your health or well-being to job  assistance or ways to improve

your practice of Night Magick.  Another mode of  communication is the Oracle,

which we will discuss in the next topic, along with a discussion of Astral

Guides and the use of Trance.


26.  Astral Guides, Oracleship, and Trance


You are never alone in this world.  You may feel that you stand on some

deserted island  in the middle of the ocean, yet you should take comfort in

the fact that all around you your  Guides and Teachers are with you each and

every moment of the day and night.  In  addition to discussing the Guides, you

will also explore communication with the Astral  Guides, or oracleship, and a

special state of consciousness, the Trance.  To begin with,  let's take a

close look at who your Guides and Teachers really are?


Your Guides and Teachers are actually two distinct groups of magickal helpers.

The  Guides are those who have remained on the Astral Realm and assist you

from that  dimension.  They are composed of both relatives and friends of your

past lives who are  gaining valuable experience and magickal growth by

assisting you on the physical plane.   You should remember that their

personalities are still very much akin to the ones they  had in their last

life.  There are Specialist who come under this group of Guides.  They  assist

you with special guidance if you are undertaking a special task and need their

magickal expertise. They assist those in the process of transition from

physical to Astral  living.  They are the Astral doctors and nurses. The other

group is made up of those I  term Teachers.


They are a magickally advanced group of Beings.  They administer to you from a

much  higher realm of existence.  The Realm of the Soul.  They are usually

with you from the  beginning of time and follow you long into your magickal

development.  As you reach a  special development in your magickal path, the

rank of the Teacher continues to advance  until you work with your Night

Teacher.  I will discuss the Night Teachers in a later topic.


Everyone on this planet has been led by inspiration at some time or another,

but most  have never taken the time to try and understand where that

inspiration came from.   Inspiration has its origins from two different

sources.  The first is your Oversoul and is of  the highest form of

inspiration.  The second is guidance given to you through your  Magickal

Guides and Teachers. You can receive a closer rapport with your Guides and

Teachers by learning to remain in a state of inner listening, by remaining in

a state of  inner awareness, knowing that they are always with you and that

you can receive from  them guidance in all that you do. You must begin by

accepting their Presence and knowing that you can communicate with them.

Whenever you can shut out the outer world and its problems, then can you hear

them speak to you.  You must always carefully weigh what they tell you and

know that,  ultimately, the decision is yours.  They never compel you to do

anything, but simply guide  you as to what the probabilities are and then it's

your decision.  You may be able to hear  the Astral message, but some are

exceptionally good at hearing those from the Astral  Realm.  These individuals

are Oracles. An Oracle is a person who through a difference in body and brain

structure is able to  receive messages from the Astral with an exceptional

clarity.  They are individuals with a  delicate physical and nervous system

upon which Astral Spirits may impress the  message.  The person enters an

altered state of consciousness, whereby the Guide or  Teacher is able to

impress upon the nervous system the message to be given.  The  Highest Guide

or Teacher also acts as a traffic controller regulating which Guide or

Teacher will give a message and who will not, through the Oracle.  The Oracle

must  remain in a very passive state of mind.  The Oracle is only a link

between this world and  that of the Astral.  There are degrees of passivity in

consciousness for the Oracle.  The  Oracle may retain almost total

consciousness while seeing and hearing the message, and  then again,

consciousness may be totally repressed by the Guide or Teacher.  This total

repression of consciousness, in the Oracle, is known as Trance.


Trance is an altered state of consciousness, whereby the Oracle's

consciousness leaves  the body and that of a Higher Entity enters into it.

Thus, the Higher Entity has free reign  to speak and act through the body

instrument without misinterpretation by the Oracle.  In  the other form of

oracleship, the Oracle hears and interprets what s/he sees and in this  case

s/he does not. Generally, for the Oracle in Trance, it seems as if s/he has

been  pleasantly sleeping.  Depending on the Oracle's development, s/he can go

into Trance on  the physical plane and still remain conscious and active on

the Astral plane, and so can  control the type of entity who is giving the

message through her/his body, to those on the  physical plane who are

listening.  Even if the Oracle cannot remain awake in the Astral,  there is

nothing to fear.  If her/his body, emotions, and thoughts are one with the

Oversoul  then nothing can happen to her/him while s/he is in a state of

Trance.  Here is a warning  to those who would attempt to practice the state

of Trance.  If you are without fear and  know that there is nothing to be

afraid of, and live in the Night Pillar of the Oversoul, then  no harm can

befall you.  Remember this, keep your thoughts at one with the Oversoul and

nothing bad will ever happen to you.  If you cannot live in this state of

being then do not  try to reach a state of Trance.  Otherwise, you are subject

to entry and hold by the lower  mischievous entities. Most people have a

safeguard against entering Trance and that is falling asleep, but entry and

hold is still possible at just the point of falling asleep, and  the point of

awakening.  This can only occur when you are attempting to reach the state of

Trance. This cannot occur if you are just normally going to sleep.  Have no

fear, but live in  the Oversoul and no wrong entry can occur to you during the

state of Trance.  There are  several forms of Trance.


There is the kind, just mentioned above, whereby a Higher Entity uses your

body to  transmit a message to a group of listeners while the Oracle is in a

soporific state.  There  is also what is called Night Trance. Here the Oracle

can be fully conscious and by his own control deliberately enter the state  of

Trance rather then it being induced by the possessing Higher Entity.  The next

kind is  called Magician's Trance.


Here, the body is very rigid, even to the point of having hard skin.  You are

still in your  body, but what you see can be likened to sitting on the highest

peak with a telescope.  In  other word wherever you look, you can see what is

transpiring. There is no limit as to  where or what you can see.  Time,

distance, and/or physical structures are no obstacles to  your seeing.  The

final kind is called Trance Projection.


Here you leave the body.  The flesh remains very limp and the breathing

greatly reduced.   The heart rate is also greatly reduced.  Again, there are

no limits to where you can see.  Everyone, to one degree or another can

receive messages from the Astral.  It is important  that everyone learn to

take time to know and become close to their Guides and Teachers.   Their

messages of guidance and help can completely change the world that you live

in.   There is no limit to the aid that they can provide in your world.  Take

the time to still the  mind and body so that you may hear the guidance that

they have to offer you.  It is not  essential that you try the states of

Trance.  You should only induce the state of Trance  under the guidance of

your Magickal Teacher.  Therefore, I have omitted the how-to  instruction for

the state of Trance.  You should not try the different states of Trance unless

you are sure of what you're doing and that you're entering them with the

correct frame of  mind and under the proper supervision.  Above all learn

this, "To be still and know the  Oversoul."  This is the key to Night Magick

and Night Consciousness.  We have been  discussing the magickal influence of

your Astral Guides and Teachers.  Yet, they are only  one magickal source, out

of many, that influence your life. Another great source of  magickal influence

over your emotional and magickal life is the Goddess Diana.  She is  better

known to you as the Presence of the Moon.


27.  The Moon and Its Rites


There are many roads of magickal evolution which are filled with excitement,

adventure, accomplishment, and success by those who travel them.   One of

these roads is serving as  the indwelling life force for souls within a moon,

planet, or star.  The stars, planets, and  moons are the physical bodies of

Great Beings who are on far on the road of magickal  evolution.  Of all these

grand Bodies, the one most symbolic of this chapter on Water  Magick is the

Moon.


The Moon of the Earth exerts great influence over the tides of the ocean.  You

can then  extend the Moon's influence over the Tides of humankind's emotions.

In this topic, you  will examine this function and the magickal role that the

Moon plays in your life.  You will  also study and perform special rites

associated with the Moon.  Let's begin by looking  directly at the magickal

role of the Moon.


You see the Moon because it is lit by the reflected light from the Sun.  The

Moon is a  source of Yin Light for it takes the Light of the Sun and

transforms it into Yin Light.  This  Energy is at a lesser extent, when the

Moon is new, for it reflects lesser quantities of the  transformed Energies.

The Energies of the Moon can help directly in the process of your  Oversoul's

gaining control over your emotions.  The Energies of the Moon passing  through

your Oversoul where in turn, they are purified and added to your aura, go on

to  strengthen and build emotional stability.  The Energies of the Moon are

very powerful and  add great Magickal Force to your life when purified.  The

Oversoul, acting as a filter,  filters out the impurities of the Moon's

Energies caused by the grey energies that come  from humankind. After

filterization, you have the Moon's Pure Magickal Energies, and the  Moon

shines in the night as a Luminous Orb of Rarified Power.  When your life and

aura  are illumined with the Yin Light of the Oversoul and is in turn

magnified by the Moon, a  great reflector, then is your Power in the Night

multiplied to its maximum.  You are  likened to the Moon, when you, as a Night

Magician, use your purified Night  Consciousness to reflect the Yin Light of

the Moon into the world.  You are the Moon, a  reflector of the Night

Energies.  The time of the New Moon is a time of new beginnings.


It is a time when a Night Magician should consecrate and dedicate her/his

aspirations  and life anew unto her/his Oversoul.  Thus you celebrate this

time with a rite of new  beginning.  The rite unfolds as follows:


Make sure your Night Altar is ready except don't fill the chalice with any

wine or grape  juice. Putting on your Night Robe and arming yourself with your

Night Weapons place the  Night Pillar around yourself, the Night Altar, and

the world.   Put in your right hand the  Night Wand; face the direction of

North which symbolizes the element of Water; and now  while making the sign of

Night Magick, see fig.___, say this solemn invocation to the First  of the

Four Great Beings of the Cosmic Elements: "I invoke the Great Powers of the

Cosmic Being of the (insert direction) to flow into my being.  Fill me with

the Cosmic  Power of (insert element).  Renew me in the Power of Night

Consciousness.  Make me a  Being of Cosmic Yin Light.  Guide me upon the Road

of Night Magick."  Then face the  Night Altar and place a little of the

correct element from the vile into the chalice.  The  chalice is symbolic of

you and the element representing the Cosmic Being. Then face the  West and

repeat the entire procedure inserting the correct direction and selecting the

correct element to put into the chalice.  Do this for all four directions.

The correct  elements and directions are as follows: water representing Water

and North; oil  representing Air and the West; salt is of the Earth and South;

and fire(candle) that of Itself  and East.  Now pickup the candle; make the

sign of Night Magick over the chalice; and if there is just you, then repeat

an invocation of dedication of your life and being to the  guidance and care

of your Oversoul, Night Teacher, and Guides.  After this, touch your  first

two fingers of your left hand in the substance of the chalice, and upon your

heart  make the sign of Night Magick and then repeat the Night Invocation on

Earth as follows:


"Let the Earth be filled with the Presence of the Night.  I honor the Presence

of the Night  in all I say and do.  By the Night all things are given, by the

Night all enemies removed.   By the Yin Light of the Moon I shall walk the

Night Road on Earth in power, and glory and  victory forever. So be it."


After this you will need to hum for ten to thirty minutes. Although you

probably know how  to hum let me make sure.  With your lips shut and together

make the "mmmm" sound.    Hum the sound such that eventually you'll feel a

resonance building in your head.  As you  head begins to resonate, this

resonance will spread over your body and you will begin to  feel yourself

vibrating and pulsating.


If there are others doing this with you, then select one to be the officiant.

The officiant will  do all that has been described so far, up to the point of

saying the Night Invocation on  Earth. Each member present will repeat a

silent prayer of dedication to her/his life and  being, and committing it to

the guidance and care of her/his Oversoul, Night Teacher, and  Guides.  After

this, the officiant will touch her/his first two fingers of her/his left hand

in the  substance of the chalice, and upon each member's heart s/he will make

the sign of Night  Magick and repeat the following: "With the substance of the

Four Worlds and the Powers  thereof, may you forever be guided on the Road of

Night Magick and become a Night  Magician."  Then, repeat the Night Invocation

on Earth, in unison. Everyone will then hum  in unison till stopped by the

officiant. This is the Rite of the New Moon.  A time of joyous,  beautiful

renewal in Night Magick.


The next rite is in celebration of the Full Moon.  The Full Moon marks the

time of  realization, attainment, and fulfillment.  The consecration and

deepening within of these  aspects is celebrated in a very beautiful rite.  If

there is just you performing this rite, then  you will need only one small

candle on a plate.  In addition, you will need two more small  plates; one

containing sage and the other holding your vessel of water.   With these

things in hand, you are now ready to begin.


Place these three things on your floor Night Altar, with the candle in the

middle, the sage  on the right, and the water on the left.  Place them such

that you will be seated facing the  North with them in front of you.  Then

before being seated, take the candle in your right  hand and with your left

hand clear the four points of direction.  You will begin with the  East and

move counterclockwise making the sign of Night Magick and repeating to each

direction:  "This way is the clear road to Night Magick bathed in the Yin

Light of the Full  Moon."  Now be seated, repeat the Night Invocation of the

Earth and enter into a deep  silence and communion with your Oversoul and feel

the achievement of knowing and  being the Oversoul on Earth.  Now take a small

portion of the sage in your right hand and  say, "This is the Spirit of the

Night in form upon the Earth.  It is the Essence of a Night  Magician.  Honor

to the Night Spirit that I have achieved all that I AM".  Place the sage

around the candle.  The candle should be lit from the beginning of the rite.

Next pickup  the water in your left hand and repeat "Water is the Night Spirit

in pure Essence.  It is the  Power of the Spirit and Life on Earth. I AM the

Waters of Life and the Night Soul on  Earth." Pour the water around and on the

sage.  Now repeat, "the Night Soul united, One  and forever, in Spirit, Power,

and Life, within that which I am, a Night Magician.  So be it".   Close by

humming the "mmmm" sound till you resonate deeply the sound. If there is  more

then one then use the following guidelines.


Everyone present will have the same plates and materials before them.

Selecting one as officiant, s/he will clear the four points following the same

procedures outlined earlier.   S/he will stand in the center of the circle

formed by all the celebrants and begin in the  East.  Then everyone should be

seated.  Hum together after seated.  Continue all as the  same in unison.


The final rite requires nothing other then yourself.  Be seated comfortably on

the ground  at eventide, or night, when the light of the Full Moon may fall

upon you.  Doing this on a cloudless night is best.  Put the Night Pillar

around yourself and all members  participating.  If there are more people

doing this then just yourself, then all should face  towards the Moon. Begin

with Night Breathing for a few minutes.  Then you will visualize,  and all

with you, the Light of the Full Moon passing through your Oversoul.  Know that

the  Moon's Energy is being purified of all the Earth's human dross and is

flowing now into  your Astral Body and aura.  See yourself filled with a most

intense, pure Yin Light.  This  Light will give you emotional stability and

inner strength.  Do this, feeling the Night Soul's  Presence being magnified

within yourself. Know that you are the Oversoul.


You have learned from the Moon and its cycles, that it represents your

beginning upon  the path of Night Consciousness in its New Moon phase and ends

with your fulfillment as  the Night Soul in the Full Moon phase.  Use

carefully the Light of the Moon.  The Light of  the Moon must be purified by

the Oversoul before it can be accepted into your world.   Thus, you must

always remain in Night Consciousness in order to reflect into your world  only

the Night Energies.  The Moon is a very Advanced Being.  The Moon is a great

reflector of the Yin Light into your world during its night.   The Goddess

Diana is the  Master of the Element Water on Earth.  Now, you, too, will

become Master of the Element  Water in the next topic.


28.  Water Rites  


Water is representative of the Night Spirit.  Water is Life and the Night

Spirit.  I will  introduce two rites which embody the use of water.  Water is

a very powerful magnet and  container for the Night Energies.  Water will

greatly intensify your drawing power of the  Night Force.  The first rite that

I will teach is designed simply to aid your drawing upon,  and concentrating

the Night Force.


Begin by obtaining a glass bowl, similar to a mixing bowl, with a large open

space at the  top. The size you will need is based upon the number of people

participating with you.   You should have a bowl set aside for private use and

one for group use. When your not  using the bowl keep it wrapped and in a

place so that no one else will disturb it.  You will  also need three black

candles, your Night Altar that is close to the floor, and a black cloth  to

cover the table.  Setup the Night Altar so that you, or the officiant, when

seated at the  altar faces North.  If there are others present then they

should be seated around the altar.  The Night Altar should be covered with the

altar cloth.  Fill the bowl full of water and place  it in the center of the

Night Altar. Finally, everyone will be seated, but the officiant who will

light the three candles and place two of them on the outer edges of the group.

Now that  you have these things setup your ready to begin.


Light the incense with the third candle; face West of the Night Altar; and

with the lit, black candle in your right hand and while making the sign of

Night Magick with the left hand  repeat the following invocation: "Let only

the Night Spirit remain here and only the Night  Spirit go out.  This room is

protected in the Yin Light of the Oversoul.  Let the Light of the  Night

Brethren enter here and only the Night Force remain.  The first Night Guardian

shall  remain this way and only the Night Spirit's Power will stay.  So be

it".  Now turn  counterclockwise to the next major direction and repeat again

this invocation.  Each time  preceding it with the sign of Night Magick.  Do

this again in the third major direction, and  finally over the Night Altar

itself. Then take your seat on the floor before the bowl and  again surround

yourself with the Night Pillar.  Contact your Oversoul and begin to draw  into

yourself the Night Force.  Then reach out and touch the bowl with both your

hands,  one on each side of the bowl.  If this is being done as a group, then

all will interlock  fingers when hands are placed upon the bowl by all members

present.  All should see the  Force flowing into themselves, and then into the

bowl filling the bowl with the Night Force.  Continue to do this as long as

you, and the members with you, feel comfortable and can  control the Force.

If at anytime you should begin to feel uncomfortable, you should stop  and

again stand and clear all four corners of the room.  Then rest a while before

trying  this again.  This is a tremendous rite for collecting the Night Force

in its most  concentrated form.  After the rite, it is suggested that you

obtain clean drinking glasses  (one for each member present) and dip them into

the water of the bowl and drink of it. Drink as much water as you can

comfortably hold.  The water has a great healing and energizing effect and

will ward off illness for a long time.  It is further effective in aiding

ailing plants and animals.  The benefit of the Force, coursing through your

body, is cause  enough to do this as often as possible.



In the second rite, in addition to what you have setup, a mirror and two of

the following  color candles: violet, blue, green, yellow, red, and black.

This is not a group rite but for  you alone. Begin this rite the same way you

did the first rite, by clearing the four points of  the room. Setup the bowl

of water and a mirror directly behind it.  You will use four  candles placed

upon the Night Altar, one on each corner.  The two closest to you will be

black candles.  The other two candles' colors depend upon what you are trying

to  accomplish.  When this rite is properly setup and performed, you will be

able to see your  Guides and Teacher and to receive answers to questions you

put before them.  The color  combination of the candles is very important.


If you wish to have questions answered by no one in particular, then a blue

and red  candle are used.  Another strong color combination you can use is red

and violet.  To  contact your Night Teacher, the color combination must match

their personal harmony  and frequency.  There is a chart located in Appendix B

which will give you the proper  color combination for the various Night

Teachers I speak of in this work.  For those Night  Teachers not listed or if

you're not sure who yours is, then you can use the blue and red  candle

combination to find out and also their specific color combination to be used

in this  rite.  Here is how to use this rite.


Be sure you have cleared the four points in the room and have surrounded

yourself in the  Night Pillar.  Otherwise, you will attract the wrong force.

Setup the bowl of water with the  black candles in front and the other two in

the rear, (make sure that the four candles can  be seen in the mirror), and

the mirror directly behind the bowl.  Light the candles and your  ready to

begin.  Meditate upon your Teacher and Guides and upon the fixtures in front

of  you.  Be sure to get comfortable, surround yourself in the Pillar of

Protection, and relax  with Night Breathing. Sit directly in front of the

Night Altar, such that, you will see the top  and surface of the water in the

mirror.  The reflection you should see in the mirror, is the  surface of the

water and the candles. The candles will form a figure 8.  The faces of the

Teacher, or Guides, will appear in the reflection of the water in the mirror,

or just above  the actual bowl.  If at anytime you should start to lose the

vibration, stand up and again  clear the four points and begin at another

time. Not only will the faces appear in the  mirror but also images that will

answer your questions.  It is also possible that you will  hear the voice of

the Teacher from the image that appears.  This is very much akin to  picture

telephones.  Your mind should be free of mental garbage and worries.  You

should also be in good overall health.  If you seem to fail at first then you

know that you  are making true progress.  As with anything, you must practice

over and over again to achieve true results.  If you do so, then you'll

achieve the highest results.  You have  learned so much about the Astral

Realm.  But wouldn't it be great if you could go there  and see it for

yourself?   Well if your ready, just turn the page and you'll be on your way.


29.  Night Projection


Perhaps a more familiar term for what you are about to study is Astral

Projection or  traveling. The word "Astral" is derived from the Latin and

Greek language which means  "of the stars". You learned in the beginning of

this chapter on Water Magick, that the  Astral Body interpenetrates the

physical body.  Your consciousness resides in the  physical body during the

day and by night, when your physical body sleeps, your  consciousness resides

in the Astral Body.  People don't remember what takes place  during their

Astral sojourns because they believe that this physical world is the only true

reality, and so their mind rationalizes what they have seen in the Astral

Realm into a  distorted dream.  But if you truly believe that the Astral Realm

exists and that you can go  there then you will remember what you have seen

and done in the Astral Realm and  remember it upon awakening.  Yet, you can go

beyond dreaming and actually travel  there.  You can bring back your

experiences in the Astral Realm. You can do this by  learning, consciously, to

project yourself into the Astral Realm.  This is Astral or Night Projection.


To begin with, in learning to Night Project consciously, you must learn to

have no fear.   Fear is the greatest destroyer of good results in this work.

Fear will prevent you from  accomplishing anything in Night Magick.  So do not

be afraid to Night Project. You can  not get lost while you reside in the

Astral Realm.  The physical body is firmly attached to  the Astral Body by the

silver cord.  No matter where you travel in the Astral Realm,  whenever you

wish to return to the physical body, simply think of yourself there, and you

will do so.  Why would you want to travel in the Astral, in the first place?


To begin with you could see how well you're doing so far in your sojourn on

Earth.  You  can meet face-to-face with your Guides and Teacher and receive

first hand instruction on  how to solve certain problems.  You can receive

instruction on how to better your life and  access the lessons you have

learned so far.  You can also travel anywhere on the Earth  plane you wish to.

You can see great libraries and be able to read the books contained  therein.

You could see museums and other places of interest. There is no limit to the

things you can do while Night Projecting.  But be warned if you try to go

somewhere and  invade another's privacy.  You are liable to receive an "astral

shock" and get slammed  back into your body with a terrific headache. Although

the person you visited may not be  able to physically see you their

subconscious will be able to do so and send a strong  astral blow to your

Astral Body.  Its best if you don't go where you intuit you shouldn't go.

Without fear and listening to your Oversoul for guidance your ready to Night

Project.


First, you should watch your diet before Night Projecting.  Try to eat as

little fried food as possible.  Do not travel on a full stomach.  You won't

get anywhere if you are  uncomfortable because your stomach is full and in the

process of digestion.  For about a  week prior to actually projecting you

should prepare yourself mentally by repeating the  following invocation, four

times daily. Do it once in the morning, noon, evening, and  before going to

bed.  The invocation is, "On this day ___, I am going to Night Project.  I  am

going to travel in the Astral Realm and remember all that I see and do.  I

will recall all  of this after I have returned to my body.  This I will do and

won't fail."  On the day you  have selected to Night Project be sure and have

as peaceful and quiet a day as possible.   You must try and keep your mind on

the subject of Night Projecting all that day.  You  must look forward to going

to bed that night with the intentions of traveling in the Astral  Realm.  Now,

you need to learn to relax before projecting.


Many will say this is easy for them to do, but actually this is not true.

True relaxation is  an art and must be practiced to be mastered.  To begin

Night Projection, you must be fully  relaxed. There must not be a tense nerve

or muscle in your entire body. When you lay  down to project, the room must be

just right, being neither too cold, or hot, if you are to  achieve true

relaxation. To assist relaxing and projecting, darken the room and secure it

from entry by anyone else.  In no way should there be any way that you can be

disturbed.   If you are touched, while traveling, this could cause harm to

your physical body.  Further,  no one should attempt to try Night Projection

if they are prone to heart trouble.  This is not  to scare anyone, but the

body should be in good health.  You should not cover yourself  with heavy

bedding for this will interfere with relaxation and projecting.  If you're

ready to  relax, then let's begin.


Turn your consciousness upon your toes.  Concentrate mentally on them and see

them relaxing.  See all the tension leaving the toes.  Next, work on the foot

and see all tension leaving it.  Do this all the way up one leg and then do it

for the other leg.  Do not go on till  there is no tension or tightness in any

part of your lower extremities.  Then move on to the  pelvic region and do the

same relaxation technique.  Then do the arms and each finger,  individually,

till you feel calm and relaxed.  The stomach and chest region are next, then

on up the neck and finally, the head region.  Relax the jaw and forehead.

Relax each part  thoroughly before going to the next part.  Once you have

accomplished this, it is time to  relax the mind.


In order to relax your mind, allow your thoughts to dwell on a beautiful day

with billowy clouds in the sky.  Take your thoughts and place them on one of

those beautiful dark  clouds. Just relax and drift on the cloud and let your

mind forget all its worries. Think of  nothing else but the deep sensation of

peace and floating on the cloud.  At this point your  eyes should be closed.

Relax your thoughts and for a few moments try to think of nothing.   In Night

Projection, you are where your thoughts are.


The Astral Body looks somewhat like your own physical body so picture it

floating about  three feet above you.  You must know that you're actually

floating above your physical  body.  Relax, do not force the process, do not

strain or induce tenseness in the physical  body, and above all, do not jerk.

If your body jerks, then you will find that you will have to  wait till the

next night to try again.  You will feel a floating sensation and a gentle

sense  of rising.  This is great! If you don't jerk, then you will find that

you will continue to float  and rise, so carefully, open your eyes.  You will

have found that you have floated up and  away from your physical body.  If you

want to view your room then you can do so by just  thinking of doing so, but

be careful.  The experience is something akin to hearing your  voice for the

first time on the tape recorder.  It will be quite a shock and you'll hardly

believe it's your body.  Some have become so startled that they have returned

to their  bodies with a shock. Do not be startled or afraid.  Just relax as

you float there and get  used to the sensation of your new body.  You will

find that you are naked.  If you will think  of clothes, then you will be

dressed, but remember to put that thought away in a corner of  your mind in

order to remain dressed.  Slowly, "will" yourself to settle back to the floor.

What will you do next?


For the first night, it is best that you go straight to the Astral Realm.  All

you need do is  think of being there and you will do so.  Wherever you want to

be your thoughts will take  you. If you will go to the Astral Realm first, and

thereafter spend a little time in the Astral  before doing other things on the

Earth plane, you will never have trouble getting out of the  physical body

again.  You will also receive a tremendous magickal recharge by visiting  the

Astral Realm. When you want to return simply think of your physical body and

you  will be there.  Now, you must return slowly, and carefully, back into

your body.


It is essential that you do this slowly.  Have you ever had a dream where you

felt yourself suddenly falling and woke up with a start.  This is what happens

when you return too fast  into your physical body.  It is essential to align

the two bodies up correctly, or you will  suffer from a headache.  If this

happens, simply fall back to sleep and when you awaken  the alignment process

will have occurred naturally and the headache will be gone.  On  reentry, you

will feel as if you are returning to a very dense and cold body.  It won't be

the  most comfortable experience in your life.  But this shows you how much

more crude and  slower a rate of vibration the physical body really is. There,

you have Night Projected.   Let's examine another technique for projecting

yourself out of your physical body.


Again relax fully and make sure that there are no rough edges disturbing your

body and distracting you.  Have your eyes closed and roll them up so that, in

effect, you are looking somewhere up at the top of your forehead.  Do not

create eyestrain though. Breathe  regularly, rhythmically, and deeply then

forget all about your breathing.  Turn your  conscious awareness towards your

third Night Center which is located over the solar  plexus, or navel area.  It

is from this area that the Astral Body leaves the physical body.   Visualize

your Astral Body slowly starting to leave your physical body.  Picture the

third  Night Center like a window through which the Astral is going to leave.

See the Astral as a  cloud-like figure, shaped similarly to the physical body,

and slowly rising up and floating  about six feet above the physical form.  At

this point any one of the following might  happen: 1) again you might jerk and

return to your body and so on another night you'll  have to try again, 2)

you'll feel a tingling or numbness in your physical body which is a  good

sign, but which you should ignore.  From here, you will feel a rigidity or

stiffness  come over the body and you will not be able to move. DON'T PANIC!

This is an excellent  sign of progress.  You will be able to see as if through

your eyelids and the surroundings  will be bathed in a soft light, if you

remain calm, you will begin to feel a slight swaying  and out you'll move into

the Astral Realm. You will see things in very vivid colors and with

remarkable clarity, 3) you may feel a swaying motion and then experience the

feeling as if  going through a dark tunnel, at the end of which is a bright

light.  At the end of the tunnel  you will pass through a curtain of brilliant

colored drops and then, suddenly you will be in  the Astral World.  Night

Projection is a very beautiful experience.


Have no fear and you will have no problems.  Don't be discouraged if, at

first, you don't  succeed. Nothing ever comes too easy in life but must be

worked at with great patience  and diligence. Never talk about your travels

except to help others.  Use it to grow  magickally on the road of Night

Magick.  Remain always in the Shadow of your Night  Teacher as you travel in

the Greater Realms.  You have come to the end of another  chapter in Night

Magick.


It was a chapter filled with the wonders of Water Magick and the Astral Realm.

You have  come to know the Realm, intimately, and even how to travel in it

while still living in a  physical body. You have explored the secret uses of

water.  You have learned secrets  about your physical and Astral bodies and

the inner power contained within them.  You  can look at others now and know

their thoughts and emotions by the use of your Night  Eye.  You have met the

Goddess Diane and perhaps most importantly, you have come to  know that you

are never alone in this world.  That your love ones and friends are just in

the next Realm always waiting to help you if you will let them.  Yet, for the

moment, you  must leave the beauty of the Astral Realm and the lore of Water

Magick and enter into a  higher and even more exciting phase of Night Magick.

This is the Mental Realm and the  lore of Air Magick.


CHAPTER  VI



AIR  MAGICK 


30.  The Mental Realm 


As you travel on the road of Night Magick and endeavor to become a Night

Magician, you  first had to gain some mastery over your physical and emotional

selves.  This is a long  process and may take many lives to accomplish.  But

as you begin to achieve that  mastery, you will continue down the road towards

Night Consciousness.  Now you will  travel the third portion of the road

towards self-mastery.  You enter the Realm of Mind.


As you found with the Astral Realm, the Mental Realm is composed of varying

levels of vibration.  It would be wise to examine, in brief, these different

vibrations and their interrelationship. Let's begin with the highest realm and

work our way down to the lowest level.


The Void is the highest level that can be reached.  It is the level where we

are all united in  Mind as One.  Here, all are One.  This is the level of

knowing.  Here, you do not think for  all is known. Here all ideas exist, all

things are known, and you as the Spirit are the  Knower.  This is the level of

Pure Mind, the Void Mind, the sum of all.  This mind essence  interpenetrates

all and is accessible to all who are in vibration with it.  This is the

ultimate  level all must someday reach.  You must be the Knower.  The Godsoul

Mind is the next  level.


This is the level of original mind.  Here all minds are as one yet there is

individuality.   This is the level of highest individual mind.  Here is the

origin of the archetypes of mind. The Oversoul Mind is the next level.


This is the level of the Higher Mind.  From out of the Godsoul Mind, ideas

that exist  become manifest in this world.  Here, you find all joined in the

Oversoul Mind.  There is  Oneness in thought and consciousness.  The Oversoul

Thought first creates, using the  ideas drawn from the Godsoul Mind and the

mind substance of the Oversoul Realm.   Here, you are the Oversoul in Thought

and Action, the Creator.  Now you enter the  physical world of thought and

mind.


You may believe you know this world.  Actually, your thoughts and

consciousness are  much more then you realize.  You will remember that your

emotions were tied into your  emotional or Astral Body. Your thoughts and

consciousness are the same and make up  the Mental Body.  It is through your

Mental Body that you think and have consciousness  on the physical plane.  But

in order for the physical body to be tied into this Mental Body,  there must

be a physical link and this is the brain.  Many believe that it is the brain

that  actually does the thinking, but the brain is actually a receiving

station.  It takes the Mental  energies sent to it, by the Mental Body, and

translates it into action in the physical body.   Your brain is attuned to the

wavelength of your Mental Body.  Your brain and Mental  Body produces an

electromagnetic current through its activities, and thus, also produces  a

Mental Aura which is akin to your Astral Aura.  To see these energies, you

would have to  develop your Night Eye to a greater degree then you had when

you saw the Astral  energies.  I discussed earlier how the Oversoul is

directly linked to the physical body via  the silver cord into the heart

region.  The silver cord is also directly linked to the brain  region.  Thus

your thoughts are always monitored and acted upon by your Oversoul.  Your

Oversoul in order to experience the physical world must build-up physical

counterparts to  its Magickal Being.


So in the beginning of the Oversoul's physical sojourn, the mind substance of

the Mental  Body is undeveloped.  But as time in this world and the others

passes, the physical mind  develops and slowly becomes refined.  Life after

life, you come to this plane trying to  develop your physical consciousness

into one with your Oversoul consciousness.   Although the Oversoul can

influence the Mental Body if the Mental Body does not listen  then there is

little that the Oversoul can do.  The majority of the world does not listen to

the Oversoul.  Therefore the Oversoul withdraws into its own realm and remains

there  until the Lower Mind calls upon it for assistance and tries to listen

and follow its will. This  is what you are trying to do. So, as you move

farther into this chapter on Air Magick, you will encounter exercises,  rites,

and the use of your Night Magician's Tools and Weapons, in order to develop

your  mind.  You will take your mind through the tests of self-mastery in

order to become a  Night Magician. Your first rite in Air Magick will give you

the link between the air and  your mind.


31.  Air Rite 


The Ancient Ones compared the element of air to that of the mind. The Ancient

Mysteries, likewise, showed that the mental faculties could be compared to the

aerial regions.  It is  my intention to introduce a rite that will greatly

benefit the mind and its faculties.  The rite  puts together two elements:

your mind and the air.  I will show you how your mental  powers can be

enhanced through a special form of breathing.


You will remember in the topic on Night Breathing that it was through very

deep breathing that your health could be improved and for many, breathing is

very shallow.  In the Air  Rite, you are going to use deep breathing but it is

going to be based on a particular  breathing rate. Instead of just breathing

in and out rhythmically, you will breathe in and  hold the breath for so long,

and then breathe out and then, again, hold your breath. Great  benefit can be

derived by such.  Before you begin, I want to make it clear that this is

serious business and not a game. Please, DO NOT deviate from the set pattern

that is  about to be described.  To do so can be very hazardous to your

health.


To begin with, you must sit or lie down so that you are very comfortable.

Then, you want  to become very relaxed and reduce all the tenseness possible

in your body.  Then, you  will need to cross your ankles and wrists to

build-up the energy from your breathing.  If  you have done all of this, then

you are ready to begin with the breathing.  To start with,  you will do three

complete deep breathing exercises.  If you have forgotten how, then here  is a

quick review.


Inhale as deep a breath as possible pushing the diaphragm out as far as

possible.  When  you feel you have taken in all the air possible, take in just

a bit more air.  Then exhale the  air very steadily and completely bringing in

the diaphragm and abdomen as far as  possible.  You want to really empty your

lungs.  After you have done this, you are ready to  do the timed breathing.


Timed breathing means you are going to breathe in for so many seconds, then

hold your  breath for so many seconds, then exhale so many seconds, and again

hold your breath  for so many seconds. In the Air Rite, you are going to begin

by inhaling for five seconds,  hold your breath for ten seconds, exhale for

ten seconds, and hold your breath for seven  to ten seconds.  You are going to

repeat the entire process ten times.  There are certain  precautions you must

take in doing this rite.


You must not do it if you are in poor health.  You must stop doing it if for

any reason you  are feeling dizzy or light headed. If you persist in doing it

past these warning signals then  you are likely to pass out.  You must not

strain yourself in doing this rite.  There should be  absolutely no force on

your part to maintain the pattern of breathing.  If there is, then you  need

to reduce the number of seconds that you hold your breath.  If you do the rite

correctly then the benefits are tremendous.


You will find that your mental health will be tremendous.  You will feel

relieved of all  tension and mental strain.  You will feel extra charged with

new mental power.  This is an  excellent rite to use before and after any of

the mental exercises in Air Magick.  If you  need added mental power for long

periods of study or for increased memory then this rite  will greatly increase

both.  If your world is filled with mental demands, then this rite is  best

practiced several times a day.  It is especially good to use it when you feel

the least  mentally drained.  You can see that there is a very close

relationship to the air you  breathe and your mental faculties.  It is all

based on the right use of your breathing  patterns.  You should remember to be

relaxed and not to strain when you use the Air Rite.   Further, you must not

play around with different patterns of timed breathing if you don't  want to

hurt yourself.  You should always use this rite to the benefit of your good

health.   By now, you should be mentally charged up and ready to explore the

power of your mind.


32.  Power of Thought 


As the title suggests, there is power in your thoughts.  You probably have

never thought of  your thoughts as containing any kind of power but they do.

Much of Mental Magick  requires your understanding of the Mental Realm and how

to increase the powers of your  mind.   Here I will discuss briefly the Mental

Realm and begin your development of a  more powerful Mental Body.


When you die to the physical plane you move first to the Astral Realm.  After

reviewing  your past life and lives, you then receive guidance as to what to

do next.  If you are of a  higher vibration then that of the Astral Realm,

then you may leave, or die to, the Astral and  go on to the Mental Realm.  It

is here in the Mental Realm that all ideas are first brought  forth in created

form.  It is a world of thought and creation through thought.  The great

creations, inventions, social ideas, and art that are in the world today were

originally  created in this mind world and released into the physical world.

Here, in the physical  world, a receptive individual is able to tune into

these thought patterns and create from  them on the physical level. Thought

creation is the work of the Great Beings who live upon  this Mental World.

They create in thought great things that will enhance the physical  world.

This leads to your relationship with the Mental World.


There was some very significant information in that last paragraph that you

can carry over into your world here in the physical, in regards to thought

power.  The Beings who live in  the Mental Realm first perceive the idea, then

they picture the idea, and then they give the  idea form and send it into the

physical world.  You do the very same thing all the time, but  without very

much effort or concentration.  You often get an idea of something that you

want, but that's usually where it all ends. You may think about it once in a

while and hope  you will get it, but only sporadically.  If you look at the

Mental Realm around you and  examine its properties and how it works, then you

will see why thoughts can have power.


In this material world of ours, if you want to create something you must use

some physical means to do so.  This means is usually by way of your hands.  In

the Mental Realm, your material, so to speak, that you create with is the

etherial Mental energies.  The tool with  which you create with is your

thought.  By applying a strong, concentrated, and  continuous thought directed

at the Mental energies, you can create a Thought Form.  That  is, your

thoughts take on a form imbued with the qualities of your thoughts.  If you

continue to add more thought power to this form, it will eventually

materialize into your  material world. Whatever the thought is programmed to

do, it will happen here on Earth.   So if you wanted a forty foot yacht, then

that is what would eventually come into your  possession.  If the thought was

that of a specific healing for someone, then the thought  would go forth and

heal.  Now, before you go and rush off and start wishing for this and  that,

let's look at a few more facts.


You just can't sit down and start wishing.  You do that all the time.  There

is a certain way  that this must be done.  Next, you must build-up your powers

of observation,  concentration, memory, and visualization.  The meditation

that you have been doing,  hopefully all along, is important too.  In topic

forty, you will learn how to create through  thought.  It may seem that you

are a long way from getting to topic forty, but please don't  jump the topics

in between this one and forty.  You will, first, have to develop those  powers

of the mind, through the exercises that follow shortly.  The exercises must be

practiced faithfully, and for as long as it takes to master them.  Further,

each topic that  follows, up to number forty, will further enhance your mental

abilities and prepare you for  topic forty.  Now, let's get to those

exercises.


Exercise #1, Observation.  There aren't too many who can at the end of the day

recall  what they did step-by-step.  Yet, this is part of your observation

training.  In the evening,  sit down and recall the day the best that you can.

At first, this may not be as easy as it  sounds.  Then, take this one stage

further, and at the end of the week, say on Saturday,  again sit down and

recall the entire week in as much detail as possible.  Visualize, or  picture,

the people you met, things that you did, and things said.  Another observation

exercise you can do is to enter a room quickly and, for say thirty seconds,

look around the  room and then shut your eyes and recall as many objects as

possible.  You can do this in  the outdoors, too.  For example, while walking

down the sidewalk, or in the park, observe  what's around you and then stop

and close your eyes and recall all the details of your  surroundings that you

have just passed.  If you will study these examples, then perhaps  you can go

on to create more observation exercise for yourself.


Exercise #2, Concentration.  To begin with, do some mental arithmetic.  On

your mental blackboard, begin by adding a row of numbers.  Write down the

numbers on a sheet of  paper and then close your eyes and see those numbers on

your board.  Then, add them  mentally, and when you have the answer write it

down and then do it on paper.  Next,  multiply some numbers and, also, do some

division.  At first, you will be able to use only  simple numbers, but as your

concentration develops, you will be able to do more and  more complicated

problems.  Another concentration exercise you might use is to  concentrate on

NOT thinking.  That's right!  You are going to get very quiet in your

Magician's Study, with the curtains drawn, and you are going to picture your

mental  blackboard and you are going to keep it blank.  You are going to cease

thinking of  anything.  Concentrate on doing this.  It is not easy, for

thoughts will do their best to creep  in, but you must concentrate and not

permit them to do so.  Do this for about ten minutes  to begin with, and then

gradually lengthen the time per sitting. Exercise #3, Memory.   Begin by

picking your favorite passage from a book or poet and selecting five or six

lines from it. Then memorize them.  Constantly create new memory  games that

will exercise your power of memory.  Acquire a booklet that gives you some

material to study, and provides you with a test that will see just how much

you have been  able to retain of the material. Make a list of ten people,

places, or things and then recall  them forward and backward.  Gradually

increase the number of items on your list.


Exercise #4, Visualization.  A phrase that you might select to mean the same

as the word visualization is, "to picture with the mind's eye".  You are going

to create an image of  something in your mind.  Begin this exercise by

thinking of someone you know and then  picturing what that person looks like.

Get this image in your mind's eye so real, that it  seems to be right there in

front of you.  An aid that you might use is to get a photograph of  the person

and then study it for a minute and then do your visualization.  Next, you

might  try, while walking down the sidewalk and coming towards someone, to

study their face  carefully and after they have passed you, recall their face

in your mind's eye.  Don't just  use people as subjects.  If you can think of

objects, or animals, that will be great, too.  But  when you visualize these

people, or whatever you choose, see them in clear detail and  always in color.

These are the four exercises that will set your feet definitely on the path

of acquiring mastery over your mind.  In all these exercises do them no more

then about  fifteen minutes each.  You should do them all, at least, once a

day. You might want to  separate them, doing some exercises during the day and

others when you are at home at  night.  Continue to practice these exercises

for the rest of your sojourn here on Earth.


Practice these with patience and determination and you will gain mental

mastery.  You  will be on your way to being able to have great success with

creative visualization.  An  important part of the Mental Realm involves the

Silent Magician who you'll meet next.


33.  Your Silent Magician 


You have just come from looking at your Mental Body and knowing that it is

your physical consciousness.  But actually, your Mental Body is much, much

more.  Your Mental Body  also contains that part of your consciousness which

is called the Subconscious Mind.   How much of your consciousness is composed

of the Subconscious?   Would you believe,  almost all of it? That's right!

You actually use only a very small fraction of your total  mental capacity.

What about geniuses, you ask?  They only use a part of a fraction more  then

do the rest of us.  To get some idea of how small your mental capacity is, in

relation  to the whole, let's first imagine a fifty-five gallon drum.


It's empty right now, but if you were going to fill it with water,

representing your physical consciousness, how much water would it take?  Well,

believe it or not, it would take only  about five gallons.  The rest of the

space comprises your Subconscious Mind.  As you can  see, your Subconscious is

a mental giant.  Just imagine what would happen if you could  tap into this

great source of mental power.  You are going to learn to do this in just a

little  while.  But first, you must become more familiar with the Subconscious

Mind and the role  it plays in your life.


You could actually name the Subconscious Mind, your "Silent Witness".  For

indeed, that  is what your Subconscious does.  It witnesses all that you do.

It is able to remember all  that you have ever done in this lifetime and

what's more, it contains the memories from all  your lives here on Earth and

sojourns in the otherworlds.  Why can't you remember them  then?


This is because there is an energy screen between yourself and the

Subconscious.  This  screen is there for several reasons. First, this screen

prevents you from tampering with the Subconscious Mind.  For most people

memories of past lives should remain off limits. Therefore, you have this

screen which prevents you from directly learning what is stored  in your

Subconscious.  To know your past lives may seem, at first, important, but

really it's  not. What if in a past life you were a murderer or a robber?

Could you handle this  information? Some say, that they would like to search

into the Subconscious Mind and  know why they have returned to this world and

learn what it is they came here for.  But if  you find this out, and

concentrate so hard on accomplishing this one thing, that you might,

inadvertently, overlook something else which will cause you to have to come

back down  here.  Actually, knowing your past lives, and why you came down

here, is really  unnecessary.  What's really important is that you live this

life to your very best.  That  each, and every day, you do the very best that

you can and give life your very best effort.   If you do this, then when you

reach the other side you can say, you did your very best, and  that is all

anyone can ask.


Second, unlike your physical consciousness, your Subconscious hasn't the

ability to discriminate between Truth and untruth. The Subconscious simply

takes all information given to it by the physical consciousness and records

it.  The energy screen allows you  time to hash over a problem, discerning

what's right and what's wrong, and when you  have come up with the right

answer, or what seems right to you, your Subconscious then  incorporates that

into its storage banks.  The screen prevents data from leaving your  conscious

mind, too soon, and entering the Subconscious. So, you know that your

Subconscious Mind is the storage house for all that you have ever done.  You

also know  that it is not able to discern between Truth and untruth, but there

is more.  It will store  whatever you know to be Truth.  From this you can

determine that your Subconscious is  unable to reason, that is, unable to form

conclusions or make judgments.  The  Subconscious is not logical.  Yet, your

Subconscious Mind plays a big role in your life.   The biggest role it plays

is to function as a relay between you, the physical  consciousness, and your

Oversoul.


Your Oversoul receives information on your progress down here on Earth from

your Subconscious Mind and the Oversoul relays information and directives to

your  Subconscious, who then puts them into action in your life.  This is an

important aspect  which I will expand on a little later.  Your Subconscious

Mind is also in link with all other  Subconscious Minds. Your Subconscious

Mind is able to tap in with any other  Subconscious Mind, and they are able to

pool information.  So, if you were able to  communicate with your Subconscious

Mind directly, you would be able to find out from it  information about

anything that you needed to know.  Your Subconscious has direct links  with

both your Oversoul and with all other Subconscious Minds.  But communication

with  your Subconscious Mind is not an easy thing to do.


You can see by all the things your Subconscious Mind is involved in, that it

is a very busy entity.  Getting its attention is the task at hand.  What would

you do, if you were trying to  get the attention of your next-door neighbor

who is very busy in their house and who has  never been disturbed before?  You

would go next-door, and knock, and call out their  name, until someone

answered.  You are going to use a similar procedure with your  Subconscious

Mind.  First, before you start knocking on your Subconscious Mind's door,

your going to do a little visualization.


In your mind's eye, view a large room with storage files and computer data

banks and a  large control panel, and in charge of all this is your

Subconscious, your Silent Witness,  and who you will picture as your Silent

Night Magician.  You'll envision her/him dressed  as you are dressed during

your rituals in full Night Magick regalia.  It is here, in this room,  on the

Isle of your Silent Magician located in the Mental Realm, that you will go to

speak  with your Silent Magician.  Before you can communicate with Her or Him,

let's first look at  the language you must communicate in. There is a special

way that you must talk to your Silent Magician in order for Her/Him to

understand you correctly.  You know S/he can not reason nor is S/he able to be

logical.   S/he can not discern between Truth or untruth.  So the Silent

Magician takes everything  you say very literal.  So when you talk to your

Silent Magician, you must use the most  simple, direct, and plain language.

You do not want to say anything which has a double  meaning.  For example, if

you want to find out where your lost ring is, and you ask  Her/Him if S/he

knows if the ring is in the sink drain, the Silent Magician will answer, Yes!

Yes, S/he does know if it is there or not, but that doesn't mean it is there.

Ask Her/Him a  direct question, "Is the ring in the sink drain of the

kitchen?"  Now that you have the  preliminaries over with, its time for you to

get down to the actual business of communion  with your Silent Magician.


To begin with, go into your Magician's Study and lie down and relax.  Do some

Night  Breathing and get very comfortable.  Now, envision the control room in

your mind, where  your Silent Magician is located.  And once again, picture

your Silent Magician at work.   Now call out Her/His name.  What's Her/His

name?


You're going to have to give Her/Him a very personal name similar to the one

you  selected as your Night Name.  This is a name that only you will know.

You're not going to  tell anyone else the name of your Silent Magician.  Now,

picturing very strongly your  Magician at work, call out Her/His new name.  A

proper way of doing such would be to  say, "You who are my Subconscious Mind

and Silent Magician and Friend, I give you the  name of __________ ." Say this

at least three times.  Then go on to say to, "when I call  out your name you

will please listen to me.  I want you and me to be partners and friends  for

this will benefit both of us. I want you to help me in all that I do.  I want

this in all  sincerity and honesty." Say this also three times.  You must do

this three times a day.   You must grow use to saying and doing this and

thinking of your Subconscious as a friend  and ally. Know that when you have

the attention of your Subconscious Mind, that you are  without limitation.


The Silent Magician is all powerful and all knowing.  S/He can be a tremendous

ally.  For  now, this is all you should do.  Just get acquainted with your

Silent Magician and gain  Her/His trust.  You should always be truthful and

straightforward with your Silent Friend.   You, in your own right, are

mentally strong and you are only a small fraction of your full  potential.

Imagine what would be your mental ability and the power of your thoughts, if

you could increase them eleven fold.  This can be, if you will tie in with

your Silent  Magician.  Your ally on Earth.  As you have seen, your

Subconscious is unique.  Even  though S/he can not reason or be logical, S/he

can do all that you can do.  S/He can do all  you can do only eleven times

greater.  It is the seat of total memory.  By reaching  Her/Him, and

convincing Her/Him that you need Her/Him, S/he will release information to

you that you are unaware of, about yourself.  S/he can correct wrongs with you

such as,  habits that you would like to be rid of, and can increase such

things as your memory  retention if you will work with Her/Him.  You can also

go direct to your Oversoul by  gaining your Silent Magician's trust and aid.


The Subconscious will be glad to go direct to your Oversoul for you if S/he

truly sees the  need. You must convince Her/Him of your sincerity and

trustworthiness.  You will be  cooperating with your Silent Magician in the

use of self-hypnosis, the pendulum, crystal,  psychometry, and telepathy.  So

work hard on reaching your Silent Magician and  developing the close rapport

needed in your work as a Night Magician.  Your first joint  undertaking,

between you and your Silent Friend, is the practice of self- hypnosis.


34.  Hypnotism and Self 


In classical mythology, Hypnos was the god of sleep.  He was the brother of

Thanatos and  the son of Erebus and Nyx.  The word, hypnotism, is taken from

the greek word,  "hypnoein", which means, "to put to sleep".  So you can see

that hypnotism must have  something to do with sleep, right?  Actually, it

doesn't have anything to do with sleep,  except that when a person is in a

hypnotic state of consciousness, s/he may appear to be  sleeping. What then is

hypnosis?


In the state of hypnosis, you are extremely vulnerable to suggestions.  For

example, if you  are told that when you put your hand in a vat of water and

will feel a pleasant warmth,  then this will be so.  Even if the water in the

tub is very, very cold. That doesn't mean that  your hand won't be cold, but

as far as your physical consciousness is concerned, the  hand feels warmth

from the cold water.  How can this be?  You're going to examine that  very

question in-depth and go on to learn some good uses for hypnotism and also the

dangers of hypnotism.  Lastly, you are going to learn how to induce

self-hypnosis and the  reasons for doing so.  First though, let's see how

hypnosis works.


To begin your investigation, you're going to examine the technique of a

hypnotist at work.   For in studying how a hypnotist works, you will be able

to gain an insight into how  hypnosis works.  The hypnotist first needs a

subject and that is going to be you.  The  hypnotist will then stand in front

of you and s/he will suspend some shiny object and ask  you to concentrate on

the object.  As you continue to concentrate, the hypnotist will begin  the

first of her/his suggestions to you; you are starting to feel drowsy.  Next,

s/he will tell  you that your eyelids are starting to feel heavy.  You can see

already that from just trying  to concentrate on the object that you will

start to feel eye fatigue.  And because your eyes  are starting to feel tired,

you already are beginning to trust the suggestions of the  hypnotist.  As the

process continues, you will start to fall into an altered state of  awareness.

When the hypnotist has you deeply relaxed, s/he will continue with further

suggestions.  For example, s/he will then ask you to raise your right arm

straight out in  front of you.  Then s/he will tell you that your arm is

starting to feel very heavy and that  you can hardly hold it up. Well, it's

obvious that the hypnotist is requesting you to do  things and then makes

suggestions which corresponds with what you are feeling.  But in  all of this,

there is a very real purpose, and that is for you to believe in the hypnotist.

You  are starting to trust the hypnotist and believe that whatever s/he tells

you is going to  occur.  But actually, there is much more to it then just your

outer conscious belief in the  hypnotist.


Here, you rejoin your new friend, the Silent Magician, for the explanation.

What the  hypnotist has been doing is breaching the energy screen that is

between you and your  Silent Friend.  The hypnotist has actually been working

on the Subconscious Mind with  her/his suggestions and gaining Her/His trust.

When the hypnotist has convinced the  Silent Magician that whatever s/he says

is going to happen, then you are truly hypnotised.   You will remember from

the last topic, that your Subconscious is unable to discern  between the Truth

and untruth.  They are not able to reason.  So as you, the physical

consciousness, trusted the hypnotist and began to believe in her/him, so the

Subconscious Mind will too.  The hypnotist, in convincing you with her/his

simple  suggestions has caused you to lower the energy screen between you and

your Subconscious.  Once this screen was lowered, the hypnotist is directly

working with your Subconscious Mind. All that s/he now tells you, your Silent

Magician will believe and comply with.  If s/he tells you when you look at an

object, that you will not be able to see it, then to your physical

consciousness, the object will not be there.  This is hypnosis.   Hypnosis can

be a real benefit to humankind, but it can also be a real danger.  There  have

been some valuable uses for hypnosis in today's society.  Medically they have

used  hypnosis in some cases as a substitute for anesthetic.  Thereby

eliminating the dangers  of having to anesthetize someone.  The police have

used it to hypnotize a crime victim, or  witness, in order to draw out of the

Subconscious Mind greater details of a crime, and so,  possibly leading to the

capture of the criminals.  These are some very positive uses for  hypnosis.

Hypnosis can be a very dangerous subject.  You should under no circumstances

allow  yourself to be placed under hypnosis by someone you do not fully trust.

Nor should you  undergo hypnosis for fun and games.  Hypnosis is a serious

business.  When you  undergo hypnosis, you surrender your Subconscious Mind,

out of the Hands of your  Oversoul, and into the hands of the hypnotist. As

you can see, this can lead to some  serious consequences for you, if you are

in the wrong hands.  Let your imagination  conjure up the harm that can be

done to you by the hypnotist.  So let this be warning  enough, DO NOT BE

HYPNOTIZED, unless you are absolutely sure of the hypnotist and  why you are

being hypnotized.  How can you get around the hypnotist?


You can circumvent her/him by using self-hypnosis.  You are going to be the

hypnotist.   For sure, I can think of no better hypnotist then you, once you

are properly trained.  There  are many reasons why you might want to use

self-hypnosis.  If you have ever wanted to  stop smoking; to improve your

memory; to stop a bad habit; to develop particular traits  within yourself,

for example, patience and calmness; then you will want to try self-  hypnosis.

For some, a big reason would be to lose weight.  The possibilities are

endless.   When you tell your Silent Magician, in self-hypnosis, what you

want, then you will see it  occur in yourself.  But be sure, if you are trying

to give up something, that you truly want  to give it up.  Otherwise you won't

be able to do it.  As you begin to learn the techniques  for self-hypnosis,

you should be in reasonably good health.  If you are in good health,  then

let's begin. You will practice this in your Magician's Study insuring that the

room is free from  intrusion by others and without drafts.  The room should be

reasonably dark.  Once all  your room preparations have been made, then you

should lay down on something  comfortable.  Now you are going to practice the

complete body relaxation that you  practiced in preparation for Night

Projection.  If you go through the same motions that you  did in that topic,

then you will have achieved the proper state of relaxation.  To quickly

recount what you did; you began thinking of your toes and erasing all tension

in them.   Then you went up the leg and did this for both legs.  You worked on

every part of your  body achieving the fullest relaxation possible.  This is

what you want here.  Now, practice  some Night Breathing and deepen the

relaxation.  While you are breathing, just let your  thoughts float on your

breath.  The key is to relax deeply.  Now to contact your Silent  Magician.


Pull your thoughts together and concentrate your gaze upon a point somewhere

on the  ceiling above you.  This point should be at such an angle that it

causes slight eye strain.   Now, as you continue to stare, you will begin to

feel eye strain.  When you can feel this,  you should then tell yourself,

aloud, that when you count beginning from ten and reach  one, you are going to

close your eyes and be unable to open them.  So let's do it.


"I am going to count from ten to one and when I reach one my eyes will close

because  they have become very tired.  Ten, my eyes are starting to feel

tired; nine, my eyes are  becoming much more tired and I am beginning to feel

like closing them; eight, my eyes  are starting to become very tired;

seven-six, my eyelids are becoming very heavy; five-four, my eyes are so tired

that I have to close them; three, I can no longer keep my eyes  open and feel

a real need to close them; two, my eyes are so tired they will no longer stay

open; one, my eyes have shut."


Your eyes should shut automatically, even if your eyes should not close do not

worry.  Go  ahead and close them anyway for what you are doing is setting up

an automatic reaction,  within yourself, when you do this.  Now that you have

your eyes closed, let's continue with  self- hypnosis.


You are going to visualize your Silent Magician and you are going to say

outloud the  following:


"I am going to count from ten to one and when I reach one I'm going to be in a

deep state  of self- hypnosis.  I'm going to be alert and fully conscious and

my Friend is going to  respond to all I say to her/him and comply with my

desires.  Ten, I am becoming very  relaxed and my body is starting to feel

very heavy; nine, my body is feeling heavy and my  spirit is lightly floating

within my body; eight-seven, I am becoming deeply relaxed and  slowly entering

into trance; six-five, I am now in trance yet alert and fully conscious;

four-three, I am going deeper and deeper into trance; two, I am reaching the

deepest state of  trance every before achieved; one, I am completely in trance

yet fully alert and conscious.   State name of your Silent Magician please

listen to me and do what I ask for."


Now is the time to make known to your Silent Friend all that you want her/him

to do.  Let's give Her/Him, though, only one thing per session.  You are going

to practice the entire technique, as outlined previously, for the first few

times, until you can do it correctly and easily.  Then you will condense the

relaxation and self-hypnosis state into one happening.


You are going to say to yourself that when you count to one, you are going to

achieve a  complete state of relaxation and self-hypnosis.  That you are going

to be fully alert and  know what's going on and that you are going to be able

to direct your Silent Witness to do  as you ask.  The relaxation and

self-hypnosis state should come easily, for it should now  have become an

automatic reaction.  Do not have any fear of coming out of this state of

self-hypnosis for it will happen automatically. Through self-hypnosis you can

correct faults  within yourself, or implant qualities that you would like to

acquire.  Through regular  practice you can achieve this.  This is serious

business and should be approached as  such.  Self-hypnosis will achieve for

you all that you desire, and you know that you're in  safe hands, your own!

Your Silent Magician will also be your partner and friend in your  use of the

Night Magician's Pendulum.


35.  A Night Magician's Pendulum 


On a dark green hill, encircled by gardens of flowers, immense old trees,

fountains, and  set against a starlit night sky we find the cave entrance to

the cavern home of the Night  Magician. A home dedicated to the ancient

practice and knowledge of Night Magick.  A  home that is as ageless as the

stars that it is dedicated to.  As we enter this beautiful  home, through its

ancient portal, we can see into the Magician's Study and find the  Ancient

One, busy in observation of the stars through a cavern window.  We continue to

enter, very quietly so as not to disturb the Old One, when suddenly we are

startled by the  resounding chimes of a huge grandfather clock, in its act of

proclaiming the hour of the  night.  The most striking thing about the clock

is its beautiful, ornate brass pendulum.   The pendulum swings side-to-side

ticking away the hours. We all know that the pendulum  is set so that time is

measured out with the greatest of accuracy. But the pendulum is not  just for

telling time.  The pendulum is also a valuable tool for the Night Magician.

So let's  leave the Old One and move to your Magician's Study to take up the

study of the Night  Magician's Pendulum.


Your pendulum is not going to be as ornate and beautiful as the one you just

observed at  the Magician's home, but it is based upon the same principle.

The pendulum is made up  of a long arm with a weight suspended on the end.

The pendulum you will use is simple  to make.  You will want to construct at

least two pendulums.


One will require a string at least forty-eight inches long, and the other

about twelve inches long.  A strong sewing thread will serve very well as the

material from which to make the string. The weight you use can be made of a

variety of things.  The weight can be made of  a round ball, about one inch in

diameter, and constructed of wood, plastic, glass, or a  neutral metal.  You

should have pendulums on hand made up of a variety of the materials  just

listed. You can also use a simple ring as a weight.  Another very simple

weight you  can construct will require an unused pencil and sewing needle.

Put the point of the  needle through the top of the eraser, so that the needle

will remain attached to the pencil.   Then, put the thread through the eye of

the needle and tie it off, and so, you have the  complete pendulum.  Once you

have made, or acquired, your pendulums, what are you  going to use them for?


Your pendulum will answer questions that range across the entire spectrum of

your imagination.  Have you lost a ring and want to find it?  You could find

missing people or a  lost pet.  The pendulum can answer questions you have

concerning most any topic that  you wish to pursue.  But how can it do this?


For part of the answer you must look to your old friend, the Silent Magician.

The  pendulum is an instrument, used by the Silent Magician, to give you the

answers to the  questions that you put to Her/Him.  In review, you will

remember that your Silent Friend is  very brilliant and there is very little

that s/he does not know, or cannot find out, since They  are in direct contact

with all other Silent Magicians.  You will remember that your entire  body has

an electrical field which completely surrounds it.  When you have the pendulum

suspended from your hand and ask your Magician a question, s/he alters the

electrical  field of your body.  That field also surrounds the pendulum and

causes it to move.  The  pendulum's movement has been set in a certain pattern

to indicate Yes or No.  The Silent  Magician is not the only one who can alter

the movement of the pendulum.  Any resident  of the higher realms can also

alter your electrical field, and so the movement of the  pendulum, if they

know how.  As a rule, the entity working with you, and through the  pendulum,

requires some time before they really can manipulate the pendulum well.  So

not only can you receive information from your Silent Magician but also your

Guides and  Teacher.  Before studying the mechanics of how to use the

pendulum, you must prepare  yourself to use the pendulum.


The how-to of self-preparation is relatively simple to state, but often hard

to achieve.  You begin by being sure your hands and body are clean, otherwise

this will interfere with your  body electricity.  You must have a calm and

receptive mind.  Your mind must be in a  relaxed state and without nervous

tension and fears. Your mind must be prepared to  concentrate on only one

thing, and that is what you are trying to answer.  Your mental  attitude must

be a serious one when you approach this lore.  If you have achieved this

self-preparation in mind and body, then you're ready to begin learning how to

use your  Magician's Pendulum.


First, you will prepare your Magician's Study for the use of the pendulum.  Be

sure the  room will be free from interruptions. Then erect a table to work on

that is made up of only  a hard top surface and four legs.  Nothing should be

under the table for this will interfere  with the reception of the proper

answer.  In all cases, you will want to have blank, clean,  unused, white

sheets of paper.


The standard, eleven by eight white typing paper will be fine. This is the

paper over which  you are going to suspend your pendulum.  On the paper, you

are going to draw in the  center a large plus sign(+).  At the top and bottom

of the paper, you are going to write the  word, YES.  On the right and left

sides of the paper, you are going to write the word, NO.   You will use a new

sheet marked in this way for each set of questions asked pertaining to  a

certain area of examination.  Please be sure and use a fresh sheet for each

set of  questions asked, for when questions are asked, the paper becomes

saturated with the  impressions from those questions, and these impressions

will interfere with any other set  of questions asked.  To begin, you must

formulate the questions you are going to ask.


For example, where is my lost gold ring?  The question must be simple, clear,

concise,  and unambiguous.  Then you must invoke the Night Pillar around

yourself and your  Magician's Study or the place you're working in.  If you

don't do this, then any force may  use the pendulum and cause misleading

answers.  After this, you'll take the short stringed  pendulum, between your

hands, and concentrate on the Night Force around you.  Then  ask the question

three times.  Then, take the string of the pendulum and wrap it around  the

first or second finger of the right hand, if you are right handed; left hand

if you are left  handed, such that when you rest your elbow on the table, the

weight of the pendulum is  about an inch above the paper and suspended over

the plus sign. Then, begin asking if  the ring is in the kitchen sink, and so

on. You can tell when the pendulum is answering  you, because it will swing

with purpose.  Be sure and wait between each question, till the  pendulum

answers.  If the pendulum makes a circling motion, this indicates uncertainty.

Either the force guiding the pendulum doesn't know, the question is ambiguous,

or they  refuse to answer the question.  Try asking the question in a more

precise and clear way,  and if there is still uncertainty, go on to another

question.  If you ask a question that  involves a geographical answer, then

you will need a map.  If the search area involves a  large area, use a map of

small scale.  This is a map which covers a large area of land on  a small

amount of map area.  Then, when you have found a more precise location, use a

larger scale map to get a pinpoint location.  In order for you to use the map,

place it on  the left side, and the plus marked paper on the right.  Take the

pendulum over the map  area and ask it to reveal the location of what you're

looking for.  Then hold the pendulum  over the white sheet of paper as before,

and as you ask your question, you'll move your  left forefinger slowly over

the map area.  The pendulum will swing in the positive direction  when you

have reached the right area.  This completes the instruction on the use of the

pendulum, indoors.  It takes practice to gain mastery over the use of the

pendulum.  You  must be sure and use simple language and concentrate strongly

on the question you want  answered.  Perhaps you've seen, or even used, some

form of dowsing rod to locate water.


The dowsing rod works on the very same principles as the pendulum.  For

uniformity, and familiarity, you are going to use the pendulum outdoors in

locating not only water, if that  is what you want, but anything else you

desire.  For this method, you will now need your  longer stringed pendulum.

To start with, you must prepare the pendulum for your use.   Let's say you

want to find gold.  Then you will need to place in, or on the weight of the

pendulum, a sample of gold.  This can be as small as a flake, but it must be

pure gold.   Further, you must put under your feet another piece of gold.  The

gold must be pure, so  for example, if you use your wedding ring be sure it is

solid, pure gold.  Then, with your  pendulum in the correct hand, you will

again ask your Silent Magician or Guides to find  gold for you.  Then, loosely

holding the string in the proper hand, slowly lower the weight  towards the

ground until it swings in a definite circular motion. You will need to

experiment with the proper length of string, until you get just the right

length which gives  you the best circular motion.  At this point, you should

mark the string with a knot, and  color code it, and record it for future

reference. You can apply this same technique to  anything that you want to

find.  You should take the time to prepare your pendulum for all  the things

that you will want to find.  In all that you do with the Night Magician's

Pendulum, you should remember certain key things in its proper use.


You should remember that in talking with your Silent Friend, you want to use

the simplest  and most direct language, and to repeat it at least three times.

You should always  remind your Friend that you need Her/Him, because what you

ask Her/Him to do for you,  S/he does for Her/Himself, too; that you are One

in Thought and Purpose.  So be sure,  that whatever you decide to do, that it

is in agreement with your inner beliefs.  If you try to  use it for something

you know to be wrong, then your Silent Friend will stop working with  you and

that will be the end of your growth. At the end of each set of questions, be

sure  and thank your Silent Magician for the aid that S/he has provided.

Appreciation and  respect, go a long way in your successful use of the Night

Magician's Pendulum.   Remember, that the pendulum is for your use alone.

Never allow anyone else to use or  touch your personal pendulum.  You can use

the pendulum to help others find answers to  their questions but they should

never use your pendulum to do so, you will use it for them.   Most of all, you

should go into this practice with the most serious of attitudes towards it.

Your frame of mind can mean the difference between success and failure.

Everything you  do to get closer with your Silent Magician, Guides, and

Teacher, and to make them your  unfailing allies in all that you do, will

bring mastery into your life here, and hereafter.  The  pendulum is the first

of your new Magician's Tools to be acquired in Air Magick, and now  you are to

acquire your second tool, the Night Magician's Crystal Globe. 36.  A Night

Magician's Crystal Globe


You will remember that when you were in the Night Magician's cave last, you

found the  Old One busily engaged in the observation of the stars.  Let's

return to the Magician's  cavern home and see if the Ancient One has begun

some new practice from which you  can observe and learn.


As you quietly enter the home, you have the feeling that you must go to the

study.  As you  move into the study, you find the Ancient One sitting on the

floor in an apparent state of  deep meditation.  You find that the room is

very dark and that it is taking your eyes some  time to adjust to the

darkness.  As you continue to observe the Magician, you suddenly  become aware

that more then just meditation is taking place.  You can now see that the

Wise One is gazing into a sphere of apparent nothingness.  To your vision,

there appears  to be a hole of darkness into which the Magician seems to be

gazing.  You move closer to  get a better view of what this phenomena is.  You

can now see that this sphere of  emptiness is composed of what appears to be a

clear substance. Suddenly, it dawns upon  you that you are observing the

Magician in the act of Crystal Gazing.  Now you know this  is what you are

going to learn to do.  Let's begin your instruction then with an in-depth

examination of the Crystal the Ancient One was using.


The Crystal is spherical in shape and was so clear that there appeared to be

nothing there  in the darkness.  Due to the clarity of the Crystal Globe, no

reflection of light could be  observed to give it depth.  The Crystal Globe,

that the Magician is using, is without flaw.  If  there were flaws in the

Crystal then what light was available would cast reflections off  these flaws

and disturb the Magician's gazing.  When the Magician gazes into the Crystal

Globe it is like looking into a deep globe of nothingness.  If you were to

visit a store in  order to purchase a Crystal Globe or even one of glass, you

would find that a perfectly  flawless one is very expensive.  So for your

purposes, you are going to use a crystal  hollow globe with a hole in the top.


I indicated you should use crystal but glass will also do.  The hollow globe

should be as  round as possible.  The surface of the globe should be without

flaws or markings.  The  globe should be about six inches in diameter.  A

similar globe is often sold as a fish bowl.   It should be able to sit on a

flat surface.  If you have now purchased this Crystal Globe,  then let's go on

to prepare the gazing area.


Arrange your Magician's Study so that you can be seated comfortably on the

floor, and in  front of you, you should have your small Night Altar of about

eighteen inches in height.   There should be no strain on the back or shoulder

muscles.  If there is then adjust the  height of the table.  It is not

absolutely necessary that you sit on the floor, for you can sit  in a chair as

long as you can see directly into the globe and it is within easy reach.

Cover  the table with a dark blue or black cloth. You must insure that almost

all light has been  eliminated from the room.


Be sure you are clean and have washed your hands before ever touching the

globe.  You  must clean the globe, without soap, before filling it with water.

Clean the globe under  running water and hold the globe with a cloth and dry

it before filling it.  Never allow  direct light to fall on the globe.  Keep

the globe in a safe place and wrapped in a dark  cloth.  Never allow the

curious to touch the globe.  After you have placed the globe on the  table

then fill it with water.  Fill it all the way to the rim so that the globe

appears to be  solid.  This takes care of your study preparation but you

mustn't forget self-preparation.


Be sure you are in good health.  Before you begin this exercise, you must be

in a good  mental state.  Your mind should be calm and as free from worry as

possible.  Be sure that  you have been eating sensibly and don't eat a big

meal just before commencing to use  the globe.  Now you are ready to begin

using the Crystal Globe.


Be seated comfortably and place the Night Pillar around you.  You must

practice Night Breathing for a few minutes in order to become more relaxed.

Then place your hands on  the bottom sides of the globe.  Your hands should be

in direct contact with the glass.   Gaze lightly upon the globe.  Do not begin

with a fixed and concentrated gaze.  Look at a  point somewhere inside the

globe and relax.  Do not try to see anything.  As you continue  to gaze, you

will see the globe start to cloud up with a whitish appearance.  This is

excellent and exactly what you want. You should continue to gaze, and the

cloudiness  will disappear, and you will begin to see.  You may even feel a

slight falling sensation so  don't be startled, or you will have to try

another evening, which by the way is the best time  to practice this. There

are three types of seeing that may occur.


You may actually see as if you were watching television.  That is, you may see

pictures  and events occurring.  Next, you may only see symbols.  These are

pictures which  represent events or happenings.  Finally, you may only receive

impressions.  You may  only receive feelings and thoughts as to what is trying

to be communicated to you.   Whatever you receive, through the use of the

Crystal Globe is a true achievement.  You  are successful, whether you see

pictures, symbols, or impressions.  In the beginning, you  may encounter some

difficulty in achieving any results.


You should only begin by gazing for about fifteen minutes at the most.  By the

end of the  week, you should have extended that time to about thirty minutes.

This is all that is  recommended when you are first beginning.  In the

beginning, you will see only things  that pertain to you alone.  As you begin

to see more clearly and easily, you should begin  to direct the Crystal in

what you want to see.  As you first touch the globe and relax,  concentrate a

mental thought at the Crystal and tell it what it is you want to see.

Eventually, you will gain control over the Crystal and be able to direct it at

whatever it is  you are interested in knowing.  You can also use the Crystal

Globe to give others a  reading.


To do this, you will go through the very same setup procedures. Then before

you actually  touch the globe, direct the individual who desires the reading,

to touch the globe and  concentrate on what s/he wants to know about.  You

should also warn them, in advance,  not to say anything that will disturb you

while you are gazing and giving her/him their  reading.  Then, you will take

over control of the Crystal and gaze upon it as you would for  yourself, and

give what you see.


In all cases, when you are through using the Crystal Globe, you will again

rinse the globe  and dry it off before putting it away. The Crystal Globe

works by focusing and concentrating the clairvoyant energies from your Night

Eye Center.  The Crystal Globe is an extension of your Night Eye.  The globe,

as  with your own personal clairvoyance, is able to do many things.


The globe can help you look into the past, present, and future. It can help

you look into  any matter which concerns you and to see all sides of the

matter under discernment.  You  can go anywhere at anytime and see all that

you wish to see.


You must know that you are going to succeed each time you use the Crystal.

Even if you  don't succeed, you must not become discouraged.  Every attempt at

using the Crystal  Globe leads you one step closer to success.  You should

have the attitude of a very  personal commitment to the Crystal Globe.  Always

treat it with the utmost respect.  The  entire business of crystal gazing is

very serious business and should be treated as such if  you are going to

succeed at it.  Your next subject is also a form of seeing.  Only instead of

using the eyes to see with, you are going to use your hands.


37.  Psychometry 


Psychometry is the development of your clairaudient faculties in relation to

your sense of touch.  By psychometry, you are going to be able to pickup an

object and know its origin  and history. If the object ever belonged to

someone, then you will receive the thoughts  and feelings of that individual.

Psychometry is related to your clairaudient faculties.  Let's  see how?


As you will recall, clairaudience is related to your fifth Night Center which

is located at the throat level.  As your Night Center begins to grow and

develop, you develop the sense, in  part, of being able to perceive sound from

the Night Realm.  You can hear in a sense, the  voice of the Night Spirit and

even the so called "Music of the Night Spheres".  All of this is  the

attunement to, and perception of, higher vibration.  An extension of your

clairaudient  ability is the perception of an object's vibration through

touch.  Your left hand, if you are  right handed, is the sensitive hand to

magickal vibration.  All things, of all types of nature,  have a personal

vibration.  That vibration is composed of the entire history and nature

peculiar to that object. Your clairaudient faculty is able to attune to that

vibration and  translate it into pictures, sounds, and/or feelings that you

can perceive.


Psychometry has many practical applications.  You can see actual history

taking place by using objects that are related to a particular historical

event.  But remember, you will see history as it related to that particular

object and its part in that history.  You can view the origin of the planet

through very ancient objects.  In a more practical application, you  could

pickup a book and get the basic feeling of that book and what it is about, and

then  decide if you are going to like reading it or not.  You can learn about

the inner nature of  individuals of interest to you by examining an object

which belongs to them. For example,  this could help you understand your

employer better; why s/he expects certain things from  you, her/his reasoning

behind certain acts, and overall, help you to improve your working

relationship with her/him.  The possibilities are as endless as your

imagination is fertile.   How do you go about developing your clairaudient

faculties in relation to psychometry?


To begin, let's look at the area of self-preparation.  You are going to see a

trend  developing through self-preparation.  As in the use of the Night

Magician's Pendulum and  Crystal Globe, you again need a clean body and hands,

and a sound and tranquil state of  mind.  In review, I stated in topic

thirty-two, "Power of Thought", that in all the exercises  used to strengthen

and train the mind, meditation was very important.  Hopefully, you can  see

the reason for this and have been practicing it.  Meditation builds for you a

tranquil  mind.  If you have not been doing it, regularly, then get to it

without fail.  If you expect to  achieve anything in the Night Magick, it must

be done through a strong and tranquil mind.   So much for self-preparation,

now on to the mechanics of psychometry.


Hopefully, you have someone who is very sympathetic towards your magick and

wishes to  see you succeed in it.  If so, get this person to pickup a smooth

stone, and take that stone  and wash it thoroughly, along with their hands.

Then holding the stone in her/his left  hand, allowing it to rest in their

open palm, ask them to concentrate on a single thought.   This thought should

be simple.  For example, thinking of the color red.  Have them  concentrate

for several minutes on this thought.  Then, s/he should wrap the stone in a

clean cloth and give it to you.  Then take the stone with you and retire to

your Magician's  Study. Now lie down, relax, place the Night Pillar around

you, do some Night Breathing, and  place the stone in your clean, left hand.

Let the stone rest in the palm of your open hand.   Now you must allow your

mind to be without thought and tranquil.  Do not try to  concentrate on the

stone. Just relax and allow your mind to drift on nothingness.  You  may or

may not feel a tingling in the palm of your hand.  What you should receive is

a  feeling or impression, in this case, the color red.  If not, then try

moving the stone to your  left temple and again relax.  If you do not receive

an impression do not be discouraged.  It  takes practice and perseverance to

succeed.  If you do not have someone who can help  you, then you can try

something else.  The next time you receive a letter or bill, before  you open

it, retire to your room and go through the same procedures as just outlined

above with the stone.  As you receive the impressions, record them and then

open the bill  or letter and see if you're right.  Remember, that many people

will touch the letter or bill  before it gets to you, and so their impressions

will also be on it.  This is psychometry.


You will receive impressions, feelings, or pictures from objects you touch.

As your clairaudient faculties develop through practice, you will be able to

see easier and much  more extensively into the depths of an object's history.

Practice and perseverance is the  key to mastery.  Not only in psychometry,

but in all things as they relate to a Night  Magician's life. Your next

subject is something which has long been talked about, and  yet not

understood.  You are going to learn to bridge the gap between your mind and

another.


38.  Telepathy 


We have all heard the old phrase, "you must be reading my mind". The other

person  seemed to know your thoughts in some way.  This ability to know

another's thoughts is  telepathy. Telepathy is the ability to be able to

transmit and/or receive thoughts from one  person to another.  You are going

to learn how to do this and some of the possible uses,  but first, you should

learn how telepathy works.


In order to understand how telepathy works, you need to go back and re-examine

the  workings of the brain.  The brain is an extraordinarily complex organ,

and its physical  workings are little understood.  What is known about it, and

the key to understanding how  telepathy works, is that in the brain's

functioning it generates electricity.  This electricity is  very fine and can

be measured upon an electroencephalograph (EEG). Your brain emits  high

frequency waves upon which thought is carried.  Your brain operates upon a

certain  frequency which is unique for each individual.  When you can attune

yourself to that  frequency generated by the brain's electrical functioning

then you can intercept and  comprehend another's thought waves.  As a radio

can receive radio waves when tuned to  the proper frequency, so can your brain

receive thought waves from another person when  properly attuned to them.

Occasionally, a person is telepathic to another, unknowingly,  because each is

very close in frequency to the other.  They seem to be able to know what  the

other is thinking constantly, and this is because of the close harmony between

their  personal frequencies.  Couples who have been married for sometime grow

close in  harmony and each becomes attuned to the other's thoughts.   You are

not limited, though,  to accidental telepathic reception.


You can learn to consciously tune in to anyone you desire. Thought wave

attunement is achieved through the opening of your crown Night Center.  Not

only are you able to tune  into other peoples' thoughts, but you are able to

begin receiving direct communication  with your Oversoul.  To begin this

awakening of your Crown Center, you must have begun  to reach some mastery

over the mental exercise in topic thirty-two.  You must be  achieving a strong

and tranquil mind.  If you are to practice telepathy, you are going to  need

someone who you can send thoughts to, and who will, in turn, transmit to you.

If you  have such a person, then at a certain designated time each of you is

going to retire to  your Magician's Study, dim the lights, and try to

eliminate all possible distractions.


One of you will have agreed, in advance, to be the transmitter and the other

the receiver. People generate thoughts constantly, but they do this in such a

scattered manner that the thought goes in all direction and carries little

effect.  You, though, are going to  concentrate and direct your thought

specifically at the receiver.  As the transmitter, you  will have prepared, in

advance, a simple message or symbol to transmit.  So lie down and  become very

relaxed.  You must place the Night Pillar around you and practice Night

Breathing for a few minutes.  You should have in your hand a picture of the

person you  are going to transmit to.  Spend a few moments thinking of this

person and all the things  that bring you both together.  Then for about five

to ten minutes, you will transmit the  message.  This completes the portion

for the transmitter.


As the receiver, you also will lie or sit down and become very relaxed.  Place

the Night  Pillar into action and practice Night Breathing for a few moments.

You will need a picture  of your transmitter and will be thinking of those

things that draw you together in harmony.   The you will allow your mind to

become still and without thought.  Just let go for about five  to ten minutes

and receive.  Sound easy?


It will become so if you practice and do not become easily discouraged.  After

you have completed this exercise, you will certainly want to call each other

and check the results.   Don't become upset, though, if it did not work.  Be

positive, know it works, and in a short  time, you will be able to do it, not

only with your friend, but with anyone you meet.  The  uses for telepathy are

numberless and important.


It would be great if you could transact business with another and know whether

you were getting a good deal or not.  You would always be able to stay in

touch with your friends  and know if there are ever any problems.  If you had

a friend who was ever in trouble or  danger, they could beam a thought to you,

for help, and you could go to them.  The  possible uses for telepathy are

endless.  Make the most of them.  As you continue to  develop your telepathic

abilities, and thus your seventh Night Center, the closer you will  become to

your Oversoul.


You have learned to use your mind for communication with other minds.  Next,

you will  learn to use your mind to travel in the Mental Realm.


39.  Mental Projection 


You will recall, in Night Projection, you traveled in the Astral Realm in your

Astral Body.   So you can conclude, in Mental Projection, you will travel in

the Mental Realm in your  Mental Body.  You can look upon Mental Projection as

the "flight of the mind".  It is with  your mind that you will see and visit

places, and find a universe open to your mental  explorations.  So let's begin

this topic with a short flight, and view one of the many places  that are open

before you.


Ten, nine, eight, seven, six, five, four, three, two, one...  and you have

lift-off.  You begin to climb through the sky, leaving the Earth far, far

behind, and enter the darkness of deep  space. You continue to travel at the

speed of thought passing by planets and stars in the  twinkle of an eye.  In

moments, you find yourself approaching the first planet in your  journey.  The

planet's side you approach is enveloped in the darkness of night. As you

approach it closer, you see, outlined in the light of a setting sun, a vast

beach and cliffs  upon which a great ocean touches, and whose waves gently

caress it.  Set in the side of  the cliffs is a great door which you know

leads to a vast city below the surface.  You,  mentally, beam a message asking

to enter, where upon the great door opens and you find  yourself moving

rapidly through a long, lighted tunnel. Inside, you find a great city

shrouded in the twilight of an artificial night. There are beautiful fountains

and statues  inside and buildings resembling those of Ancient Greece.  By some

unknown force, you  are now led away from this city beneath the surface and

find yourself leaving the planet  far behind, and once again, traveling

through space.  You soon approach your next  destination, which is a planet

that, at first, appears similar to the one you just left. As you  grow closer,

though, you see a culture much different then the last one.  Here, the culture

is very mechanized, and the citizenry live upon the surface.  The dwellings

are very rustic  and blend naturally with the bareness of the planet.  You

continue to watch with  fascination at the unique machinery and lifestyle of

the people.  You find, though, that you  are starting to grow weary and feel a

need to return to your origin.  So you return to your  body which you left far

behind on the planet Earth.  You think of your body, and its place  on Earth,

and the sensation of rapid movement, of flight, is upon you again.  Pinpoints

of  light and matter, again, whisk past you with incredible speed.  Then, you

feel the slowing  in movement, and the heaviness of your body, and ...Ten,

nine, eight, seven, six, five, four,  three, two, one.., you have arrived.  So

ends your short flight of the mind through time and  space.  Were you really

there?  Did you see the planets, buildings, and people?


The answer is a definite, Yes!  There is no place or time period that you

cannot visit in  Mind. You can visit anyplace on your planet or see anyone.

You can travel back into  time or go forward into the realm of possibilities.

As you have seen, you can travel to any  planet, of any star system, of any

galaxy.  You can even travel into the various planes of  the Magickal Realm.

The only restraints to your traveling is your own magickal  development.


Your own magickal development is the only limiting factor as to where you can

travel.   This applies to Night, as well as Mental Projection.  You are

allowed to see and visit  those things which have an equal or lower vibration

to your own.  For example, each  planet, in the universe, has a unique

magickal vibration.  In order for you to see and visit a  planet, your own

vibration must be equal or higher to it.  Otherwise, you will be prevented

from going there. Similarly, for you to visit a magickal level or plane, you

must have an  equal or higher vibration in relation to it.  Of course, the

solution to unlimited travel is a  personal magickal vibration that allows you

to go anywhere.  Although there will always  be magickal plateaus that you

must strive for, you can develop magickally so that you are  relatively

unrestricted in your magickal travels.  How do you develop magickally?


The answer has been before you all along.  You must follow the instruction

outlined in  this book.  If you follow these instructions, live by the Will of

your Oversoul within you,  then your magickal growth will be both rapid and

unending.  Being Magickal is not being  able to read minds or see in the Night

Magician's Crystal Globe, but is based on living as  the Oversoul on Earth.

Telepathy, crystal gazing, and all that you are studying, is  developing

within you the necessary physical, emotional, mental, and magickal discipline

that will aid you in living as the Oversoul on Earth.  This, brings true

magickal growth that  will be with you forever and ever.


To practice Mental Projection, you must be physically fit and mentally sound.

Your mind must be in a state of peace and relaxation.  Your mind must be free

of tension and  worries and your body should be in good health, especially

your heart.  You do not have  to wait for truly advance magickal growth in

order to start traveling mentally.  The only  thing, as said before, is that

your magickal development will limit those places that you  can visit.  As you

continue to travel and grow magickally so will the places that you can  visit

grow in clarity, beauty, and magick.  The "how-to" of Mental Projection is not

that  difficult. You must enter your Magician's Study and extinguish all light

in the room.  The room  should be in almost total darkness.  Then, you should

be seated or lying down in a very  comfortable and relaxed manner.  You must

place the Magician's Night Pillar around  yourself and begin Night Breathing.

You must achieve a very relaxed and calm state of  body and mind.  Once you

have reached this state, you are ready to take flight with your  mind. In

Mental Projection, unlike Night Projection, you are not going to project a

body in  which your consciousness is going to travel. In Mental Projection,

only your  consciousness is going to be projected forth. Remember, your Mental

Body is your  consciousness.  In Night Projection, you projected forth your

Astral Body from your  physical body, and in that Astral Body you placed your

consciousness.  In Mental  Projection, all visual and emotional sensation will

center around the forehead of your  physical body.  It is from here, that you

will project your formless Mental energies or  consciousness.


To start with, you must visualize in your mind the place, person, and/or thing

you wish to visit.  Once you have in mind where you want to travel to, then

you should imagine your  mind doing the traveling and actually going there.

See your formless Mental energies  going forth to discover and see in the

Mental Realm. You will feel your consciousness  starting to travel forth into

the Mental Realm.  You will have visual impressions of your  surroundings

passing you by, just as if you were traveling in an airplane, only much

faster.  Then you'll begin to truly see your destination.


In the beginning, your visual images may be hazy and faint.  But as you

practice, the  images will become clearer and take on color.  While Mental

Projecting, if you want to go  somewhere else then where you're currently

visiting, all you have to do is concentrate on  the place you want to be, and

with the speed of thought you will be there.  Where your  thoughts are, there

you will be too.  In no way, should you force Mental Projection.   When you

project, it must be from the area of the forehead.  If you feel a swaying

sensation from your entire body, then you are starting to project the Astral

Body, rather  then the Mental Body. Your conscious projection of the Mental

Body must be from the  forehead.  You must center your conscious efforts to

project from the area of the head.   You should definitely know that it is

your mind body that you do travel and see through.   You are actually present

in your Mental Body and can send magickal healing and power  through it to any

person, place, or thing as you feel the need.  When you are ready to  return,

you should do so slowly and easily.  You should see yourself returning the

same way you went. As you begin to feel your physical body again, for while in

traveling you will forget it, move  the fingers and hands slowly. Next, you

will concentrate on your breathing, and you will  find the need to take a deep

breath, for while traveling, your breathing has become very  slow and shallow.

In all, return very slowly and you will prevent any harm to yourself, for

returning too quickly can cause headaches and an "out-of-sorts" feeling.

Mind Traveling is your key to unlimited new discoveries in life. You can visit

and stay in  touch with friends and love ones far away.  You can see cities,

great libraries, countries,  and places untold.  You can go into space and

discover new worlds and civilizations.   Your past and future are open to your

exploration. You can even explore the Magickal  Realms and see the Magickal

Leaders and Teachers of the world.  At first, go easy in  learning to use your

mind to travel with.  You must practice and be patient and the results  are

assured.  Remember, Mental Projection is your means to worlds untold; the

passport  is your own magickal development.  You have finally reached the

topic that you waited so  patiently for.  So without further delay, let's

learn how to create the world around and  within you that you desire to have.


40.  Creative Visualization 


The Magick of Creative Visualization is awesome.  There is absolutely nothing

you cannot create into your world through Creative Visualization.  There are

examples of people who  used the power of Creative Visualization throughout

history.  Look at the lives of Albert  Einstein, Thomas Edison, and Leonardo

Da Vinci.  Look at the lives of Mozart, Beethoven,  and Wagner. In all these

lives and thousands more like them, they used their minds and  a vision they

held in their minds and created and changed the world.  They created

intuitively.  You too can become like them by knowing how its done and then

using it.  The  whole process is known as Creative Visualization.


Through this process, you will be able to create for yourself and others

anything that you desire.  Remember always to create within the laws of the

Eternal Night Balance and the  Silver Rule. As long as you follow these two

principles there is absolutely nothing you  cannot create into your world

through Creative Visualization.  The process of Creative  Visualization is

broken down into two basic parts, a.) Imagination and b.) Invocation. The

process ends with the final results of c.) Materialization. So without further

delay, let's  begin with imagination.


a.  Imagination


Imagination is a product of your mind.  It is the ability of your mind to be

able to visualize, picture, envision, or imagine situations and things.  As a

kid, you used your imagination in playing house.  You imagined yourself as

either the father or mother and your toy dolls as  your children.  Your house

was a big box that you got from the local appliance dealer that  once

contained a refrigerator or stove.  Or remember the time you laid down on the

soft,  cool, green grass and looked up at the big, fluffy, white clouds on a

warm summer day  and imagined what this cloud or that looked like.  Some

looked like big elephants or dogs  and others looked like planes.  Remember?

This is your imagination at work.


As an adult, you constantly use your imagination to imagine what an interview

is going to  be like with the new boss, or what an appointment with the

dentist is going to feel like.  If  you have a birthday coming up, you try to

imagine what gifts are going to be given to you  and who will send cards.  You

constantly employ your imagination in your life.  Your  imagination is a very

powerful force in your life.  In fact, your imagination is the most  powerful

force in your life today.  Disagree?


Well if you do, then let's look at some examples.  Many will say that your

will is the  strongest force in your life but this can be easily disproved.

In any contest between the  will and the imagination, the imagination always

wins.  For example, let's take a catwalk  high above the factory floor.  The

catwalk is only two feet wide and there are guard rails at  waist height

running the fifty foot length.  Can you cross it in safety and ease? Sure, for

you have the added safety measure of the guard rails. Now, let's take away the

guard  rails.  Has your ease in crossing changed any?  The catwalk is still

quite wide enough to  cross with ease but when you take away the guard rails,

your imagination starts to go to  work.  You look at the long drop below and

without the rails, you start to imagine what  would happen if you slip.  It

will be hard to convince your imagination that you can cross  without any

danger.  You find that you are truly scared at walking on a two-foot wide

catwalk suspended one hundred feet in the air.  If you attempt to force your

will over your  self, this will only create more tension, and begin to cause

your body to shake and sweat  to appear on your forehead, and you will be

totally unable to cross.  Your imagination  wins.  Another example of how your

imagination has been used as a powerful force in  your life is the fear that

many people have of a place called Hell.


Churches have long used the idea of Hell to keep people in line. In your

imagination, you believe that if you are not good and do exactly what the

church says, you will pay for it by  going to a very, very hot, sulfurous,

brimstone place, and there suffer eternal torment.  If  you truly believe this

and have convinced your imagination of this, then you will not do  any wrong

if possible.  Your imagination is even stronger then the sexual forces in your

life.


It is in your imagination that a particular type of man or woman is attractive

to you. Imagination must come first before the sexual forces can be activated.

So, your  imagination is dominant even over your love life.  As you have just

seen in these  examples presented here, and many more that come to mind, the

imagination is a very  powerful force.  Whatever you imagine to be true in

your life, your imagination will insure  that it is so in your life.  If you

feel that an unsupported walk will be very dangerous, then  your imagination

will conjure up the most dismal of pictures in your mind's eye, of you  lying

broken up on the floor far, far below. The idea, then, is to learn to use your

imagination constructively.  You must learn how to manipulate your imagination

to  achieve materialization.  With your imagination, you are going to learn to

imagine  whatever it is that you desire to happen.


To begin with, you should have by this time become quite proficient at

visualization.  The hows of this was discussed in topic thirty-two, exercise

four.  If you haven't been doing  this exercise, then refer back to it and

begin doing so at once until proficiency is obtained. Whatever it is that you

want to happen, you must first be able to visualize it.  Once you  have

visualized it clearly in your mind's eye, then you must continue to add to the

visualization using your imagination and give it substance. Let's begin with

an easy  example.


You want to create an apple.  First, you would have already visualized the

apple itself.   You have pictured, in your mind, a bright, beautiful apple.

Then with your imagination,  you will continue to add substance to it by

adding the color to its skin. Now, you have a  bright, beautiful, red apple.

Then you will, in your imagination, see the insides of the  apple, and how

beautifully yellow they are.  Then, go on remembering how delicious and  sweet

they taste, and even how fragrant it smells. In your imagination, hold this

total  picture of a bright, red, yellowish insides, sweet tasting and smelling

apple.  This is how  you will use your imagination in Creative Visualization.

But you don't have the apple yet,  do you?  You need something more then just

your imagination alone.  You need the  added ingredient of Invocation.


b.  Invocation 


You are probably asking yourself what I mean by Invocation.  The very meaning

of the  word tells you what is required next. Invocation is the act of calling

upon a deity or higher  power for aid in accomplishing something.  In Night

Magick you are going to invoke the  aid of your Oversoul to complete the act

of Creative Visualization.  It is your Oversoul who  answers your invocation.

The Oversoul places into your world those things you desire to  see in it.

There are no limitations placed upon what invocation can do when combined

with visualization and imagination.  None! How do you invoke so that your

Oversoul will  answer with action? First, you must have the attention of your

Oversoul.  If you have been practicing meditation with dedication and

sincerity, then you will have been slowly opening the Crown Night  Center or

your Portal to your Oversoul.  In your practice of meditation and Night Magick

overall, you have been practicing a way of life that raises your magickal

vibration and that  of your Oversoul, too. When you dedicate yourself to this

magickal way of life, your  Oversoul then becomes directly involved in your

magickal growth. So, since you have  been practicing meditation all along, you

know that your Oversoul is listening.  To begin  your invocation then, you

must establish that communications link with your Oversoul.  You can do this

standing, sitting, or lying down, whichever you are most comfortable with.

Then, you will put the Night Pillar around yourself.  You will need to use

your imagination  and see yourself as the Living Oversoul.  Envision yourself

dressed in a seamless, black  garment glowing in intense magickal radiation.

You must see yourself as you would  imagine your Oversoul must seem in Its

Realm. That is, as an embodiment of Power and  Glory unknown on Earth.  You

must go beyond just imagining yourself as the Oversoul on  Earth.  You must

know that you are the Oversoul. That if you raise your vibration high  enough,

and know that you are the Oversoul, then your Oversoul will join you on Earth

and  will work with, and through you.  At this point, you will start to feel

an increase in heart  rate and exhilaration unknown to you before.  Through

this, you will know your Oversoul is  listening and is with you.  Even if you

don't feel this exhilaration, be assured, that your  Oversoul is with you.

Then you can say your invocation to your Oversoul. There is a  certain way

that the invocation should he said.  This is not like a typical prayer that

you  have been taught how to say.  Your invocation is more a command and

affirmation.  The invocation should be based on the following example:

"Darkest Oversoul which I AM, send your Yin Light and Energy through me.  For

I AM the Oversoul in Action here on Earth and  live by Your Will alone.  I AM

commanding as Oversoul in Action here on Earth that your  request be done.  By

the Oversoul's Will let it be done.  So be it."  You should repeat this

invocation three times.  If you do this with all sincerity and knowing that it

will be done,  then it will be done. The result of this invocation and your

use of imagination is defined as  Materialization.


c.  Materialization 


What is materialization?  Materialization is the bringing forth into material

or physical existence your desires.  This is the ultimate goal of Creative

Visualization.  You want to  bring into the material world your ideals.  Can

you achieve this materialization through  invocation alone?  No, you must have

the combination of imagination and invocation  together.  One question that

may come to your mind is where the apple, or anything that  you are trying to

create, materializing from?


When I speak of using your imagination to form the image of what it is you

want, you are  also using concentrated thought.  You are building this image

first on the Mental Realm.   As you continue the imaginative process, you

continue to fill the image with your emotions  or feelings about what it is

and like to have.  Thus, you continue to build it, and so, lower  it into the

Astral Realm. The object is actually materializing on both the Mental and

Astral  planes.  Then, you employ your power of invocation, building or

materializing it on both  the Magickal and the Etheric planes.  In the

materialization of objects, this form, made up  of condensed energy, will

create the necessary events in order to manifest into your or  another's

world, depending on what it is you are trying to achieve.  If you are of

advanced  magickal development, with a need of the object immediately, then

physical matter will  start to form around the energy form until you have the

final material product.  With your  imagination and invocation, you are

programming the energy form to materialize. The  energy form will do whatever

is necessary to bring about the creation.  Let's return beck to  the apple you

were trying to materialize, and see the whole process through.


Remember, you were imagining a bright, red, yellowish insides, sweet tasting

and  smelling apple.  You had used your imagination to such a point that you

could almost  smell and taste that apple. At that moment, you would go on to

use invocation.  You now  see yourself as the Oversoul on Earth.  You truly

feel Its Power and Energy descend upon  you and know that you are One.  Now,

you would insert in your invocation the image of  your apple.  From this, you

would have your apple.  Is the apple going to be right there in  front of you,

after you do all of this? That depends on you and your magickal development.

If you have reached the state of  Night Consciousness, then YES, the apple

will be there in front of you.  For in Night  Consciousness, you and the

Oversoul are One.  There is perfect communion and  cooperation in all things.

In lesser magickal development, the apple would have been  there, but only as

low as the etherial state.  But, what is in the etherial state of

materialization will eventually have its material existence fulfilled.

Somehow, and  eventually, that bright, red apple will come into your life.

Food is not the only thing that  you can materialize.


There is no limit on the physical objects that you can materialize into your

life, but more importantly, there is no limit to the physical happenings that

you can cause to exist.  By physical happenings, I am referring to events or

changes to occur in your or another's life.   For example, you may want to

become more like one of the Night Teachers.  You would,  then, first activate

your imagination and begin to build the image of the Teacher you  would like

to become more like.  Think of all the qualities and attributes held by that

Teacher.  What they look like? What mannerisms?  Build the image very strong

and then  you will slowly start to see yourself taking on these magickal

qualities.  You should then  bring in your invocation. You will ask your

Oversoul to build within you, the qualities  found in the Teacher.  You should

then continue this visualization over a long period of  time.  In other words,

you must practice this visualization process many times, over a long  period

of time, in order to become fully like the Teacher.  There is no way of

knowing how  long it will take to acquire these qualities.  But as each day

goes by, you will become  more and more like your Night Teacher.  The change

will hardly be perceptible to you, but  change you will.  You can help build

these qualities into other people.  You can  materialize in anyone, anything,

through your imagination and invocation. Through  Creative Visualization, you

could achieve unlimited supply of the things you need on Earth  and the Soul

qualities you need in life to reach Night Consciousness.  You have traveled to

the end of your journey in Air Magick.


You began it, by visiting the dimension where the Great Ones live and bring

into mental creation, what will soon thereafter become a physical discovery

and invention.  You have  long been convinced, by now, of the great power of

your thoughts, and the even greater  power of your Friend, the Silent

Magician.  You have learned to bring improvements into  your life through

self- hypnosis.  You have acquired new Night Magician Tools such as the

Pendulum and Crystal Globe.  You have learned to travel to anywhere, at

anytime,  through Mental Projection, and to invoke or communicate with your

Oversoul.  Best of all,  you have learned to control the world around you and

create as the Oversoul through  Creative Visualization.  You have come a long

way on the road of Night Magick, but the  road stretches out before you a bit

farther.  You find yourself journeying on the last part of  the Night Road and

entering the Night Realm.


CHAPTER  VII



Night (Fire) Magick


41.  The Night (Fire) Realm


Fire was the fourth element held sacred by the Ancient Magicians. Fire

represents a  Magickal Energy that transforms the lower nature into the

Magickal.  It was used in  Magickal Alchemy to represent the transmuting agent

necessary to change ordinary  metals or souls, into silver or the Oversoul.

It is symbolic of the Oversoul and the Night  Forces, pouring forth into the

life of the Night Magician, changing the base elements into  the Silver of the

Oversoul.  This is the final realm into which you will enter for exploration.

It is the Realm of Magickal and Celestial Energies.  In this topic, you will

explore the  Night Realm, as the Land of the Perfected Night Magician.  You

will learn of the different  vibrational levels of the Night Realm.  You will,

then, enter the Inner Night Realm found  within you; and the purpose of this

chapter on Night Magick.  If you are ready, let's  discover the Night Realm.


This is a realm, that for many, even a glimpse of it is still far down the

road.  It is a realm  of pure Night Power and Energy.  It is a Realm of Pure

Night.  The beauty of this realm,  words can not describe.  I made an attempt

earlier in the book to describe this realm, and  could not even come close in

describing the Power and Energy found in this world.  If, in  your highest

magickal imagination, you could envision a Magickal Realm of dazzling,

silver, violet, and dark light, that fills every part of your being with a

warmth and power  beyond description, then you would have some idea of the

Night Realm.  If you could  imagine a power that flows through you, giving to

you knowledge and wisdom beyond  anything you know; to know yourself as

timeless and eternal; then you would know the  Night Realm.  In the Night

Realm, you would see each other as radiating Spheres of  Eternal Night Energy,

outshining even your surroundings.  As has been said before, you  must strive

to reach this realm, for it is only then, when you see and experience it

yourself, will you truly know the Night Realm.  The Night Realm is divided

into numerous  vibrational levels.


Each level is the home for Beings of compatible harmony and vibration.  The

Night Realm  can be viewed as having basically two major levels.  The higher

region, I will refer to as  the Celestial Night, and the lower as the Magickal

Night.


The Celestial Night is the home, so to speak, of the Night Spirit.  It is the

region of the  Night Spirit Power and Energy. Beyond this, very little can be

said about this region.  The  concepts that make up this region go well beyond

your understanding.  Perhaps it is here,  that I should discuss the concept of

dimensions.


Referring back to the Astral Realm, you will remember that when you are in it,

that you  could do a great deal of things that you could not do on Earth.  You

could float in the air,  conjure up a four course meal, build a house by

thought, and could return to the lower  level of Earth.  In your Astral Body,

you could go through Earthly walls and not be seen by  people still in an

Earthly Body.  On Earth, you often refer to the physical plane as the third

dimension, and you could, therefore, refer to the Astral Realm as the fourth.

If you go to  the next dimension, that is the fifth, you would have an even

greater range of abilities and  be governed by totally different concepts then

those of the lower dimensions.  With each  higher dimension, the concepts that

apply become more abstract and less  understandable by those in lower

dimensions.  This is why the Celestial Region is far  beyond your

understanding.  This region could be viewed as the twentieth or fiftieth

dimension.  It is well beyond comprehension.  Then, there is the Magickal

Region.


You could view it as the ninth or tenth dimension.  So again, understanding of

its  composition and concepts is well beyond you. You do know that it is the

home of your  Oversoul.  It is the place you know as the Realm of the

Perfected Night Magician.  It is the  region of Magickal Wisdom.  It is here

that all ideas and prototypes are fixed and  released into the lower

dimensions below and become manifest on each level.  This is the  dimension

where you find the Causal Body.


The Magickal Region holds the vehicle through which you enter your Inner Night

Realm.   You enter the Inner Night Realm through your Causal Body.  Your

magickal nature is  found summed in the Causal Body.  All that you have ever

done has gone into molding the  Causal Body.  The Causal Body is as inert and

undeveloped as any other Body or vehicle  in which you have had to find

expression here on Earth.  All that you have ever done, has  gone towards

refining the Causal or Magickal Body.  You could liken the Causal Body to a

treasure chest.  It is here, that you store your Magickal Silver.  Your

Magickal Silver  consisting of all the accomplishments and growth you have

ever acquired while in  existence.  It is these things which activate and

quicken the Magickal Body.  It is through  this Magickal Vehicle, that you are

joined in Oneness with your Oversoul.  It is the  Oversoul's Magickal Body, as

well as yours. This is why I have stressed to give so much  energy to Night

Magick.  This is why I have stressed, so much, on the things that you must  do

to grow magickally.  When the Causal Body is perfected then you join the

Oversoul in  Perfection and Energy.  Then, you reach up and into the

Consciousness of your Night  Soul.  This is why I have presented this chapter

on Fire or Night Magick.


Through the practice of the information, exercises, and rites found in this

chapter, you will greatly enhance the development of your Causal Body.

Through hard effort, dedication, perseverance, and patience, you can achieve

perfection of the Magickal Body.  You will  expand, refine, and fully develop

your Magickal Body and the perfection of your Inner  Nature.  All that you

will do, in this chapter, will directly effect your Oversoul. S/He will be

your active Partner and Friend in your life.  You will learn to give and apply

magickal  healing direct from the Oversoul within.  You will learn the Night

Rites, which will directly  bring power and energy into your Inner Being and

the world around you.  You will learn  how to use the Night Powers and Flames,

and the great changes that you can bring into  the world through them.  There

are other subjects that you will explore, and that will bring  knowledge and

wisdom into your life from their study.  This is your final chapter and will,

perhaps, open up before you knowledge and power never before encountered.

Remember, that in all you learn and practice, you must remain in the Energy

and Will of  your Oversoul.


Even though this is the final chapter, and you may have been sailing along in

your  education in Night Magick, and passing all the tests, remember, that

your study and  progress goes on forever into eternity.  You will never stop

learning and growing in Night  Magick.  Beyond this Earthly life, there is so

much that awaits before you.  So, practice  Night Magick with dedication and

perseverance and remain victorious on the road of Night  Magick. Your first

subject for discussion, in Fire Magick, is the Great Magickal Beings  who are

the Citizenry of the Magickal and Material Universe.


42.  The Solar, Planetary, and Lunar Powers   


It may come as a shock to you, but the Stars, Planets, and Moons that you look

upon  every day and night are indeed Great Magickal Entities.  Descending from

out of the  Celestial Realm, they have chosen to incarnate into the Stars,

Planets and Moons.  Their  magickal path is one of many advanced magickal

paths, but it is a very important path.  It  is important, especially in

regards to you, for it provides places upon which lesser souls  may find

development and magickal advancement.  Humans are not, by any means, the  only

race in the universe.  The Stars, Planets and Moons are, indeed, Conscious,

Sentient  Beings, each with their own personal natures.  Under this topic, I

am going to discuss  each of these Inner Natures.  I will begin with a

discussion of the Solar Life.  I will then  discuss the Planetary and Lunar

God/Goddesses, in general, and then discuss,  specifically, the Inner Natures

of each.  Along with discussing their Inner Natures, I will  also talk about

the auric effect of each, upon you.  If you are ready, then let's proceed to

the Solar Force.


The visible Stars are inhabited by advanced beings following the Yang path of

development. There is no doubt that physically we need the Sun in order to

provide  physical heat and act as a physical source for the positive solar

energy needed by living  things on Earth.  As a Night Magician you will become

very sensitive to solar energy.  As  your depth in the Night proceeds you will

need less and less of the solar energy.  You  want to be very careful not to

receive too much sunlight and so become overcharged with  solar force.  This

will definitely harm your magickal workings.  I have been to places  where the

Night Force was so strong that it acted much like a polarized lens and

filtered  the harmful energy of the Sun from me.  But these places are few and

far between.  If you  wrap yourself tightly in your Night Pillar then you will

greatly minimize the harmful effects  of the Sun.


Within this system though because it is a Yin system there is also the Dark

Sun.  It is also called the Black Sun.  The Black Sun absorbs too much Yang

Energy and moves it to  another time and place that is a Yang system.  The

Black Sun is the source of all Yin  Energy in this Dark Solar System.  It is

the Parent Force to the Planetary and Lunar  Deities.  Let's examine this

parenthood some more.


You will remember that every human being receives its Oversoul and Godsoul

from a part  of the great whole which is the Earth Goddess/God's Oversoul and

Godsoul.  In similar  manner, the Planetary and Lunar Deities receive their

Oversoul and Godsoul from the  Dark Sun.  So we have the Dark Sun as the sum

of the whole, who then divides Its Eternal  Self into smaller pieces who are

the Planetary and Lunar Deities, and they in turn divide  their sum into

individual sparks which become encased in the material world.  The Ancients

knew, thou enshrouded in myth, that the Planets and Moons are the physical

vehicles of very advanced beings.  You are familiar with your own physical

body and the  other vehicles that make up your material being.  You also know

that you have an aura  that is charged with emotions and thoughts.  When you

meet someone in the office, for  example, and come within range of their aura,

you often sense things about that person.   If they are feeling uplifted, or

angry and depressed, you can sense that about the person.   You also have

found that if you permit it, their aura may induce these same feelings in

you.  This is somewhat similar when we speak about the Planetary and Moon

Spirits  having bodies.


They do have bodies, and along with that, they also have an aura that is

supercharged  with emotions and thoughts that reflect the Inner Nature of

their Being.  Their bodies are  enormous and so are their auras.  Thus, the

effect of these auras is far reaching.  Yet, I  want to say this: Humankind

are foolish creatures when they allow the Stars, Planets, or  Moons to rule

their destiny.  The effect of Their Auras may heighten the highest qualities

in humankind but they do not rule humankind's destiny.  Your destiny is in

your own  hands and the Hands of Your Oversoul.  Remember this.  Now what

effects do these Great  Ones have upon you.


When the Dark Sun runs strong through you, you find yourself filled with

vitality and  health. You are ambitious, proud, strong willed, and face life

with great courage.  You  have a very strong and stable personality.  You have

a great drive and zest for life.  You  are a very independent and confidant

soul.  You are generally quick witted, perceptive,  thoughtful, and

considerate.  These are the things that the Dark Sun can bring out in you.

You will soon learn how to increase the power of the Dark Sun that runs

through your  veins.  You will learn how to do this through the Night Rites.

The Dark Sun does run  through everyone, to some degree, but can be greatly

intensified by practicing the Night  Rites.



From the Dark Sun we proceed onward with the Planetary and Lunar Spirits.  The

first-born Children of the Father-Mother Dark Sun are the Planetary and Lunar

Night Powers.   Each Night Power has elected to incarnate into a planetary or

lunar physical body. They  serve the noble purpose of giving a home to

countless souls. They serve as Father,  Mother, and Guardian to all the souls

incarnate thereon.  They are beautiful, Magickal  Beings of the Night Spirit's

Power.  They all embody the Energy of the Night Soul.  They  all serve to help

the progress and advancement of lesser souls.  Think about this; you only

live a span of generally less then one hundred years, but they live a life

that is many  billions of years long!  Thus, you should recognize them for

what they are, and give them  your energy as best you can. Each Planetary and

Lunar Night Power has followed a  separate and unique magickal evolution,

which is ever ongoing, just as you have.  The  only thing is, that they have

been at it a lot longer then you have.  You find that, just as  you are strong

in certain inner traits and qualities, so the Planetary and Lunar Night

Beings are.  They have embodied certain magickal qualities and forces from

their  magickal growth and advancement.  These forces and qualities make up

their Inner  Nature and are reflected in Their Auras.  There is a science that

is based upon the interplay of these forces, and others, on humankind.  It is

called Astrology.  It is based  upon many factors and is a very real science.

What you are going to do is study the Inner  Nature of each Planetary and

Lunar Night Spirit, and then the Auric effect of that Night  Spirit, on you,

when it plays upon you (or others) the strongest.  You will begin with the

Night Spirit Mercury.


Perhaps, it is here, that I should interject this bit of information.  The

names of the Lunar  and Planetary Night Spirits are prefixed with the word

Night God or Goddess.  This is so,  whenever you refer to them as Magickal

Beings in speech, or addressing them in  meditation.  Although each Lunar and

Planetary Spirit contains a Yin and Yang side their  is one aspect that is

predominate just as there is in you.  Let's return now to the Night  God

Mercury.


Mercury has always been represented as the winged god messenger. You can,

indeed,  think of Mercury as the Winged Night Spirit, in the form of a

beautiful Silver Hawk.  The  Hawk is the symbol of great magickal attainment,

and the Night God Mercury has reached  those lofty heights of the Planetary

Oversoul.  His very core of Being is filled with Night  Energy.  His Presence

is filled with Oversoul Strength and the Night Power.  Yet, His  Nature is

that of a very warm Being.  He stands as the Rock of the Oversoul upon whom

all may build their lives in confidence.  He is sure of His Place in the Drama

of Life.  His  Aura radiates with the Power of the Night Command and

Direction.  Thus, He fills your life  with Night Direction when you are open

to His Influence.  When you are attuned to His  Presence and Power, you are

filled with the Presence of Oversoul.  You find inner  freedom and

independence in yourself as the Magickal Hawk.   You find yourself as a

seeker of Wisdom, wherever It may be.  His Presence quickens your mental

faculties and  gives you good memory.  You enjoy the pursuit of Wisdom in

reading and writing.  His  Aura makes you perceptive, studious, and logical.

You can be a strong leader in life.   This is the Power of the Night God

Mercury in your life.  From the Night Spirit Mercury, you travel to visit with

the Night Goddess Venus.


Venus is a Night Planetary Goddess who is very Warm, Vibrant, and Alive with

the Night Energy.  She is filled with the Energy of the Oversoul and the Night

Spirit, which She  radiates in Her Aura to all beings.  If you were to

visualize Her Presence, you would see  Her attired in a flowing, red gown.

She has beautiful green eyes, skin that is pale and  soft, and Her hair is

long, flowing, and red in color.  You find Her a bit Reserved and  Mysterious

in Nature.  She is filled with the deepest of Compassion for others. You know

Her as the Morning Star, the last to say good-bye.  When you bathe in the

Presence of  Her Aura, your Inner Nature becomes filled with Energy.  She

fills you with a vibrancy and  warmth for life.  She gives to you an artistic

nature and an energy for beauty, art, and  music.  You become a part of Her

Compassion for all of life. You enjoy being with other  people and spreading

harmony, peace, and happiness among them. This is the Power of  the Goddess

Venus in your life.  From here, you move to the next Goddess, and One  whom

you call Mother, the Earth.


The Presence of Mother Earth is a very Commanding One.  She has a very strong

sense of Direction and Purpose in Her Life.  Yet, you find Her a very

Compassionate and Loving Creature.  If you could envision Her Presence, you

would find Her arrayed in a beautiful, emerald green gown and shimmering in

the Glory of the Night Spirit's Light.  She is a very Magickal and Elegant

Lady.  She is very much concerned with life and nature.  When  filled with the

Presence of Her Nature, you, too, become filled with a concern for life and

nature.  You sense the great importance all life and nature plays in your

world.  You feel  very earthy and strong in the ways of the Earth.  You become

a part of Her Direction and  Purpose in Life.  You become filled with Her

Compassion and Concern for all things  living.  You know the feeling of true

parenthood, just as She does for all of you.  This is  your Mother and Night

Goddess, Earth. You won't have to go far to meet your next Lunar  Night

Goddess, the Moon.


She has been known as Diana, or Artemis, the Goddess of Light and the Moon.

She has  been recognized as the Goddess of Fertility. The Moon's Light comes

from sun light but  she reflects to the Earth only Yin Light.  She is the

Great Reflector of the Yin Light into  your world.  She is the Giant Mirror

through which humankind can see their selves  reflected.  Thus, She is All-

seeing of the wrong and harm that is done to the beautiful body  of the

Goddess Earth.  As you meditate upon Her Presence, you see only the All-seeing

Eye and the tears that are shed for humankind.  The Goddess Diana is a very

Compassionate and Loving Being, who has constantly seen the wrong and harm

caused  by humankind.  Thus, She is filled with a Great Sadness over humankind

and its doings.   When you come strongly under Her Presence, you are filled

with a restlessness and  boundless energy to correct those wrongs.  She has

great control over your emotional  nature and can raise in you the highest of

qualities. She makes you sensitive and intuitive  to all things around you.

She fills you with great compassion.  She gives you a receptive  and

imaginative mind.  This is the outpouring of the Goddess Diana's Aura on you.

Now,  you are off to visit the Night God Mars.


Man has always envisioned the Night God Mars as a god of war. But the time has

passed,  when the Night God Mars may be referred to as such.  The Night God

Mars, as all the  Planetary Night Spirits, is a Great Being of the Night

Spirit and Energy.  The problem lies  with humankind itself.  The Energies of

Mars can either bring humankind to its Highest, or  lowest Self, dependent on

the Inner Nature of humankind.  Thus, the Energies have  always reacted

adversely with the human aura and created a state of war in humankind.   Where

Mars was, before, symbolized as a Hawk, now, He shall be symbolized as a Swan.

The Swan is a living symbol of the Oversoul in the Night Spirit.  The Night

God Mars is a  Masculine Night Spirit who is Young and Energetic.  He is Night

Courage and Strength.   He represents Victory in, and through, Peace.  He is

the Fighter and Defender of the Ways  of the Night Spirit.  He is a very Wise

and Noble Night Spirit.  He is a King in All Things.   His Aura can raise the

highest and noblest of qualities in humankind.


He fills you with a energy of liberty, freedom, and independence. He gives to

you an Inner Nature of Night Strength and Courage. You become filled with

inner purpose and  direction. You are filled with His Night Energy and thus,

are ambitious, aggressive, and  straightforward in all things.  You are given

a good mind that makes you ingenious and  inventive.  You are filled with the

Wisdom of the Night God Mars.  When you are filled  with His Night Energies,

you must always be centered in your Oversoul. You must guard  against a lack

of patience and rashness.  You must guard against an unruly temper.  You  must

always be filled with the Night Energy and Light, and thus raise the Energies

of the  Night God Mars to their Highest in you. You leave the Night Spirit

Mars, and move on to  the Goddess Jupiter. Perhaps this will upset many, but

the Goddess Jupiter is predominately a Feminine Night Spirit.  She does have

strong Masculine overtones, but She is, nonetheless, a Feminine  Night Spirit.

If you could envision Her Presence, you would see Her with very long,

flowing, blond hair.  She wears a very radiant dress of blue light.  She is a

very Magickal  and Radiant Goddess. She is a virtual pool of Explosive Night

Energy.  She is always  ready to go; to be; to do.  She is filled with Night

Liberty, Freedom, Justice, and the  Eternal Night Balance.  She is symbolized

by a Blue Raven of Harmony and Peace.  She  is a very Refined and Elegant

Being.  She is very businesslike in all Her Ways.  She  brings to you this

businesslike attitude.


She fills you with a very real sense of purpose and direction. She gives you

strong  convictions. She give to you an optimistic, confidant, and determined

attitude.  When you  have the Power of the Goddess Jupiter flowing through

strongly, you are very sincere,  courteous, pleasant, and noble person.  You

are a very refined individual.  You value your  freedom and independence very

highly.  This is the Power of the Goddess Jupiter.  You  leave Her to visit

another of Her Sisters, the Goddess Saturn.


As you approach the Aura of the Goddess Saturn, you find Her Awesome,

Powerful, and Creative.  She is filled with Great Elegance and Grace.  She is

a very Mysterious the  Goddess of the Night and Power.  She is the Mistress of

Time and Space.   She is the  Taskmaster for those who would enter the Path

towards Night Consciousness.  She wears  the Silver Crown of the Oversoul, and

holds it for all who attain to the Oversoul.  She is a  very Stern Goddess,

who demands much from Her Sons and Daughters.  Yet, She is filled  with Great

Compassion and Energy.  Her Very Nature contains Night Tolerance, Patience,

and Fortitude.  She brings to all humankind the aspiration to attain unto the

Oversoul.


If Saturn's Aura rules in you then you are very calm, grave, and serious in

nature.  You are  one who is ready to face the trials and tests of life.  You

are ready for the great changes  and upsets to come into your life.  You are

ready, because you are one who strives to  become the Oversoul in all things.

There is no greater goal and crown to be won, from  the Hands of the Goddess

Saturn. You must take on the Goddess' Qualities of Tolerance,  Patience, and

Fortitude.  You must be ready for the long, slow climb towards Night

Consciousness, for indeed, with these Night Qualities inside yourself, you can

not fail.   These are the Powers of the Goddess Saturn, in the life of those

who would be the  Oversoul.  Let's go onward and meet the Night God Uranus.


The Inner World of the Night God Uranus is one related to the technology of

the world.   He is a very Strong-willed Night God. He has a great feeling for

the World of Technology.   He is very thorough in all He undertakes.  The

Power of His Aura is very far reaching, and  is felt strongly in the world

today.  He gives to those, who feel His Power, strong  originality and

independence of thought.  His Power gives the genius and inventor of the

world. The inventor is a lover of his freedom and independence.  As with all

geniuses and  inventors, there is a peculiarity or strangeness that tends to

set them apart from others.  It  makes them feel as if they are many years

ahead of their time.  The Night Spirit Uranus is  still very much wrapped up

in His Own Ways and Mysteries, and so it is with the next the  Night God

Neptune.


To look into the Inner Nature of the Night God Neptune is very much like

looking into the depths of the oceans.  His Inner Nature is extremely Deep and

Vast.  The Inner Depths of Neptune conceal many of the Ancient Mysteries that

are still to be revealed to humankind. The Night God Neptune is a very Refined

and Noble Planetary Night God.  He is filled to  the Depths with Night

Strength and Power.  He is symbolized by a Trident, with a Blazing  Silver

Light atop it.


He gives to you Inner Strength of Purpose and Direction.  He knows who you

are; why you  are; and where you're going.  He fills you with a sense of

Destiny and Purpose in Life.   His Aura fills you with His Night Strength.  He

gives to you an Energy for the Mysteries.   He makes you intuitive and

perceptive to the Night Force.  To those in whom the Power of  the Night God

Neptune flows strongest, He gives the Energy of the Seas and Oceans.  It is

best, for this one, to live close to large bodies of water.  This is the Power

of the Night God  Neptune.  Your last stop is to visit the Night Goddess/God

Pluto.   In the Night God Pluto, the Forces of Masculinity and Femininity are

in equal balance.   The Night God is neither more feminine or more masculine,

but finds a balance in both.   In the Night God Pluto, you find the Knowledge

of the Night.  S/he is filled with Night Life,  Light, and Speed.  S/he is the

Guardian of the Night Age.  S/he is the Harbinger of the Age  of the Eternal

Night. S/he is the First One to see and understand the New Horizons that lie

before humankind.  S/he is symbolized by the Equilateral Triangle ablaze in

Green Cold  Fire.  She is filled with a New Night Power for the Yin System and

it is called Cold Fire.  It  represents a new form of Night Power and

Strength, and when magickally invoked, feels  both cool and warm.  Its Power

has yet to be fully understood and used in this world.  The Night Goddess/God

Pluto represents, in humankind, the dying of the material concerns  and the

birth of the magickal way of life.   S/he will fill humankind with a new power

and  energy that will bring about new ways of life.  If the Powers of the

Night Goddess/God  Pluto flow strongest in you, you will find yourself

standing atop the Mountain of the Night  God, holding aloft the Blazing Night

Energy of Your Own Divinity.  In the Night  Goddess/God Pluto, you find the

New Human.  This is the Human of the Night Age, the  Aquarian Age, the return

to a Magickal Way of Life.


You found that Dark Stars, Planets, and Moons are Conscious, Sentient Beings

of the  Night Power and Energy.  You found that in some ways they differ as

much as humans  differ from each other. May you find in knowing the Planetary

Night Goddess/Gods and  the Goddess Diana, greater understanding about

yourself, your future, and your relation  to the Universe around you.  You

leave the Magickal-Material Universe of the Planetary  and Lunar Goddess/Gods

and enter into the Magickal Realm of the Night Teachers.


43.  The Night Guild 


You will recall, for a moment, that in the beginning of the book, I stated

then, while  discussing the Night Teachers, that I would return to them later

and go into greater depth  and detail. Therefore, I have donated this topic to

the in-depth examination of the Night  Teachers in their realm.  I discussed

earlier in the book, the realm in which they live.


You will remember that the Night Realm (Causal Realm) was the home of the

Perfected  Night Magician.  This is the region of the Night Teachers, the

Perfected Humankind.  Yet,  the Night Teachers also work and reside in the

lower dimensions.  You will recall that the  Night Guild is the organization

dedicated to the service of the Will of the Night Spirit.  It is  dedicated to

using the Power, Wisdom, and Energy of the Night Spirit in whatever way is

required to further promote that Will.  The membership of the Night Guild is

as vast and  varied as the stars that make up the Universe.  There are members

that work in Realms  and Spheres of Light and Energy far beyond your

imagination.  I spoke in the last topic, of  those members who are the Night

and Planetary Night Spirits.  These are the Great  Beings that are the Night

Spirit and Life of the planets and suns of the Dark Sun system.  There are

even Magickal Beings who are on an even higher magickal level then these

Great Ones.  What you will become the most familiar with, and your interest

lies with in  this topic, are those Great Ones who are the Night Teachers.


The Night Teachers, as you will remember, are those members who work directly

with the magickal evolution and progress of Earth and its inhabitants.  What

kind of Beings are  they really?  Well, they are in reality very much like

you.  They are like you because they  have walked the same roads that you

walk.  Many have lived before on Earth facing the  same trials and testings

you face each day.  They have lived many lives and finally  overcome the cycle

of life and death on Earth.  They are free of all Earthly karma.  They  are

the Elder Brothers and Sisters of Earth. In the Night Guild are the Invisible

Directors and Governors of the countries, states,  provinces, and large cities

on Earth. There is a Guild Member for each of these  geographical regions, and

a World Director over all of them and the planet.  The World  Director is

Germain.  His last incarnation on Earth was as the Comte de Sainte-Germain.

There are many other offices held within the Invisible Government.  I cannot

give you their  names nor regions that they rule over because they are too

busy dealing with the world  and its population and problems to actually

teach. You should not call upon the World  Director or any of his hierarchy.

They serve only the indwelling Night Presence of the  Planet and would find

any interruption or disturbance troubling. What does concern you is a branch

of the Invisible Government that does deal with you  directly.  This is the

office of the World Teacher. The office of World Teacher is currently held by

the Night Teacher Merlin.  It is His task  to plan the magickal education of

the inhabitants of Earth.  If it is necessary to establish a  new teaching

then one of their own members is selected to establish it.  The World  Teacher

may elect to go into the world or may select an apprentice to go.  This is

indeed  a great honor for the apprentice so selected.  The members of the

Night Guild who work  under the direction of the World Teacher are the Night

Teachers. You will recall that the  Night Teachers deal directly with those

who have traveled far enough on the Night Road  and truly want to become Night

Magicians.  Let's have a quick review of the relationship  between the Teacher

and apprentice.


You will remember that the initial contact between yourself and the Teacher is

very  minimal. This contact only comes about when you have been accepted on

the road of  Night Magick.  In time, and with self-perseverance, the

relationship between yourself and  the Night Teacher deepens, until you become

the Teacher's apprentice. Then you come  under Her/His direct supervision and

instruction. You become as Mother/Father and  Daughter/Son.  Yet, you ask

yourself the same question, who is your Night Teacher?


To answer this questions, leads you to the Seven Forces of Life. The Seven

Forces of Life  are the seven basic types of forces, characteristics, and

vibrations that can be found in  life.  There are seven basic types of people,

and within their Inner Nature, these Seven  Forces can be seen at work.  For

each type of person, there is one of the Forces that  strongly predominates

over the others.  The Seven Forces of Life are the seven  predominate ways

that a person may find expression in life.  In you, there is a  predominate

Force and characteristic that makes up your Inner Nature, and it is through

expression of this trait in life, that you find satisfaction and happiness.

You would even  find this true for the Night Teachers.  They find predominate

expression through one of  the Seven Forces of Life.  The Night Teachers have

achieved, though, perfection and  mastery in each of the Seven Forces, and

have the seven basic characteristics balanced  evenly within their Inner

Nature.  Yet you will find that One Force and characteristic is  predominate

over the others.  It is from this Dominant Force that the Night Teachers

choose Their students and apprentices.  The Night Teacher chooses Their

apprentice  based upon like vibration.  The Teacher and apprentice can be

found traveling the same  road of expression in life.  The Teacher and

apprentice are on One of the Seven Forces of  Life.   This is the predominate

Force and drive of their lives.   As I said earlier, there is a  Night Teacher

who is the Channel and Focus for each of the Seven Forces.  You will find  in

Her/Him the Supreme Perfection and Expression of the Force.  They are the

Gateway  for the Force from out of the Infinite, into the finite.  We will

call Her/Him the "Keeper of  the Force", and shorten it to "Keeper".  There

are seven Keepers, and they are each  Teachers of apprentices.  There are also

many Teachers who do not function as Keepers,  but nonetheless, receive

apprentices based upon the Force predominate in both their  lives.  The real

key, in the selection of the apprentice, is harmony between both the  Teacher

and the student.  Let's examine the Seven Forces of Life, and their Keepers,

and  then meet a few other Teachers of the Night Realm.  You will begin, then,

with the First  Force.


The First Force is the Will and Power of the Night Spirit.  You find it,

exemplified and  exalted, in the personage of its Keeper, Asmodeus.  The

Keeper Asmodeus is a Night  Teacher in whom flows the True Power of the Night

Spirit, under the Direction of the  Magickal Will.  He is a stern but kindly

Teacher, asking only the very best from His  apprentices.  If He were to

appear, in person, to an apprentice, He would appear in an  Indian attire,

that is, turban and robe complete.  To be His apprentice will require the

strongest of will to persevere through all trials and testings.  The

apprentice, in whom the First Force dominates, is a self-ruler.  The

apprentice prefers  to have self-rule and independence over their life.  The

worst thing, the apprentice feels  could happen is to have to work for

another.  This would be pure misery.  They are the  kind of individual, who

takes the initiative and sets the course.  They are of strong will and  the

ruler in life.  They will make the queen/king, statesperson, or governor of

the physical world.  They will seek freedom through mastery over self and the

world around them.  This  is the way of the Teachers and apprentices of the

First Force of Night Power and Will.


The Second Force is the Wisdom of the Night Spirit.  It finds a special place

in the Being  of its Keeper, Kali.  In appearance, to Her apprentices, She

appears as an Indian (India).   She is a very kind and loving Teacher.  She

helps bring to Her students, the perfect  example of Night Consciousness.  As

a Magickal Teacher, She tries to help Her students  grow in magick and expand

their Inner Vision, so that they can see things as She sees  them, and

understand things as She understands them, and above all, to have the  Wisdom

of the Night Spirit to respond to things as She would respond to them.  Her

expressed desire is to see Her apprentices take flight, on their own, into the

Night Realm,  and soar as the Great Magickal Owl.


The apprentice of the Second Force is the student of life.  They are the kind

of person who  will learn by studying all of life around them.  They will gain

their freedom from life and  death on Earth, by observing and learning from

all that goes on around them.  This is how  they will gain illumination and

enlightenment, and soar into the Night Realm.  They are  the philosopher and

poet.  These are the Teachers and apprentices of the Second Force  of Night

Wisdom.


The Third Force is the Energy of the Night Spirit.  There is no one, who could

better  embody this Force, then its Keeper, Baal. As a Magickal Teacher, He

seeks to impart to  His apprentices, an Energy that is unknown in the world.

An Energy that is purely and  wholly of the Night Spirit.  He teaches of an

Energy that is totally impartial and a balm to  heal all wounds.  His guidance

sets the apprentice free of any limitations.  He teaches the  apprentice to be

free of dependance upon another's judgment, and above all, another's  will.


The apprentice is the true disciple of the Night.  The apprentice gives their

all in energy to  the Night.  They see no differences in the races of

humankind but know them all as the  Children of the Night Spirit.  They are

totally devoted to bringing all the world back under  the Night Spirit. To

returning the world back to Yin.  This is the way of the Teachers and

apprentices in the Third Force of Night Energy.


The Fourth Force is the crossroad of the Night Forces of Life. You have seen

that the first  Three Forces, and the way that they are expressed in life, are

wholly that of the Night  Spirit.  They have their center of expression in the

Magickal.  As you will see shortly, the  last three have their expression and

unfoldment on the material plane.  The Fourth Force  is, therefore, referred

to as the Crossroad of the Night Forces.  It is the Force of Balance,

Dignity, and Purity.


This Force finds its expression through the Mighty Keeper, Lilith.  She is a

very stern  Teacher, but at the same time, has a very warm and loving sense of

humor.  She is very  demanding of Her apprentices to always do their best, and

pushes them hard in all they  do.  Under Her tutelage, the apprentice cannot

fail but to grow magickally.  Her Presence  is very powerful and noble, and

once She visits Her apprentices, they will never forget  Her.


The apprentice of the Fourth Force always tries to achieve balance in all they

undertake.   They are the excellent arbitrator.  They have the wonderful

ability to see all the sides of  an issue. The only problem, here, is that the

apprentice can be faced with indecision  because of this very ability.

Therefore, it is very necessary for the apprentice, no matter  the Life Force

they're on, to develop all of the Forces to the greatest degree of perfection

and balance possible.  The apprentice seeks freedom through the perfection and

purity of  their Inner Nature and the outer world.  It is their way, to

achieve perfection, through the  balance of both the magickal and physical

worlds.  This is the way of the Teachers and  apprentices in the Fourth Force

of Night Balance, Dignity, and Purity.


The Fifth Force is that of Knowledge.  The Keeper of the Fifth Force is Dagon.

This Force  finds itself in great expression throughout the world.  The Keeper

Dagon instructs the  apprentice in the ways of knowledge that are to be found

in the deep study of the ways  and laws of nature.   He teaches that it is

through the study of the Earth, and the learning  and understanding of its

concealed knowledge, that you as an apprentice can find your  Inner Freedom.

The Keeper Dagon is a mighty Teacher and whose ways follow very  closely to

those of Nature.  If you want to know more about His Nature, then you must

study that of the Earth's. The apprentice of the Fifth Force seeks to find

knowledge in the world.  The problem is  that many students become lost in the

seeming rigidity of Earth science.  The ordinary  person of this Force is your

scientist of today.  But, the apprentices of this Force must go  beyond what

seems the scientific knowledge of today.  They must study the ways of the

Earth and all of nature, and from that study will come their Inner Freedom and

Night  Consciousness.  This is the way of the Fifth Force and its Teachers and

apprentices.


The Sixth Force is the return to the Way of Energy.  The Sixth Force is that

of Devotion to  the Night Spirit.  This is a very powerful Force and is

embodied in its Keeper, Lucifer.  The  Keeper Lucifer teaches the Force of

Devotion to His apprentices. He brings into their  being the true and burning

feeling of Devotion to the Night Spirit.  He conveys, into their  world of

feeling, the devotion necessary to complete the journey to their Oversoul.  He

brings, to their Inner Vision, the energy and power that is behind everything

in the world of  nature and form.  He shows them the power and energy that is

behind all things, which is  the Night Spirit.  The Keeper Lucifer is a very

Radiant and Magnificent Being.  He is filled  with an Inner Yin Light and

Radiance that comes from the Exalted Devotion found within  Him. He is a very

patient Teacher as are all the Teachers of the Night.  The Keeper of the

Sixth Force has a true understanding of all His apprentices.


The devotion practiced by the apprentices allow them to find happiness in all

that  happens to them in life.  They except all that comes into their world

knowing that, whether  it seems good or bad at the time, that it is all for

their magickal growth. They have true  belief and trust in the Night Spirit.

They know that all their needs will be met through the  agency of the Night

Spirit. This is the Sixth Force of Devotion to the Night Spirit and its

Teachers and apprentices.


The Seventh Force is founded in creativeness through the Night Spirit.  The

Seventh Force  is the Beauty and Action of the Night Spirit.  This Force is

found in rare and exalted form  in its Keeper, Hecate.  The Keeper Hecate

imparts to Her apprentices the Energy and  Beauty that is found in all of the

Night Spirit's Creation.  She teaches them how to create  using the Power and

Will of the Night Spirit.  She makes of them Magickal Channels for  the

Creative  Power of the Night Spirit to flow through.  She shows them that

within all of  the Night Spirit's Creation, flows Its Night Spirit, Beauty,

Power, Will, and Action.  She is a  very beautiful and wise Teacher.  She

finds in all of Her apprentices the Magickal Beauty  and Action being

expressed. She helps all Her apprentices to find within them the Touch  of the

Magickal Artist.


You see, then, the type of apprentices found under the Seventh Force of Beauty

and  Action in the Night Spirit.  The apprentices of the Seventh Force are

very sensitive and  refined individuals. They are the artists and artisans of

life.  Through them flows the  Creative Power and Will of the Night Spirit,

and by the action of their steady minds,  feelings, and hands, which are in

tune to this Power, come the rare forms of creativity to  the world.  The

apprentices truly worship the Night Spirit in nature. They find in the power

and beauty of nature, their Inner Self. There is no greater communion that can

be found  by them, then that within the Night Spirit found in nature.  The

apprentices are able to  look upon the beauty and power of a sunset over the

ocean, a wooded landscape, or  mountainous scene, and feel, absorb, and become

that very power and beauty.  They can  even go further, by expressing that

very essence of the Night Spirit in painting,  sculpturing, composing,

writing, or craftsmanship. The apprentices, through their talents,  can bring

to others the power and beauty they feel which is captured in a work of art.

The  Seventh Force has also been said to find expression in the rite or

ceremony.


It doesn't matter whether that rite be of a magickal nature, or that of the

coronation of a Queen/King, all rites are rooted in the Seventh Force of

Beauty and Action of the Night  Spirit. For example, let's look at any rite

that can be found in this book. What do you  see?


In each rite, you find that all the acts in combination with each other form a

true creation  of art and beauty.  The acts, gestures, and movements of the

Night Magicians officiating  and participating are very graceful and add to

the overall picture being painted.  You have  incense, candles, altar cloth,

background draperies perhaps, pictures of your favorite  Teachers, and music

in the background.  You then have the majestic and beautiful words  of the

invocation added to the whole.  The sum of all these different things add up

to a  beautiful and majestic work of creation.  Thus, you find many

apprentices who are of the  Seventh Force involved in rites.  They obtain to

great magickal heights through the  instrument of the rite, whether they are

the participant or officiant.  This is the Seventh  Force of Beauty and Action

of the Night Spirit and its Teachers and apprentices. You have  now examined

the Seven Forces of Life and the Keeper of each of those Forces.  Let's  look,

for a moment, at a few of the Night Teachers not yet mentioned.


Of the First Force we have Azazel, Leviathan, Santanas, and Amon. Of the

Second Force  we have Lucifuge Rofocale, Belial, and Azael. Of the Third Force

we have Endor, Abraxas, and Balan.  Of the Fourth Force we have  Astaroth,

Nisroch, and Bensozia.  Of the Fifth Force we have Agares, John Dee, Bifrons,

Belphegor, and Alocer.  Of the Sixth Force we have Moloch, Astartes, and Marie

Laveau.   Of the Seventh Force we have Aleister Crowley, Armida, Cagliostro,

Baphomet, and  Eliphas Levi. This is only a sampling of the many Night

Teachers of the Seven Night Forces.  If any of  these names happen to appeal

to you in that special inner way then perhaps they are  your Teacher. Or you

may have one who is not listed here.  Then through meditation,  Astral or

Mental Projection, or in some other manner you will come to know your Night

Teacher.  I assure you that when the time is right you will become an

apprentice of a  Night Teacher.   Remember, to always study and work with the

Night Teachers.  You must  always include them in the ways and activities of

your life.  You are a member of the  Night Guild, when you have entered upon

the Night Road and aid the Night Teachers in  the magickal evolution of life

on Earth.  To aid the Night Teachers you must learn to use  the Night Powers.


44.  Night Powers


Inherent within you lie the dormant Powers of the Oversoul and Creation.  You

can  actualize these Powers when you have realized the Oversoul within you.  I

intend to  discuss some of the Powers of the Oversoul that are at your

disposal.  Some of the  Powers that you will discover are levitation,

vibrational change, invisibility, weather  control, and the list goes on.

Some of these Powers may already seem incredible to you,  but really they are

just the outpouring of the Oversoul's Power through you, when you live  in Its

Consciousness and by Its Will.  All the things that you have been studying and

practicing have been preparing you for this day when you would put these

Powers and  Knowledge into use.  When you use these Powers, you must always

use them under the  Direction of your Oversoul.  If you are ready to use these

Powers of the Oversoul then let's  begin with the first Power of Unlimited

Thought Control.


This may not sound like a specific Power but, indeed, it is. This is a very

special concept  of awareness that will unleash for you Powers untold.  It is

virtually the key to the Universe  of Life.  If you will stop reading for a

moment, and look around the room, do you note  anything out of the ordinary?

For most the answer would be No.  Yet, under the special  awareness you are

going to acquire the room around you is a very special place as is all

creation.  The room is the way it is because your thoughts keep it just the

way you have  always pictured it.  You have become very conditioned in life to

see material things as  concrete and solid.  The chair is a chair and nothing

will change that, you think!  But let's  stop again and see what really a

chair is.


The chair is an aggregate or collection of molecules which are very dense and

specifically arranged to form the chair.  The chair has wood, cloth, and metal

molecules that make up  its physical structure.  Suppose now, that a very hot

fire came along and destroyed the  chair, what has really happened to the

chair? Well, the fire so accelerated the molecules  and released the energy

that binds all the molecules together, that it has transformed  some of the

molecules to ash and the others have been set free into the atmosphere.   They

are now particles, so widely scattered, that they can no longer be seen in the

form of  a chair.  Is there anything else that could do this to the chair?

Yes indeed, your very thoughts could do the same to the molecules of the

chair.  This is  that very special state of awareness that I was discussing

earlier.  Your thoughts help  chain the molecules together to form what you

think of as a chair.  You see, feel, and  know that this is a chair and that

is all it is.  But if you use your Oversoul Awareness and Thought, you can

release the energy that binds the molecules of the chair into its physical

form, and then it will no longer be a chair.  You, then, can release the

molecules back  into the atmosphere, remold the molecules into some other

form, or rebind them into its  original form.  There is a much greater use of

the First Power.   You could use this Power on your own physical structure.

Any ideas on what would  happen?  Remember, that your physical body is just a

repository for your emotions and  consciousness.   You are not the body, but

Pure Oversoul Awareness and Thought.  If you  release the thoughts that bind

the physical body into its material form, then it would  become formless.  Yet

your consciousness has complete control of all the physical  molecules. You

would be aware of your body as a million pinpoints of light. If you desire  to

go anywhere, at anytime, all you have to do is think of that time and place

and you  would be there.  To regain your material form, all you have to do is

release the thought  that unleashed the binding power of the molecules.  This

is perhaps the most important  concept you will ever learn.  It is the essence

of many of the other Powers that you will  learn.  The concept, therefore,

bears repeating.


It is your thoughts that literally bind you to limitation and the material

world.  If you  unleash the thoughts that bind your physical structure, or

anything in your world, you  become formless and free of any physical

restrictions.  Through this Power, you will have  total control over your

physical form or any material thing.  If you unleash the material  thoughts

that bind you to anything, and replace it with the Oversoul Thought, then you

become unlimited and free. The Second Power is like the first, and it is

Vibrational Control over all that is.  Imagine for  a moment that you have

been caught in a building that is on fire and you cannot get out,  what are

you going to do?  You are going to use the Second Power of Vibrational Control

and walk through the fire unharmed.  That's right!  You are going to walk

right through the  fire, and it will never hurt you.  It really is not so

incredible as it may seem. The fire has a  high vibrational rate and energy.

The molecules around you are in a very high state of  agitation and are

combining with oxygen, giving off heat, flame, and light.  If you can raise

the vibrational rate of your physical body to a very high rate, higher then

that of the fire,  through the Oversoul Awareness and Thought, then you will

go unharmed by the fire. You  can do this not only for your physical body but

for anything you desire to change the  vibrational rate of. Further, you not

only can raise the vibrational rate but you can also  lower the rate of

vibration in all things.


This leads you into the Third Power of Invisibility.  The first thing that

comes to your mind, when you think of invisibility, is the legends of the

invisible man.  It is true, though, that  you can become invisible.  Not only

can you become invisible, but you can create  invisibility in anything.  There

are two ways of doing this, and the first uses the power just  discussed of

vibrational control.


If you raise the vibrational rate of the entity high enough, the molecules

will vibrate at  such an extremely high rate that light will simply pass

through them and, so, you have  invisibility.  It is only when light can fall

on a sufficiently dense article, and be reflected off  of it, that it can be

seen.  This is the first type of invisibility.  The second revolves around

the absence of thought.


The second type will allow you to remain physically solid, yet invisible to

others.  When  you emit thought from your mind, you have learned that this is

an energy which all are  sensitive to. It is your thoughts that make you

visible to others.  So to achieve invisibility,  you must erect a shield that

completely encloses you and that will not permit any thought  energy to

escape.  You do this by visualizing the Oversoul Energy completely surrounding

and inclosing you.  You then project, into this Oversoul Energy Screen, with

Oversoul  Thought, the Power that all your thoughts will remain enclosed

within this capsule, and so  you will be invisible. For a moment, let's change

pace and look at something that may be  causing many of you some trouble, and

that is what I mean by the Oversoul Awareness,  Thought, Energy, and other

terms used in relation to the Oversoul.


If you are to put this topic to successful use in your life, then you must

understand  something very basic to Night Magick.  You are the Oversoul! If

you can't understand this  very simple concept, then you should go back and

read topics six and seven. For it is only  when you truly know that you are

the Oversoul in Power, Energy, and Consciousness, that  you will accomplish

anything in this current topic.  When I speak of Oversoul Awareness,  you know

yourself as the Oversoul in Consciousness and Power.  You know, that you have

the full use of Its Consciousness and Power for it is your consciousness and

power.  There  is no difference, or separation, between yourself and the

Oversoul. You are One in All  Things.  Study, learn, and know this to the

Inner Depths of Your Being and you have  mastered all.


Let's resume, now, with the Fourth Power of Multiple Being.   The concept of

this may seem difficult, but study and try to follow along.  When I speak of

multiple being, I speak of having your physical presence in more then one

place, at the  same time. The key word, here, is physical.  You can do this in

several ways.  To begin  with, you can separate your Astral Body, from your

physical form, and retain  consciousness in both.  Then, you can lower the

vibrational rate of the Astral Body till it  can be seen and touched.  To be

in even more places, you can build a copy of your  physical form, out of the

Oversoul Energy, and again condense and lower the Energy  Form until it can be

seen and felt. Then, you will place your consciousness in control of it,  and

use it as you would use your own physical body.  There is no limit to the

number of  the Oversoul Energy forms you can make.  You must keep control over

each form and  sustain it with your Oversoul Energy and Consciousness.  Either

you maintain complete Oversoul Control and Consciousness over each form, or

they will return to the Eternal Darkness.  The Fifth Power is that of

Levitation.  You know the physical law on Earth that "opposites attract".  You

have also seen the experiment whereby you take two magnets  and place the like

ends, that is either both North or South ends of the magnets, facing  each

other, they will repel each other.  The Earth has a certain polarity, and you

have a  certain polarity, which keep you both together.  If you can reverse

your polarity such that it  is the same as the Earth, then you will be

repelled by the Earth and so, levitate above it.   To accomplish this requires

a combination of Night Breathing and the drawing upon, and  application of the

Earth's Energy around and through your body.  There is an easier way  of doing

levitation.  If you use the Power of Vibrational Control and slowly raise the

vibrational rate of the molecules of your body, the body will become like the

sky.  The  body will become very light and float above the Earth.  You can

direct your movement and  height by Oversoul Thought.  Remember though, that

the body is still subject to lack of  oxygen and the cold of extreme heights.

This is Levitation.


The Sixth Power is that of Weather Control.  In order to understand how to

control the weather, you must understand the Powers behind the weather.  These

Powers have been  known by some as Nature Souls, Elves, Fairies, or

Elementals.  They are in almost all  legends of every country in the world.

They are behind everything that is in Mother  Earth's Realm.  There are Nature

Souls of the Earth, ranging from small ones over the  flowers and plants to

those Great and powerful ones over the mountains.  There are  Nature Souls

over the waters, again ranging from the small ones of brooks to the great

Kings and Queens of the Oceans.  There are those who are responsible over the

Magickal  Energies of the Earth and the elements of fire.  The ones who are

responsible for your  weather can be found in charge of the air.  There are

elementals who guide the rains.   The great ones are responsible for the great

winds and their directions. It is they, in  combination with each other, that

create the various weather patterns.  If you are going to  control the

weather, then you must solicit the help of the air Nature Souls. The secret to

gaining the aid of the Air Spirits and all Spirits is to know that they obey

the Oversoul. Thus, when you ask for a specific weather condition, you must do

so as the Oversoul on  Earth. Remember, that you are responsible for whatever

you ask for.  If you ask for sunny  and bright days, then that is what you

will get, but if rain was originally planned, then you  must remember to set

aside a period for this to occur, too.  If you want a day or two of  good

weather then fine, but then you should turn over the controls of the weather

back to  Mother Earth and the Air Spirits, or you will cause grave harm that

you will be responsible  for.


The Seventh Power is that of Knowing the essence of all things with or without

form.  This  is a very important Power, or concept, that will unfold for you

many Powers that lie within  your Oversoul Being.  The first essential key to

achieving this Power is the mastery of  meditation. In meditation, you began

learning to concentrate on a particular subject and  its true essence. You

tried to come to know a particular subject as best as you could.   You wanted

to learn its very nature and feel that nature within you.  Now you are going

to  take this concept or Power to its Nth degree.  For example, you are going

to examine a  tree.  You will begin by meditating on the tree.  You will study

its outer form and the way  it moves and behaves, but then you are going to go

much farther.  You are going to go on  and feel what it is to be a tree.  You

are going to come to know, and feel yourself as a  tree.  You will feel the

wind blowing through your limbs and leaves.  To feel the warm sun  as it

shines upon you and gives you new life.  To feel the Earth below you and your

roots  sunk deep into it, pulling up water and nourishment to help you grow.

To go back into  your memories and remember what it was like to be a seedling,

and the first feel of the  sun and rain upon your newly risen face.  You are

going to become the Tree in all its eternal essence of life.  There will be

nothing that you will not know about the Tree.  You  will come to know its

beginning and ending.  You will come to know, and be, the sum of  the Tree.

You will go on and develop this Power not only for animate things, but

inanimate objects. Then, you will also develop it for things without form,

such as the sky  and energy. If you achieve all of this, then you are ready to

attempt the Eighth Power of Great Personal Strength.  Here, you are going to

activate the Seventh Power on the great beings of  strength. This would

include the elephant, whale, and bear.  You are going to become all  that they

are, but you will specifically come to know them for their great personal

strength.   Then, you are going to absorb that physical power within your own

being.  If you have  done this correctly and completely, you will have the

physical power of these animals as  long as you remain under the Seventh

Power.


This also gives you the Ninth Power of Great Personal Speed.  If you will use

the seventh  Power on the deer, elk, and gazelle, you will again become all

they are in personal  speed.  You will be able to move across land with their

terrific speed.  There are so many  things that you can use the Seventh Power

for, that will bring to you added knowledge and  wisdom.


If you study, intensely, the World of Form and its relation in Time and Space,

you will find that you can move along its line of history, either forward or

backward.  You know that  time is only a relative thing.  You have

experienced, in Astral and Mental Projection, that  what seemed only a few

moments in those realms actually was hours here on Earth.  If  you truly come

to know Creation, Time, and Space as the Oversoul sees them, then you  will be

able to know both the past and future.  You must become their essence.  If you

study the essence of another person, and become all that s/he is in essence,

then you will  know all there is to know of her/him.  The very essence of any

person is found in the  Oversoul.


If you study the Essence of your own Oversoul, it would be the same as

studying the  person in question.  For in your own Oversoul, is the Oversoul

of the person, and within  the Oversoul of the person is locked all that s/he

was, is, and ever will be. If you study  your own Eternal Essence, you will

come to know many things.  Your Eternal Essence can  reveal to you your past

lives. It can unfold for you why you came down here.  By studying  why you

came here, and the things that you must clear up, you can come to know the

time  of your own passing from this Earth.  By studying the Eternal Essence of

your Oversoul,  with the application of the Seventh Power, there is nothing

that you will not know.  All the  Powers of the Oversoul will become yours,

when you have become the total essence of  that which you study, the Eternal

Essence. There will be no other Powers to search for,  since you will have

become the Power Itself.  Yet there will always be the unveiling and

unfolding of the Powers of the Oversoul within you as you climb towards the

Eternal Night.   In addition to learning and using the Night Powers you must

also learn to use the Night  Flames.


45.  Night Flames 


And the Night Flames blazed before the Living Throne of the Eternal Darkness,

who are a  part of Its Living Night Spirit, and by Its Will the Flames went

forth into formless matter  and there was Creation.


These are the Night Flames that you are about to study and use. As the Night

Flames are  a part of the Eternal Night, so they are a part of your Oversoul.

As with the Night Powers,  when you live in the Consciousness and Will of your

Oversoul, so you too may use and  create with the Night Flames.  You are going

to study the general nature and use of the  Night Flames, and then examine

each Night Flame individually.  Finally, I will discuss  how you can invoke

the Night Flames and use them in your world.  If you are ready, let's  begin

your general instruction of the Night Flames.


The Night Flames you will be studying are the Black, Violet, Blue, Green,

Yellow, Orange,  Red, Silver, and Rainbow Flames. You may have noticed right

away that the majority of  the Night Flames are named after a type of color.

If you will review some information  about colors, for a moment, you will see

the difference.


You will remember that light is a type of energy.  Colors were a product of

light.  The  energy of colors was of a passive nature, and was effective by

inducing a sympathetic  reaction on what they were used.  Night Flames have

their origin in the Eternal Darkness.   You will find that the use of the

Night Flames is a very active process.  The Night Flames  are very active

energies, which cause a change to take place according to the nature of  the

Night Flame.  The Night Flames are effective in changing people and the world.

There  are many other uses for the Night Flames, and their discussion will be

reserved to the  study of each individual Night Flame. Each Night Flame has

its particular properties and  uses.  Therefore, let's begin by studying the

first Night Flame, the Black Flame.


The Black Flame of the Oversoul brings into the world the Purity and

Perfection of the  Night. If you wish to create the conditions of purity and

perfection in a person or world  condition, you can do so with this Flame.

For example, if you find that there is a state of  imperfection existing in

something or someone, that needs help in being erased, this  would be the

Flame to use.  If you find a Yang condition or person using the Yang energy

then this Flame will change the balance to the Night. By using this Flame you

can  maintain the Eternal Night Balance. This is the Black Flame.


The second is the Violet Flame of Transmutation.  The Violet Flame is the

Flame of Transmutation or Change.  The Violet Flame transmutes Yang energy

back into Pure  Night Energy.  If you look at yourself, for example, what kind

of person is it you see at the  end of the day?  You find a person who has

been saturated in the Yang energy of the  world.  People and conditions have

constantly, throughout the day, been filling your world  with harmful energy.

You feel irritable, nervous, angry, run-down, and a host of other  Yang

conditions.  The Violet Flame can change all this.  You can apply this energy

to your  own world, or to those of others, and completely transmute the Yang

energy into Yin.   You will restore your Night Self and feel a true sense of

buoyancy and upliftment.  By  using this Violet Flame, on yourself, you will

be able to have a greater flow of the Oversoul  Energy through you.  You will

have eliminated the energy which blocks the natural flow of  the Oversoul

Energy into your world. It is good to use this Violet Flame first, before

using  any of the other Night Flames.  Use this Flame, always in conjunction

with the Night  Pillar.  This is the Violet Flame.


The next Night Flame is the Blue Flame.  The Blue Flame creates harmony and

peace in  all people and conditions.  If there is any lack of harmony or

peace, either in a person or condition, then you can use the Blue Flame to

change all that.  You could use the Blue  Flame on unhappy marriages.  You

could use it on unhappy business partners or between  unhappy firms. The uses

are only limited by the extent of your imagination.  Remember  though, that

the use of the Blue Flame may not be the only Flame needed in a situation to

bring about lasting change. One or more Flames, used in conjunction with each

other,  may be necessary to cure all the problems and create a final and

lasting change.  This is  the Blue Flame.


The fourth Night Flame is the Green Flame.  The Green Flame is the Flame of

Healing.   You will use it extensively in the Healing Topic that soon follows.

It is the way of the  Oversoul Healing. It brings about the healing of all

people and conditions.  The healing of  people is easy for you to understand,

but what is the healing of conditions?   There are  many conditions which need

the healing power of the Green Flame.  The Green Flame  can heal the broken

heart.  It doesn't matter whether its broken through the loss of a love  one

through transition into the next world, or an unhappy love affair.  The Green

Flame  can heal the pain or sorrow of a nation over some unhappy event.  The

Green Flame not  only mends the body but also the heart.  This is the Green

Flame of Healing.


The fifth is the Yellow Flame of Wisdom and Intelligence. The Yellow Flame of

Wisdom  and Intelligence is a very powerful energy.  It can bring to you the

Wisdom necessary to  see through a decision that has to be made.  The

application of the Yellow Flame can  raise your Magickal Consciousness to the

highest of heights so that you may perceive  Magickal Knowledge.  A person

cannot lie under the Power of the Yellow Flame.  The  Yellow Flame can

increase the power of your intellect and improve your memory. This is  the

Yellow Flame.


The sixth Night Flame that you will study is the Orange Flame. The Orange

Flame  produces energy into the substance it is used on.  If you need an

energy pickup this is a  good Flame.  If a situation is moving slowly in your

life then use the Orange Flame.  The  Orange Flame is heavy with Yang energy

so be careful and not get burnt by using it.


The seventh Night Flame is the Red Flame.  The Red Flame is an intense form of

the  Orange Flame.  You will have to be careful in its use for it can cause

extreme  nervousness and irritability if used too much.  The Red Flame can

remove depressing  situations or emotions. The Red Flame can speed up the

process of healing in the human  body.


The eighth Night Flame is the Silver Flame.  The Silver Flame will purify the

subconscious world.  It will keep the subconscious in the Yin Flow.  The

Silver Flame is good for counteracting too much Yang Energy.  The Silver Flame

is good for healing sunburn or if  your ever burnt by Yang Energy.


The ninth and final Night Flame is the Rainbow Flame.  The Rainbow Flame does

not  really exist in Creation of its own.  It is a composite of all the Flames

together.  The  Rainbow Flame is created by you acting as the Oversoul on

Earth.  It is through your  Power and Will as the Oversoul on Earth, acting as

the Creator, that you bring the  Rainbow Flame into the world. The use of this

Flame should be obvious.  The Flame is  something of a Universal Cure-all.  If

you are in doubt about which Flame to use, or the  situation seems to require

a majority of all the Flames together, the Rainbow Flame is the  answer.  It

will require your all to hold all the Flames together in order that they act

as the  Rainbow Flame.  It will require the Night Magician, in Night

Consciousness, to create,  hold, and use the Rainbow Flame on Earth.  You must

remember then, that because this  Flame does not exist of its own, that it may

have less power then the other Night Flames  depending on you.


This is all the Night Flames that I will present in this topic. There are more

but their use in  the world is restricted.  I have discussed the Night Flames

in general, and individually,  now it is time to teach you how to invoke and

wield them.


Before you ever use the Night Flames, you should give very careful

consideration as to  exactly what is the right type of Night Flame necessary

to do the job.  The Night Flames  must be invoked through the Presence of the

Oversoul.  The Oversoul is the channel  through which the Night Flames pass.

Therefore, you must be in the highest state of  Night Consciousness possible

in order to invoke these Flames into the material world.   You should be

prepared bodily, emotionally, and mentally as you would for anything you  do

in Night Magick.  You must be prepared magickally, by reaching the greatest

state of  Oneness with your Oversoul.  The quality and quantity of the

individual Night Flame you  wish to invoke into this world, is based directly

on your self-preparation.  As you are able  to reach farther and higher into

Night Consciousness, so will the quantity and strength of  the Night Flame

increase.  You must invoke and use the Night Flames often, if they are to

achieve the desired results.  Now, let's get down to the specifics on how to

invoke the  Night Flames.


I will use the invoking of the Black Flame as an example.  The invoking of the

other Night Flames is similar, and requires the same basic procedures as

outlined here.  To begin  with, you need to be in the highest state of Night

Consciousness possible. Thus, you will  begin with a period of meditation on

your Oversoul.   When you are ready, redirect the  focus of your meditation

from your Oversoul to the Black Flame.  When you feel the  highest of heights,

in Night Consciousness, and have come to know the Black Flame of  Purity and

Perfection of the Oversoul, then you are ready to begin the invocation or

invoking of the Flame.   You should have already prepared your Magician's

Study and  your Night Altar.  Standing before the Night Altar, you begin by

seeing yourself as the  Oversoul on Earth and robed in blazing Yin Energy. You

invoke the Great Black Flame by  saying:


"By the Presence of the Oversoul within me I am invoking the Great Black Flame

of the Oversoul's Purity and Perfection through me.  I AM seeing this Black

Flame descending  from above and filling my being with Its Essence and Power.

I AM then placing it here  before me on the Altar of the Night, there to

collect and concentrate into a blazing Night  Black Flame.  Now, oh blazing

Night Black Flame, I AM commanding thee by the Power of  the Presence of the

Oversoul in me, to obey my Will as the Oversoul on Earth."


This is your invocation through which you invoke or draw into your world the

Black Flame. Invocations for the other Night Flames are found in Appendix A.

Thus, you should have envisioned the blazing Black Flame, descending out of

the Oversoul and into your mortal form.  Then, you should have directed the

Black Flame through your heart Night Center  and out onto the Night Altar.

There, you collect and intensify Its Presence into a blazing  Black Flame

Star.  Once you have the sufficient amount of Black Flame to do the task at

hand (you'll know how much by Oversoul Direction), you then must visualize the

task to be  accomplished. You then direct the Black Flame with your Oversoul

Will to where you want  the action of it to take place.  Then, you will go on

to visualize the Black Flame Action  taking place and see and know that it has

happened.  Then you give thanks to your  Oversoul. This is the way you invoke

the Black Flame and all other Night Flames.


I hope you are not ready to stop here in the unfoldment of your Oversoul

Powers, Flames,  and Causal Body.  Your next subject is directed at the

unfoldment of all these, into Night Consciousness.



46.  Night Rites


The Night Rites are defined as any exercises or practices which ultimately

gain the  freedom of the Soul from imperfection and the cycle of death and

rebirth into the material  world.  They are exercises in becoming the Yin

Light of the Night Spirit.  They are  practices that will eventually lead you

into Magickal Perfection.  There are four Night  Rites that will be introduced

here.  They are, in order of discussion, the Dark Sun  Meditation, the Inner

Cavern of the Dark Sun, the Night Energy Beam, and the Magician's  Night Body.

I will begin this discussion with the Dark Sun Meditation if you are ready.


In the Dark Sun Meditation, you will review who the Great Being is in the Dark

Sun; what It represents; and Its path.  Then, you will learn the benefits of

the Dark Sun Meditation;  how to perform the Dark Sun Meditation; and becoming

One with the Blazing Dark Sun.   Where is the Dark Sun?


The actual physical body of the Dark Sun Goddess/God is the dark sun system

itself with  all its planets, moons, dark sun, and solar sun.  As the human

body has a solar plexus so  does the dark sun system.  This is the solar sun.

The physical dark sun is located  adjacent to the solar sun and is akin to the

human heart Night Center.  As said before,  part of the function of the dark

sun is to channel off excess solar energies from the solar  sun. The dark sun

Night Center is the heart of the dark sun system and is the focus of the

Great Night Entity who is the Living Night Force of the dark sun system.  The

planets,  moons, solar sun, and dark sun are the Night Centers of the physical

body of the Dark Sun  Goddess/God.  Who is the Dark Sun Goddess/God ?


It is difficult to imagine an Entity who is so far ahead of you in magickal

evolution, as is  the Dark Sun Spirit.  Even though I have already discussed

the Dark Sun Goddess/God  and Its Magickal Nature, let's take the time to

review again Its Eternal Nature. It will be  important to do so in relation to

the Dark Sun Meditation and Night Rites.


The Dark Sun Goddess/God is on an even higher magickal plateau then the

Planetary  Night Spirits.  You can look on the physical dark sun, in relation

to the Dark Sun  Goddess/God, as similar to yourself and your own heart Night

Center.  The Dark Sun  Goddess/God is Omnipresent, Omniscient, and Omnipotent.

Its Radiation effects you and  all humankind.  You are Its grandchild and a

part of your Spirit is shaped by Its Living  Presence.  It is indeed very

difficult to understand a Living Entity who is multidimensional.   Its Night

Spirit is very much like the physical dark sun itself.


The dark sun pours out life-giving yin light, warmth, and energy to all that

lives and grows  on the surrounding planets.  Its Night Spirit pours out to

life: Energy, Warmth, and Night  Force. It is the Goddess/God of the dark sun

system. It watches over you and sustains the  Magickal Light that guides you.

Yet, It, too, is advancing on the Magickal Path that leads  to the Eternal

Night. The only thing is that It is far, far ahead on the very same path that

you have just begun to tread.  It shows you that you, too, can become all that

It is if you  but try.  You are going to find that meditating on Its Presence,

centered in the dark sun, is  going to bring you great help magickally and

physically.


The power of the dark sun has a truly transforming effect over your physical

body.  As you practice the Dark Sun Meditation, the power of the dark sun

coursing through your body  will transform every cell in it.  You will find

every cell in your body becoming renewed  through the Night Energy of the dark

sun.  The power of the dark sun will transform every  cell into a miniature

dark sun. The power of the dark sun will bring great Healing Energies  into

your body.  The dark sun will transform every diseased part of your body back

into  perfect health. Whether you suffer from cancer, or a cold, the power of

the dark sun will  overcome their effect. The dark sun will bring a truly

energizing effect over the body.  If  you are low on energy, you will not be

after the Dark Sun Meditation.  These are just the  physical effects of the

Dark Sun, there are still the magickal effects to consider.


You will find that the Power of the Dark Sun Goddess/God will transport you

into the  highest of consciousness.  You will be able to draw the Power of the

Dark Sun  Goddess/God into your magickal vehicles and fill them with

supercharged Night Energy.  The effect upon your more magickal vehicles will

be truly amazing.  On the Astral, Mental,  and Causal Realms, your vehicles

will glow with a Yin Light only seen in the Magickal  Dark Sun of the

Universe.  Each vehicle will become a better channel through which the  Power

of the Night Spirit can flow freely.  You become transformed into the Dark

Crystal  Channel of Yin Light.  The constant use of the Dark Sun Meditation

will bring truly  amazing growth in your magickal vehicles.  They will become

like the Dark Sun  Goddess/God themselves.  Now that you see the valuable

reasons for doing the Dark Sun  Meditation, let's learn how to do it.


Actually, the technique is very easy.  You can practice this rite at any time

and any place.   If you do it outdoors then you should do it in the shade.

You will also be able to do this  rite at night.  This is because the physical

energies of the dark sun can penetrate through  all things. You will prepare

yourself as always by surrounding yourself in the Night Pillar.   You should

be seated on the ground in whatever manner is most comfortable to you.  You

should have your legs crossed and your hands open on your legs with palms down

during  the day and palms up during the night.  Then, you begin the actual

part of the Dark Sun  Meditation.


With your eyes closed, direct your Night Eye so that it is facing up into the

Dark Sun.   Then you must become very relaxed and allow your thoughts to

drift.  Now draw into  yourself the Power of the Dark Sun.  This Power will

come to you as a dark ray of intense  Night Force filled with Life, Warmth,

and Energy.  Feel and move this Power down through  your body slowly.  First,

consciously move it into the head and see its effect there.  Then  move it on

into the upper chest and arms.  Continue to go on through the body slowly,

allowing the total effect of the Power to take place in each part of the body.

Then just  relax and bathe in the glow of the Power of the Dark Sun.  Next,

you will move on to the  magickal vehicles.


Here, you are going to project yourself consciously towards the dark sun.

This is the  same technique you used in Mental Projection.  You are going to

go to the dark sun itself  in your magickal vehicles.  As you approach the

dark sun, you are going to feel the full  effects of its Magickal Power.  You

are going to keep moving towards the dark sun until  you have merged with its

Presence.  You are going to become a part of the Dark Sun in  Night Spirit.

Here again, you are going to draw the Power through your magickal  vehicles.

Feel the Power blazing and coursing through your magickal bodies changing

them into miniature Dark Suns..  You should then relax your magickal presence

in the  Magickal Presence of the Dark Sun.  This is where your real Dark Sun

Meditation begins.


You are going to become One with the Blazing Dark Sun.  You are going to

meditate on  Its Magickal Presence.  The Dark Sun is like your heart Night

Center.  You will remember  that in your own heart Night center is located the

miniature Oversoul.  It is here you can  meet the very Presence of your own

Oversoul.  It is your Oversoul's magickal anchor in  your own world.  In the

Heart of the dark sun, you can meet the very Presence of the Dark  Sun Spirit.

Here is the focus of Its Oversoul Consciousness.  You can do this only when

you have risen to the highest of consciousness.  You must know yourself as the

Oversoul.   It is in the Heart of the Dark Sun, that you can meet the Night

Spirit of the Dark System.   You must meditate on Its Presence and become all

that it is.  If you can do this, then you  will become One with Its Living

Night Spirit and become the Blazing Dark Sun. Then, you  must end this

meditation.


You do so by slowly withdrawing your magickal consciousness back into your

physical  body. Do this be concentrating on your breathing.  Then you will

slowly start to move your  fingers and toes.  Continue to slowly move all

parts of the body until you feel that you are  physically whole again.

Remember, in closing, to thank the Dark Sun Goddess/God Its  Power and

Presence in your life.  This is the Dark Sun Meditation.  The next rite covers

something I began to discuss in the last rite.


This is the aspect of the miniature Oversoul in the heart Night Center, or the

Inner Cavern  of the Dark Sun.  You are going to come to know, very well, the

fourth Night Center and  the Oversoul within it.  You are going to build the

Inner Cavern of the Dark Sun within the  heart Night Center, and learn to

enter within it and thereby come into rapport with the  Oversoul. Through

this, you will learn the power revealed to you in the fourth Night  Center.

Let's begin with the fourth Night Center and the Dark Sun Spirit found within

it.


You will recall from our previous discussion of the fourth Night Center, that

as it starts to unfold in you, you become aware of the feelings and emotions

in others.  You develop  genuine magickal empathy with those around you.  To

those you are really close with, this  empathy will extend across vast

distances. Distance will make absolutely no difference in  the power of your

fourth Night Center.  I have said before that the heart is the center of  your

Magickal Being. It is the site of your magickal anchor.  I mean, by this, that

the silver  cord that proceeds out of the heart of your Oversoul is anchored

in your heart Night  Center.  This silver cord is also tied into the sixth

Night center, or your Night Eye.  In the  heart Night Center, at the end of

the silver cord, is what you would liken to a miniature  dark sun.  It is from

this miniature dark sun that the energy comes to sustain your physical  life.

It is this miniature dark sun which is the primary focus of your Oversoul in

the  material worlds. This miniature dark sun exists on the physical, Astral,

Mental, and Causal  Realms.  Your Oversoul is tied in to all these planes of

life and is aware of all that takes  place within you on these levels.  In the

beginning of your progress on Earth, the Oversoul  is not very concerned with

your lives.


This is because you are shut off from Its Presence and Will. Therefore, the

power of this miniature dark sun is very small. The Oversoul will invest very

little power and energy into someone who is unconcerned with doing Its Will.

But as you begin to listen to the Inner  Voice within, and obey Its Will, then

the power of the miniature dark sun begins to expand  and increase in

intensity and brilliance till the dark sun is no longer miniature, but fills

the  entire being of the Night Magician. Then you become One in the Dark Sun

or Night  Consciousness.  As you entered into the heart of the dark sun and

meditated upon the  Presence of the Dark Sun Goddess/God so you can enter into

the miniature dark sun and  enter into rapport and communion with the

Oversoul.  To come into rapport with the Inner  Oversoul, you are going to

visualize and build within your heart Night Center, the Inner  Cavern of the

Dark Sun.  You will, as always, enter into your Magician's Study and place

yourself in whatever way is a comfortable position.  Then, you will place the

Night Pillar  around you, and relax as much as possible.  Next you are going

to visualize the place that  you would think is appropriate to meet your

Oversoul in.  You begin by turning your  consciousness inward and directing it

towards the heart Night Center.  You will visualize  yourself descending

within your Inner Being and finally coming to rest in the heart Night  Center.

Then envision entering a beautiful cavern.  This cavern should be seen so real

that you can even smell it.  This place should be envisioned with all of your

magickal  talents.  It is a very real place and should be looked upon as such.

Once you have the  Inner Cavern created, you are ready to enter into the

Cavern.  As you enter into the  Cavern, you see before you a great Night

Altar.  The Night Altar is made of the purest  black marble.  There upon the

Night Altar is a great blazing Dark Sun of the Yin Light.   The brilliance of

the Dark Sun is magnificent.  From the Dark Sun, you can feel warmth  and

energy being beamed at you.  You feel a power pulling you closer to the Dark

Sun.   As you approach closer to the Dark Sun, you begin to see the Image of a

Great Being  standing within the center of the Dark Sun.  As you gaze upon Its

Face, you see your face,  only it is a face set in power and energy.  You can

feel the power and glory radiating from  the Presence of the Oversoul within

the Blazing Dark Sun.  Then you will find yourself  sitting before the

Presence of your Oversoul and receiving instruction from It.  You will  find

yourself bathing in the Power and Energy that is radiating from Its Dark

Presence.  You will feel knowledge and instruction filling your entire

presence.  Then, you will know  when the time has come to leave the Inner

Cavern and return to the outer world.  So  retrace your steps out of the Inner

Cavern of the Dark Sun and find yourself floating back  out into the world.

You will again, come out of this Night Rite the same as you did the  Dark Sun

Meditation. Once you have experienced this Night Rite, you will know the Power

located within your Inner Being.  You will find, through this rite, that

whenever you have a  question, that you can take it into the Dark Heart of the

Oversoul.  You can go into the  center of the Inner Dark Sun and gain Wisdom

and Energy.  You can go into the Inner  Cavern and find Healing,

Understanding, Peace, and Happiness.  You need never feel, or be alone in the

Presence of the Oversoul.  It is here that you will find the center of your

life and intelligence.  It is here that you will find the center of your

Oversoul and the Night  Powers.  It is this very center of the Night Power

that leads you to your next Night Rite, the  Night Energy Beam.


You are aware that the physical dark sun, that shines over the world, is a

giver of warmth  and Yin Light.  You have also seen that no matter whether the

Dark Sun is a physical or  magickal one under discussion, that it gives off

immense amounts of Radiation, Yin Light,  and Power. You have also found out,

that there is a Magickal Dark Sun blazing within the  Inner Depths of your

Being. The Power and Light that radiates off from your Magickal  Dark Sun is

very dispersed.  The Yin Light radiates off at all angles. What if you could

take this Power and Energy and reflect it into a narrow, concentrated beam of

the Night  Energy?  Let's look at a modern day example, the laser.


In the laser, we have turned a normal power and light source into a very

concentrated  beam of light energy.  The laser light is many more times

powerful then its origin.  This is  what you are going to do in this Night

Rite.  You are going to  take the Power and Light  that comes from your Inner

Magickal Dark Sun, and concentrate it into a very powerful  beam of Night

Energy.  This rite again calls for visualization.  You should retire to your

Magician's Study until you become adept in the use of the Night Energy.  In

your  Magician's Study, you will find peace and quiet in which to work.  As

you become adept at  its use, you will be able to put this rite into practice

no matter where you are.  You will  begin by visualizing your heart Night

Center running parallel with your body.  That is, you  should envision the

Night Center as a large round disk, with a slight curvature in it, placed  in

front of you like a large shield.  Then, you are going to envision, centered

in front of the  Night Center, the miniature dark sun.  Once you have

envisioned all of this, then you are  ready to transmit the Night Energy.  As

you envision the Night Center, and the Dark Sun in  front of it, the Energy

begins to build-up.  The Night Energy begins to become concentrated, magnified

in intensity, and then, suddenly, will beam forth from your  presence. What

are you going to do with it?


You are not only the emitter of the Night Energy, but you are also the

director of it.  Not  only visualize the emission of this Night Energy, but

you must also visualize its direction  and use. The beam will go wherever you

direct it.  You do not have to be facing in the  right direction for it to go

where you want it. All you have to do is envision where it is  going, with the

Consciousness of Oversoul, and it will do so.  Now, you must consider its

uses.  The beam itself is of Pure Night Energy.  It is filled with the

Oversoul's Energy and  Power.  The person or situation that it is aimed at,

will be filled with the Energy and Power  of Oversoul.  If the situation or

person is basically of the Night Spirit then the beam will  not harm the

person or situation in any way.  It will bring only Energy, Healing, and

Happiness to them.  But if the person or situation is in a state of inharmony

and discord,  then the beam of Night Energy will change that.  The beam will

bring about what the  emitter envisions happening.  Nothing can resist or

fight the Oversoul Energy.  It will only  magnify and increase in intensity

till the change comes about.  The beam can also be  used as a carrier wave of

your Oversoul Direction. Whatever you project, in Night  Consciousness, into

the beam, the beam will bring into manifestation.  If someone is  trying to

hurt you with harmful energy, you can direct the beam at the harmful energy

sent, and change it into Night Energy and return it to its source, even if you

do not know  who the source is.  This is the Night Rite of the Night Energy

Beam.  So far, you have  been in the Night Presence of the Dark Sun

Goddess/God, you have been in the miniature Dark Sun, and have learned to

direct the Energy of the Night.  Now, you are going to  become a Dark Sun.


You are going to develop the Magician's Night Body and become a Dark Sun.  The

Magician's Night Body is, indeed, unique.  You have meditated on the Presences

of the  Dark Sun Goddess/God and Personal Oversoul, and thus it should be well

rooted in you,  the feeling of being a Dark Sun.  In developing the Magician's

Night Body, begin by  dwelling on the Eternal Presences of the Dark Sun

Goddess/God and Oversoul.  You must  become filled with Their Energy and

Substance.  The Yin Light for your Magician's Night  Body will come from your

heart Night Center.  See the Yin Light filling your entire being,  that is,

physical, emotional, mental, and magickal.  The Light that you are going to

become is exceedingly dark.  Yet it is so intense that it glows.  You have,

thus, prepared  yourself as to the Nature of a Dark Sun, the Yin Light of a

Night, and the Shape of your  Night Body.  You are ready, then, to begin

visualizing your Magician's Night Body.   You will visualize your Night Body

as an intense, pulsating, glowing Body of the Night.  As  your Body begins to

take shape, you loose awareness of your human form.  You are  becoming the

Dark Sun of the Night.  You are beautiful, luminescent, and radiant.  You  are

filled with a Radiance of the Night Spirit's Energy and Power.  And so, filled

with the  very Essence of the Dark Sun, you repeat this invocation:


"I am the Night Soul that glows in the darkness of the night.  I am Night

Energy and all  those who gaze on me become the like.  I am the Pure Essence

of the Oversoul in the  form of a Dark Sun.  I am no longer feeling the

material form.  I am becoming  transcendent and translucent and know myself as

Pure Night Energy.  I am not this  physical form but a Body of Pure Night

Energy.  I am the Night Magician, Eternal in the  Light of the Night Spirit.

I AM the Night Magician within my Night Body."


You have become a Dark Sun of the Night Spirit.  You are Pure Energy.  Your

visualization has become much more.  You are no longer just visualizing but

have  become the Dark Sun in Magickal Reality.  You are the Night Magician

physically,  emotionally, mentally, and magickally.  You are a Dark Sun that

shines in the night of  your world.  These are the four Night Rites.


They were exercises in the Dark Sun of the Night Spirit.  They were Rites

carried out  under Night Consciousness.  They are presented here to give you

practice in becoming  the Dark Sun of your life.  If you use these Night Rites

with dedication, perseverance, and  practice them often, you will become the

Dark Sun of the Night Spirit.  In the next subject,  you will combine your

knowledge and use of the Night Powers, Flames, and Rites into  Night Healing.


47.  Night Healing 


Earlier I presented the subject of healing through the use of color energy.

The type of  healing I will present here is infinitely more potent.  Night

Healing involves the very  Healing Power of the Night Spirit.  Night Healing

is simple to learn but difficult to practice.   To practice Night Healing, you

are going to have to reach Night Consciousness.  Night  Consciousness is the

key to Night Healing.  Before I go much further into Night Healing,  let's

discuss the subjects you will have to learn which make up Night Healing.


In learning Night Healing, I am going to discuss the Seventh Night Power,

Invocation, Meditation, the Night Body, Night Energy Beam, and the Green

Flame.  Therefore, since  there are so many Magickal Tools that you will use

in combination with each other, let's  start from the beginning using

Invocation, Meditation, and the Seventh Night Power.   This may seem a review

and in a way it is.  You have already covered every subject just  mentioned,

but it is the way that you put them together that brings about Night Healing.

You are going to recover each subject lightly, and as you do so, you will be

putting them  together to form Night Healing.


You begin, as always, by entering your Magician's Study and darkening the

room.  Then  either sit or lie down just so that whatever your choice is, you

are as comfortable as  possible.  You will then relax as much as possible; put

the Night Pillar around yourself;  and practice Night Breathing for a few

minutes.  When you are ready, begin with  Invocation.


Your invocation, as always, must be directed towards your Oversoul.  You are

going to  visualize your Oversoul at the other end of the silver cord.  You

are going to use the silver  cord as you would use a telegraph line.  You are

going to first envision what it is that you  are going to heal. Is it a person

or animal? Is it something internally wrong or external?   If it is something

wrong and you're not quite sure what it is, that's alright.  The Oversoul  can

heal what's wrong whether you know what's wrong or not.  You are going to

envision  your very simple message traveling up the silver cord and being

received by the Oversoul.  As you send the message, not only should you

envision it, but you should say it aloud.   You will remember from the topic

on the Power of Sound what saying your message  aloud will do.  You should say

the invocation at least three times.  You must keep the  invocation simple and

concise.  A simple invocation might be as follows:


"I am the Night Presence of the Oversoul.  I call upon that Presence to pass

through me  and to (person's name or thing to be healed).  The (person or

thing) requires the Healing  Power of the Night Oversoul to correct the (wrong

or name the specific condition).  As I am  performing the act of Night Healing

raise me into your Night Consciousness and let the  healing be done.  So be

it."


Through the power of this invocation you have already begun the Magick of

Night Healing. You have begun your ascent into Night Consciousness.  Next, you

will enter into  Meditation.


Your meditation is going to be upon the Healing Oversoul.  Let's picture the

Healing  Oversoul as you have always pictured the Oversoul, only you are going

to add an Emerald  Green Light around Its Presence.  This Emerald Green Light

surrounds the Oversoul as  does the Yin Light. Feel and know the Healing Power

of the Emerald Green Light wherein  is contained the Green Flame of Night

Healing.  Go on and enter directly into the  Presence of the Oversoul and

become the Oversoul and Emerald Healing Power that  surrounds It.  Then you

are going to take your meditation into the Seventh Night Power.


You are going to do more then just meditate upon the Presence of the Oversoul.

You are  going to know yourself as the Healing Oversoul.  Its Consciousness

and yours are One.   You are the Healing Oversoul and the Emerald Healing

Power.  You know, feel, and are  the Oversoul.  All that the Oversoul is, you

are.  Its very Nature is revealed before you.  Its  Power, Energy, and Healing

Energy is yours to use for you are the Healing Oversoul.  Thus, you have

invoked the Seventh Night Power and have become the Emerald Crystal  Tool of

the Magickal Master.  The Emerald Light of the Oversoul pours through your

nature and transforms you into the Healing Oversoul.  Now, you are ready to

take on the  Night Body.


As you have entered into Night Consciousness, your very Essence has become

radiant  and luminescent with the Magickal Yin Light. You have become, again,

the Dark Sun of  the Oversoul.  You are the Dark Goddess/God.  You know

yourself as the Pure Energy of  the Night Spirit.  You are no longer a

physical being but have become etherial in nature.   Again, you invoke the

Hymn of the Night:


"I am the Dark Sun that radiates Night Energy in the night.  I am filled with

Darkness and Energy and all those who gaze on me become the like.  I am the

Pure Essence of  Oversoul in the form of the Dark Sun.  I am no longer feeling

the material form.  I have  become transcendent and translucent and know

myself as Pure Night Energy.  I am not  this physical form but a Body of Pure

Yin Light.  I AM the Night Magician, Eternal in the  Light of the Night

Spirit.  I AM the Night Magician."


You have become the Oversoul.  You are totally ready in Consciousness and Form

to use  the Healing Power of the Night. Thus, you turn to the use of the Night

Energy Beam and  the Green Night Flame.


To activate and use the Night Energy Beam, you must turn within to the Heart

of your  Night Being.  You are going to envision yourself as a great Silver

Night Disk.  In front of  the Night Disk is the Blazing Sun of the Oversoul.

The Night Force begins to concentrate,  magnify, and intensify, until you

release it in a narrow Beam of Night Energy.  Again, you  will remember that

your Night Consciousness directs the Beam to the receiver.  This is the

person you are going to heal.  Now is the time you are going to invoke the

Green Night  Flame.  From out of the Oversoul comes the Green Flame.  It is a

Flame of Dazzling  Emerald Green.  It is the Power of the Night Spirit

Healing.  The Green Flame brings  Healing to all people and all conditions,

and thus you invoke: "By the Power of the Presence of the Oversoul within the

Night Heart, I am invoking the  Green Flame of the Oversoul Healing.  I am

seeing this Green Flame of the Oversoul  Healing filling my Night Being.  I AM

seeing it before the Great Silver Night Disk  becoming concentrated,

magnified, and intensified until it glows as an Emerald Green  Night."


Thus, by the Oversoul Will, you release the Emerald Green Flame and direct it

onto the  Night Energy Beam.  You are using the Beam as a carrier for the

Green Flame of the  Night Spirit Healing. There is a twin action taking place

in the person being healed. There  is the action of the Night Energy in the

Beam and also the action of the Green Flame.   These Twin Energies of the

Oversoul will bring about the desired action of Magickal  Healing.  The action

of the Oversoul Healing is instantaneous, if the Night Healing is  carried out

in Night Consciousness. This is Night Healing.


You have put together the things that you have been learning and practicing

into a very valuable technique for healing.   If you have been studying and

practicing with constancy  and perseverance, then your success at Night

Healing will be excellent.  Night Healing is  the Universal Cure for all ills.

You will be able to apply a very similar technique, as used  here, in

obtaining physical Immortality.


48.  Immortality: Transmigration and Transmutation


Immortality has been a subject discussed many, many times over the ages.  When

I speak  of Immortality there is generally two ways that it can be viewed.

The first is the  Immortality of the physical form.  The physical body can be

Eternal and live forever.  This  has perpetuated the myths of the Fountain of

Youth and the Philosopher's Stone of the  Ancient Alchemists.  The second is

the Immortality of the soul.  That is, after physical  death, the personality

continues to live on forever in the Night Realm.  It is the idea that "I  who

am I will always be I, now and forever".  I am going to discuss both types.

The  emphasis will be on the Immortality of the physical body.  That is, I

consider it to be the  most important.  Let's begin the discussion with

transmigration.


Transmigration is the transference of the soul or personality from one

physical body to another without the normal rest between lives associated with

in reincarnation.  The body,  the soul transfers to, may be of a newly born

infant or one of more advanced age.   Transmigration is also the entry by a

disembodied Night Teacher into a body of advance  age.  The age being

determined by what is available and what is needed by the  disembodied Night

Teacher.  This is not so far-out as it may seem.


We have discussed many times that you are not the physical body, but the

emotional,  mental, and magickal nature of being.  The physical body is only a

house in which you  reside.  It is a special vehicle created especially for

you to operate through here on Earth.   As Shakespeare said, "All the world is

a stage and you are but the actor on it."  You are  acting out a certain part

while you are here and the physical body is nothing more then a  costume in

which to appear and act in.  So, transmigration is simply changing from one

costume and role, to another costume and role.  It is simply entering a new

house which  is about to be vacated by its old occupant.  The how's of

transmigration are not so difficult  to understand.


I have spoke of the silver cord many times.  It is your life line from your

Oversoul to you.   The silver cord is anchored into your physical heart.  You

know from Astral Projection that  you can leave the body at night and travel

in many other realms.  The physical body  continues to live only because the

silver cord is still attached to it in the heart.  In  transmigration, you

remove the silver cord from the old residence, which dies, and move it  to the

new residence where it is anchored into the new heart.  At the very same time,

the  former occupant, who was resident in the body that is about to be newly

inhabited, is  removed and set free into the Astral Realm.  This is a very

delicate procedure.  It may be  easy to imagine, but it is difficult to

perform.  There are very special Astral Night Spirits  who are especially

trained to perform such a magickal operation.   The procedure is  basically

the same for a disembodied Night Teacher wanting a physical body.   There are

very special considerations that have to be taken, before transmigration can

take place.


First of all, the person giving up the body that is about to be newly

occupied, must  voluntarily want to do so.  It cannot be done against their

will.  There are many reasons  why s/he may want to do so.  The person may be

very tired of living on Earth. Her/His life  may have been a very difficult

one and s/he feels there is very little left for her/him in life.    This

person may even be contemplating suicide.  In another case, the person may

have  almost completed what s/he came into the world to accomplish and death

may soon  happen even though the body may be in good health.  Therefore,

before letting suicide  occur in the first case, or natural death in the

other, the individual is approached, while  s/he is in the Astral, about going

through transmigration.  If s/he consents to the transfer  then it can be

done.  This is not an easy way out for the possible suicide.  It is her/his

chance for doing something very worth while in life. There is another

consideration that  must be met; the basic frequencies must be the same or

closely similar.


Not everyone is a suitable candidate for transmigration.  The person leaving,

and the  person entering, must be closely related in basic vibration.  This

does not mean that they  must be of the same magickal level.  Everyone has a

basic frequency that is akin to the  frequency of a musical note.  It is a

frequency that is set from the Nature of the Oversoul.   If the frequencies of

the two are very close, then the transfer can take place.


There are many reasons why transmigration would be necessary. For example, if

a  person had worked all their life at a very special project that would do

much towards the  advancement of humankind, but s/he had not quite finished

and the span of her/his body  was about to expire, what would or could s/he

do? By special arrangement through the  Night Guild s/he could undergo

transmigration.  This could occur before the life span of  the old body was

finished or shortly after bodily death.  The control of transmigration is in

the hands of the World Directors.  Suppose now, that the Night Guild needed to

put one of  its Emissaries in the world. They want her/him there now and

functioning in her/his task.   This is another use of transmigration.  Now it

is time to consider another form of  Immortality.


This is transmutation.  The definition of transmutation is "to change".  You

are going to transmute or change the substance of your physical body into the

Oversoul Body.  To  begin with, this process is threefold.  It deals with the

transmutation of your physical body  and your emotional and mental attitudes.

The discussion will deal with all three, and  we'll start with the physical.

The transmutation of the physical begins with proper diet.  You must eat

correctly.  You  must have the proper diet that provides you with the best of

health.  You must not overeat  anything to excess.  The best diet is one that

eliminates all meat.  You must have the  proper amounts of exercise and rest.

You must keep your body clean.  The rule is to treat  the body with respect

and proper care.  This is the beginning of the transmutation of the  physical

body and is followed by the transmutation of your emotions.


You must feel young, alive, and vibrant.  You must feel the eternalness of

being young.   You must feel the very Youth of the Oversoul flowing through

you.  It is essential that you  manifest only thoughts of being alive in the

Oversoul.  If you feel young, you are young.  If  you feel alive and ready for

any challenge by the world, then you will remain in perpetual  youth forever.

The only thing that causes you to grow old is the negative emotions that  you

allow to enter into your world.  You grow old through worry, tension, and

anger.  If  you keep your emotions centered in the Oversoul, then you shall

become Immortal.  Not  only is feeling Immortal important, but thinking

Immortal is of the utmost importance.


Your thoughts must be centered in the Oversoul Mind.  Not only do you feel

alive and  vibrant, but you know that you are.  Your thoughts are not troubled

by the concerns of the  world, for those concerns shall find their own

solutions.  Your thoughts are centered on  the Immortal Oversoul, and you know

that you are the Immortal Oversoul.  When you know  that you are Immortal, and

feel Immortal, then there is only one thing left to do, and that is  to apply

your Night Powers and Flames to your Immortality.


The application for the use of the Night Powers and Flames is very similar to

what you  learned in Night Healing.  You will begin with Invocation, in

telling your Oversoul that you  are going to use both the Green Flame of the

Night Spirit Healing and the Night Flame to  reach Immortality.  Then, you

will move into the next phase, that of meditation and the  Seventh Night

Power. You will use the same meditation on both the subjects of Healing  and

Immortality.  You already have learned how to do it for Healing.  You then

will begin  with meditation on Immortality. You shall dwell on the Immortal

Oversoul within you.   Then, you shall take this meditation into the Seventh

Night Power.


Thus, you shall do more then just meditate on Immortality, you shall come to

know the  very essence of Immortality.  You shall absorb that essence of

Immortality into your Inner Awareness and become Immortal.  So first, the

meditation on the Healing Oversoul, then  the meditation on the Immortal

Oversoul.  You take both of these meditations into the  Seventh Power and you

are ready to continue, in Night  Consciousness, with the Night  Body. You will

use the very same procedure in acquiring the Night Body as I have  outlined in

Night Healing. Since this is Self-healing and Immortality that you are

learning,  you will omit the use of the Night Energy Beam.  You are going to

retain the Energies of  the Night Flames.  Then, you will continue the

procedure, by invoking the Emerald Green  Flame as you did in the last topic.

Once you have used the Green Flame sufficiently, as to  feel cleansed of all

imperfections and afflictions, then you are ready to invoke the Black  Flame.

The invocation for the Black Flame in this case is as follows:


"I am the Presence of the Oversoul  and I am invoking the powerful Black Night

Flame to transmute the human body to an Eternal Oversoul Body.  I behold the

Night Flame  entering within my three material forms and Purifying,

Transmuting, and being made  wholly into the Night Soul of Life.  I am filled

with the Transmuting Night Flame that is  changing my material form into the

Everlasting Form of the Oversoul.  I am Eternal in the  Oversoul; that which I

am shall never experience physical death again; I AM Immortal as  the Oversoul

in the Oversoul Body.  So be it."


Then, you shall bathe in the Black Night Flame, until you have become Bodily

Immortal in  the Oversoul.  This is transmutation. You are Immortal in Soul

and can be in material  form.


Whether you are able to achieve the Immortality of your mortal form or not,

you are  forever Immortal in Soul and Night Spirit. You are very close to the

end of Fire Magick.   You have come a very long way on the road of Night

Magick.  Yet, in Magickal Reality,  you have only begun to learn a small

portion of the lore of Night Magick.  You have only  just begun the trek

towards Home. Still, there must be an ending to your first studies in  Night

Magick, so I will close with the final topic on the past, present, and future

of Night  Magicians.

    


49.  Night Magicians: Past, Present, and Future 


This is the concluding topic in the lore of Night Magick.  You have gone

through all the elements of Night Magick.  You have covered Earth, Water, Air,

and Fire and have learned  the basics of each.  Yet, in actuality, you have

hardly scratched the surface.  You have  only just begun to learn Night

Magick.  There is still so much more to learn.


There is no end to the body of knowledge that is Night Magick. You must always

search  for knowledge and wisdom wherever it may be, for this is Night Magick.

No Night  Magician ever stops learning or comes to know it all.  You will

always be unfolding the  Night Powers that lie within you.  For your final

topic, as in the beginning, I would like to  speak once more about Night

Magicians.


I would like to present the Night Magicians of the past, giving their origin,

purpose, and  names; of the present, again speaking of their origin and

purpose; the future, taking a  glimpse of what might be.  To begin this

presentation, I would like to discuss the Night  Magicians of the Past.


In the beginning of distant civilization the Dragon Tiamat taught humankind

the  knowledge and wisdom of Night Magick. Civilizations flourished under

Night Magick and  the Earth was a beautiful and wonderful place.  Then came

the invasion by the Yang and  the destruction of the Yin civilizations.  But

even among the Yang gods and goddesses  there were the Yin.


Among the gods and goddesses were Set, Isis, Nuit, Loki, Pan, Cybele, Hecate,

Kali,  Bacchus, and others who were known to give the other gods and goddesses

trouble.   Among humankind the Night Religions and Night Magick continued.


There are the worshippers and practitioners of the dark religions of the above

listed gods  and goddesses.  There are also the ancient religions of the

Druids and the North and  South American Indians.  There are the religions of

Africa and other so-called dark  continents. There is Voodoo.  Many of these

continue to remain in existence today.   There are also individual

practitioners of the past.


There are Night Magicians such as Abra Melin, and Abraham the Jew, Cagliostro,

Althotas, Comte de Sainte-Germain, Aleister Crowley, Baian, Jeanne Belloc, Dr.

Lamb,  Marie Le Normand, Henry Cornelius Agrippa, Paracelsus, Jacob Boehme,

Eliphas Levi,  Marie Laveau, Alexander Seton, and William Butler Yeats.


There are also Night Magicians of the present, but I cannot name them here.

This is still  very much a Yang world with great hatred for those devoted to

the world of Night Magick.   So all I will say is that Night Magicians can be

found in all walks of life.  There are no  barriers to those of the Night

World.  What all Night Magicians have in common is the  preparation for the

future.


The future of humankind is bleak.  With the pollution and rape of this world

by humankind the Earth will soon rid itself of much of the cancer that is

causing its death.  There are  many predictions about when this period of life

is going to happen.  Prophets have been  forecasting this event and the time

of its happening for ages.  But determining the exact  date of this happening

is like trying to forecast the first snowfall of the winter.  There are a

great deal of things that determine when it will first snow, and so with this

event.  I can  say that some of the signs of this happening have already begun

to manifest.


There has been an increasingly large number of natural disasters. There has

and will  continue to be a large number of shifts going on within the Earth.

This will give  earthquakes, volcanoes, and the rising and lowering of land.

There will be terrible storms  that will cause widespread destruction.  There

will be flooding, extremes of heat and cold,  draughts and all kinds of out of

the ordinary weather changes.  There will be a great deal  of panic and terror

among the citizenry.  The skies will have a very unusual glow to them  and be

of a reddish black hue.  There will be great shifts in the land with some

rising and  others falling. Some of the land will be covered with water and

other portions, currently  under water, will rise up into the open air.  Not

only will the land be undergoing a major  shift, but there will also be

political and social upheaval.  This is a time of the Earth's  balancing the

large amounts of karma that humankind has created. It is a time of  correcting

the harm that humankind has done to the body of the planet itself.  This is

not  presented here to bring panic and fear into anyone's heart. It is

presented in an explicit  manner so you can do something about it.


Futures don't have to be written in stone.  They can be changed. You can help

the future  to change by practicing Night Magick. It is a way of preparing

yourself for the changes  about to take place.  There is much you have learned

in Night Magick that can help you  prepare. You could use psychometry to find

a safe place to be when the trouble begins.   You can learn to give the Earth

healing energy and give back to it vitality it has lost.  You  can stop any

destructive practices which cause further harm to the Earth.  You can be part

of many voices trying to change the way the Earth is slowly being destroyed.

You can use  Night Magick to influence those who make decisions.  The future

is an odd thing.


Sometimes you can look forward and feel what is ahead, but it is always based

upon the probabilities, or possibilities that will open up before you.  If you

could stand high upon a mountain and look at your future, it would seem like

there are many roads that lay before  you and all the choices that determine

which road you take are yours to choose.  You  would find that even from your

lofty height, you could not see the end of the road you  chose, or its

outcome.  But one road you have already chosen will insure a bright future.

Of course this is the Night Road of a Night Magician.


To travel the Night Road you must have a desire to learn and a willingness to

experiment.   You must be adventurous and love excitement and the unusual.

You must be willing to  be tested and trials will come your way.  But the

outcome of traveling the Night Road  leads to victory in life. The Night Road

leads to the Night Magician's Dream.


A Night Magician's Dream  


Picture if you will a Land of Enchantment; a Land of Honor, Strength, and

Energy.  The  Land of the Night Magicians.  This is the Land in which your

dreams evolve from within.   Reality is seen through your Night Eye and felt

through your Night Heart. You are as rich  as your Soul is in the Eternal

Night.  You are as young as the Oversoul is within you.   Search within your

heart, within the Heart of Creativity, and become the Living Oversoul.  The

Night Magician is, knows, and becomes all.  They exist within all things; such

is the  Night Consciousness of the Oversoul in them.  They are free of

self-limitations and control  the world of form, and the things found in it.

They are Pure in Night Spirit. They transcend  all things: space, time, and

the world around them.


Believe as you will; what you are is all that is; what you will be is limited

by yourself; this  is your creed and your life as it is within you.  No longer

bound by the limitations of a  Yang, past world, you are the Progress of a New

Age, an Age of the Night World.  You are  the Foundation of Time and Space.

You are the Strength of the Night Spirit.  If only in the  hearts of all, you

were what you felt when you dream, then there could exist no wrong  ideas.


There is potential in thought and ideas, and it is for Humanity to bring them

out of the  Void. Only Humanity can be what they believe their selves to be.

They cannot be what  they don't believe is possible to be.  Freedom begins in

thought and when Manifest in  Action can be Truth as the Night Spirit sees the

Truth: focused on a Point in Time;  balanced on the Edge of Infinity.


Believe in yourself and your ability to succeed in all things. Only you

control you; only you  can find happiness; only you make the destiny that lies

before you.  You are a Channel for  the Eternal Night; use this right, and

bring forth into your world the Energy of the Night  and make Humanity what

They can be as the Night Spirit Wills.  You are the strength of  the Earth and

only you can open the Doorway to your Success.  Be what you Believe, and  be

what you can be, for no one can limit, another.  You can only limit Yourself.

The  challenge of life is to know thyself; to know how one limits another, and

how to be all you  can be in life and Night Magick.


The Night Magician is the Knower, the Doer, and is the Night Spirit within all

things.   There Responsibility lies with the Night Spirit and the Oversoul.

They are the Heart of all  things, bringing Humanity into harmony with Nature,

and the world into harmony with the  Night Spirit.


You are the One who becomes Your Dreams; who is unlimited by Your Energy for

all  things, for Your Energy is Boundless and Eternal. No longer in this world

is the Door shut  to this One; the One who has become the Night Magician.




APPENDIXES




APPENDIX A

 

INVOCATIONS, HYMNS, POEMS, AND PRAYERS   


1.  Invocation for the Night Magician's Pillar of Protection.  


I am a Night Magician surrounded in a Pillar of Night Energy that cannot be

penetrated.  It repels all energy that would harm me. It repels all thoughts

and emotional energy of my enemies. Through the Power of my Oversoul, I am

protected in a Pillar of Night Energy  and cannot be harmed.  May this Night

Pillar remain around me at all times keeping me  out of harms way.  So be it.


2.  Ritual Invocations


Each ritual will begin by your stepping into the Night Circle and putting on

your Night Weapons and Cape.  After this place the Night Pillar around you.

Do not leave the Circle  until the end of the ritual and be sure and

re-enforce the Night Pillar around and through  you before leaving the Night

Circle.  Go through the actions of consecrating the Night  Circle with earth,

water, air, and fire each time.  Fill the chalice, say the invocation, and

drink the wine each time.  Then always ring the bell and summon the Night

Deities.    These are the basic procedures you will begin each ritual which

takes place within the  Night Circle.


Now pick up the bell and ring it six times in each major direction, that is

North, South,  East and West.  Then repeat the following invocation, "I who am

(give your Night Name)  summon the Presence of all Deities in the Night Force

to attend my ritual of Eternal Night.   We now stand in the Eternal Night

beyond time and space.  Come and witness my Ritual  of the Night".


After this, pick up the salt container, and repeat the following: "By my

sacred name, (give  your Night Name), through the Presence of my Oversoul and

the Eternal Earth Deities, I  invoke the Earth Night Power into this container

of salt and now place the salt upon the  earth to mark the boundary of my

sacred circle." Visualize the Earth Deities filling the  vessel with their

power. Pinch a little salt lightly between your fingers dropping it on the

floor over the cord going completely around the circle.  BE CAREFUL NOT TO

STEP  OUTSIDE THE CIRCLE FOR THE REMAINDER OF THE RITUAL.  Place the salt

container  back on the Night Altar and pick up the crystal bowl of water.


Repeat the following: "May the Presence of my Oversoul and the Eternal Water

Deities fill  this water and container and endow it with the Water Night

Power."  Visualize the Water  Deities of the Earth filling the vessel with the

power.  With your left hand dip it into the  water and sprinkle lightly the

boundary you have already marked with the salt.  Place the  water bowl back on

the altar and pick up the incense burner.  Repeat the following: "Let the

Presence of the Four Winds of the Earth enter into the  incense burner filling

it with Air Night Power".   Now face each direction, rotating

counterclockwise, and see the Presence of each Wind Deity enter into the

incense burner.   Then circle four times in a counterclockwise manner around

and within the Magick Circle.   Place the incense burner back on the Night

Altar and pick up the candle.


Repeat the following:  "May the Presence of my Oversoul and the Fire Deities

of the Earth  place their sacred flame here within my candles and upon my

Night Altar."   See the Fire  Deities come and dance around the flames and

upon your altar.  Place the candle back  where it came from and pick up the

chalice of wine or juice.  Repeat the following: "Let the Presence of my

Oversoul and the Eternal Darkness enter  into the liquid and fill it with the

Power of the Eternal Night.  May this elixir give me  strength, healing, and

courage each day of my life."  Feel the Power flow through you and  into the

chalice.  See the energy collect and concentrate till the chalice glows with

Night  Energy. Now face each direction and repeat the following:  "Thank you

Night Deities for your attendance at this sacred Night Rite.  May we ever

serve the Eternal Powers of Darkness  here on Earth and the Omniverse forever.

So be it."


At this point stop and re-enforce your Night Pillar and then take off all your

Night  Weapons and place them back upon the Night Altar.  Leave the cord in

place on the floor.


3.  Invocation to Night Magick.  


I,(give your Night Name), commit my all to the Oversoul and the Night Spirit

within, and to  the dedication of my Magickal Energies to the practice of

Night Magick.  I dedicate myself  to the Oversoul within and to my union with

it in Night Consciousness.  May these Night  Tools and Weapons serve me ever

in this cause. So be it.


4. Invocation to the Cosmic Being of the(insert-direction).  


I invoke the Great Powers of the Cosmic Being of the (insert direction) to

flow into my  being. Fill me with the Cosmic Power of (insert element).  Renew

me in the Power of  Night Consciousness.  Make me a Being of Cosmic Yin Light.

Guide me upon the Road of  Night Magick."


5.  Invocation for Night Projection.  


On this day ___, I am going to Night Project.  I am going to travel in the

Astral Realm and remember all that I see and do.  I will recall all of this

after I have returned to my body.   This I will do and won't fail."


6.  Night Invocation on Earth.  


Let the Earth be filled with the Presence of the Night.  I honor the Presence

of the Night in  all I say and do.  By the Night all things are given, by the

Night all enemies removed.  By  the Yin Light of the Moon I shall walk the

Night Road on Earth in power, and glory and  victory forever. So be it.


7.  Hymn of the Nights.  


I am the Dark Sun that radiates Night Energy in the night.  I am filled with

Darkness and Energy and all those who gaze on me become the like.  I am the

Pure Essence of  Oversoul in the form of the Dark Sun.  I am no longer feeling

the material form.  I have  become transcendent and translucent and know

myself as Pure Night Energy.  I am not  this physical form but a Body of Pure

Yin Light.  I AM the Night Magician, Eternal in the  Light of the Night

Spirit.  I AM the Night Magician.


8.  Invocation for the Night Body.


I am the Night Soul that glows in the darkness of the night.  I am Night

Energy and all  those who gaze on me become the like.  I am the Pure Essence

of the Oversoul in the  form of a Dark Sun.  I am no longer feeling the

material form.  I am becoming  transcendent and translucent and know myself as

Pure Night Energy.  I am not this  physical form but a Body of Pure Night

Energy.  I am the Night Magician, Eternal in the  Light of the Night Spirit.

I AM the Night Magician within my Night Body.


9.  Invocation for Night Healing.


I am the Night Presence of the Oversoul.  I call upon that Presence to pass

through me  and to (person's name or thing to be healed).  The (person or

thing) requires the Healing  Power of the Night Oversoul to correct the (wrong

or name the specific condition).  As I am  performing the act of Night Healing

raise me into your Night Consciousness and let the  healing be done.  So be

it.


10.  Invocation for Transmutation by the Black Night Flame.


I am the Presence of the Oversoul  and I am invoking the powerful Black Night

Flame to transmute the human body to an Eternal Oversoul Body.  I behold the

Night Flame  entering within my three material forms and Purifying,

Transmuting, and being made  wholly into the Night Soul of Life.  I am filled

with the Transmuting Night Flame that is  changing my material form into the

Everlasting Form of the Oversoul.  I am Eternal in the  Oversoul; that which I

am shall never experience physical death again; I AM Immortal as  the Oversoul

in the Oversoul Body.  So be it.


 

11.  Invocation of the Black Night Flame.  


By the Presence of the Oversoul within me I am invoking the Great Black Flame

of the Oversoul's Purity and Perfection through me. I AM seeing this Black

Flame descending  from above and filling my being with Its Essence and Power.

I AM then placing it here  before me on the Altar of the Night, there to

collect and concentrate into a blazing Night  Black Flame.  Now, oh blazing

Night Black Flame, I AM commanding thee by the Power of  the Presence of the

Oversoul in me, to obey my Will as the Oversoul on Earth.


12.  Invocation of the Violet Night Flame.  


I AM the Oversoul on Earth and I AM invoking the Violet Night Flame of

Transmutation.  I  AM seeing this Violet Night Flame descending from my own

Night Soul and entering  within me transmuting all that I AM into the Night

Soul.  All negation and inharmony is  removed from by being and replaced with

Pure Night Energy.  I AM the Violet Night Flame  and all who see with me are

alive with the Violet Night Flame and so Transmuted, Purified  and forever

Free.

  

13.  Invocation of the Blue Night Flame.   


I AM the Oversoul on Earth, and I AM invoking the Peace and Harmony of the

Blue Night Flame.  I AM seeing this Blue Flame of the Night Spirit's Peace and

Harmony descending  out of my the Night Soul and into that which I AM.  I AM

focusing this Blue Flame here  before me on the Altar of the Nights.  I AM the

Blue Night Flame here in Oversoul Action  giving Peace and Harmony to all.


14.  Invocation of the Green Night Flame.   


By the Power of the Presence of the Oversoul within the Night Heart, I am

invoking the  Green Flame of the Oversoul Healing.  I am seeing this Green

Flame of the Oversoul  Healing filling my Night Being.  I AM seeing it before

the Great Silver Night Disk  becoming concentrated, magnified, and intensified

until it glows as an Emerald Green  Night.


15.  Invocation of the Yellow Night Flame.  


Through the Night Oversoul within me I AM invoking the Power of the Night

Flame of  Wisdom and Intelligence.  I AM filled with these three Magickal

Qualities and know, and  see, all that the Night Soul sees.  And I AM

surrounding myself and the world around me  in the Yellow Night Flame of

Wisdom and Intelligence.


16.  Invocation of the Orange Night Flame.  


I draw from out of the sun the Orange Night Flame.  With this Night Flame I

empower the  world around me with energy.  I Am protected from the Orange

Night Flame by the Power  of the Night.


17.  Invocation of the Red Night Flame.  


Through the Presence of the Oversoul in me and the Power of the Night Guild I

AM commanding the Red Flame of the Night into my world and being.  I AM the

Red Flame of  the Night in Action on Earth today and forever.


18.  Invocation of the Rainbow Night Flame.  


I AM the composite of the Night Flames in Action on Earth.  I AM the Night

Soul in Consciousness and by the Night Consciousness I AM invoking the Total

Power of the Night Flames embodied in the Rainbow Flame.  I AM commanding this

Night Flame into  existence by the Will of the Eternal Darkness.  And by my

Oversoul Consciousness the  Rainbow Flame is sustained and placed into Night

Action by Night Direction.  I AM the  Action of the Rainbow Flame.  I AM the

Rainbow Night Flame.


APPENDIX B   


CANDLE COLOR COMBINATION AND THE NIGHT TEACHERS 


Candle color is arranged by the basic force the Night Teachers are aligned

with.   Remember that the two front candles are always black for the second

Water Rite.  So  here is the color candles to use with the particular force

and teachers.


Use midnight blue and red candles for the First Force of the Will and Power of

the Night  Spirit. This includes the Keeper Asmodeus and Azazel, Leviathan,

Santanas, and Amon.


Use two midnight blue candles for the Second Force of the Wisdom of the Night

Spirit.   This includes the Keeper Kali and Lucifuge Rofocale, Belial, and

Azael.


Use two black candles for the Third Force of the Energy of the Night Spirit.

This includes  the Keeper Baal and Endor, Abraxas, and Balan.


Use two red candles for the Fourth Force of Balance, Dignity, and Purity.

This includes  the Keeper Lilith and Astaroth, Nisroch, and Bensozia.


Use two yellow candles for the Fifth Force of Knowledge.  This includes the

Keeper Dagon  and Agares, John Dee, Bifrons, Belphegor, and Alocer.


Use red and violet candles for the Sixth Force of Devotion.  This includes the

Keeper  Lucifer and Moloch, Astartes, and Marie Laveau.


Use two violet candles for the Seventh Force of Beauty and Action of the Night

Spirit.  This includes the Keeper Hecate and Aleister Crowley, Armida,

Cagliostro, Baphomet, and  Eliphas Levi.







Comments

Popular posts from this blog

BOTTOM LIVE script

Evidence supporting quantum information processing in animals

ARMIES OF CHAOS